452
1 RX450h/350_Navi_U 1 QUICK GUIDE 9 2 BASIC FUNCTION 31 3 NAVIGATION SYSTEM 68 4 PHONE 147 5 AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM 210 6 AIR CONDITIONING 315 7 VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM 329 8 INFORMATION 343 9 LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT 369 10 PERIPHERAL MONITORING SYSTEM 397 INDEX 413 TABLE OF CONTENTS

TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

  • Upload
    others

  • View
    0

  • Download
    0

Embed Size (px)

Citation preview

Page 1: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

11

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 QUICK GUIDE 9

2 BASIC FUNCTION 31

3 NAVIGATION SYSTEM 68

4 PHONE 147

5 AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM 210

6 AIR CONDITIONING 315

7 VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM 329

8 INFORMATION 343

9 LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT 369

10 PERIPHERAL MONITORING SYSTEM 397

INDEX 413

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Page 2: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

2

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Introduction

This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. Please read this manualcarefully to ensure proper use. Keep this manual in your vehicle at all times.The screen shots in this document and the actual screens of the navigation system dif-fer depending on whether the functions and/or a contract existed and the map dataavailable at the time of producing this document.

The Navigation System is one of the most technologically advanced vehicle accesso-ries ever developed. The system receives satellite signals from the Global PositioningSystem (GPS) operated by the U.S. Department of Defense. Using these signals andother vehicle sensors, the system indicates your present position and assists in locatinga desired destination.The navigation system is designed to select efficient routes from your present startinglocation to your destination. The system is also designed to direct you to a destinationthat is unfamiliar to you in an efficient manner. The system uses DENSO maps. The cal-culated routes may not be the shortest nor the least traffic congested. Your own per-sonal local knowledge or “short cut” may at times be faster than the calculated routes.The navigation system’s database includes Point of Interest categories to allow you toeasily select destinations such as restaurants and hotels. If a destination is not in the da-tabase, you can enter the street address or a major intersection close to it and the sys-tem will guide you there.The system will provide both a visual map and audio instructions. The audio instructionswill announce the distance remaining and the direction to turn in when approaching anintersection. These voice instructions will help you keep your eyes on the road and aretimed to provide enough time to allow you to maneuver, change lanes or slow down.Please be aware that all current vehicle navigation systems have certain limitations thatmay affect their ability to perform properly. The accuracy of the vehicle’s position de-pends on satellite conditions, road configuration, vehicle condition or other circum-stances. For more information on the limitations of the system, refer to pages 144through 146.

NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER’S MANUAL

NAVIGATION SYSTEM

Page 3: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

3

RX450h/350_Navi_U

For safety reasons, this manual indicates items requiring particular attention with thefollowing marks.

IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT THIS MANUAL

CAUTION

●This is a warning against anything which may cause injury to people if the warning isignored. You are informed about what you must or must not do in order to reduce the risk ofinjury to yourself and others.

NOTICE

● This is a warning against anything which may cause damage to the vehicle or its equipmentif the warning is ignored. You are informed about what you must or must not do in order toavoid or reduce the risk of damage to your vehicle and its equipment.

SYMBOLS USED IN ILLUSTRATIONS

Safety symbolThe symbol of a circle with a slash through it means “Do not”, “Do not dothis”, or “Do not let this happen.”

Arrows indicating operations

Indicates the action (pushing, turning, etc.)used to operate switches and other devic-es.

Indicates the outcome of an operation (e.g.a lid opens).

Page 4: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

4

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ INFORMATION FOR GASOLINE VEHICLES IS WRITTEN IN BRACK-ETS NEXT TO THE INFORMATION FOR HYBRID VEHICLESDifferent writing styles for gasoline and hybrid vehicles

Example

When the “POWER”*1 <“ENGINE START STOP”>*2 switch is in ACCESSORY orON*1 <IGNITION ON>*2 mode, the initial screen will be displayed and the systemwill begin operating.

*1: Vehicles with hybrid system

*2: Vehicles with gasoline engine

HOW TO READ THIS MANUAL

No. Name Description

Operational Outlines An outline of the operation is explained.

Main Operations The steps of an operation are explained.

Related Operations A main operation’s supplementary operations are described.

Information Useful information for the user is described.

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

2. STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE

1 Scroll the map to the desired point.

When “Map” is selected on the “Con-firm Destination” screen, the mapscreen will be displayed. The map loca-tion of the selected destination can beset as a destination.

If a destination has already been set, “Goto ” and “Add to Route” will be dis-played.

“Go to ”: Select to delete the existingdestination(s) and set a new one.

INFORMATION

●The route for returning may not be thesame as that for going.

●The route guidance to the destinationmay not be the shortest route nor a routewithout traffic congestion.

●Route guidance may not be available ifthere is no road data for the specifiedlocation.

Page 5: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

5

RX450h/350_Navi_U

To use this system in the safest possiblemanner, follow all the safety tips shown be-low.This system is intended to assist in reachingthe destination and, if used properly, can doso. The driver is solely responsible for thesafe operation of your vehicle and the safetyof your passengers.Do not use any feature of this system to theextent it becomes a distraction and pre-vents safe driving. The first priority whiledriving should always be the safe operationof the vehicle. While driving, be sure to ob-serve all traffic regulations. Prior to the actual use of this system, learnhow to use it and become thoroughly famil-iar with it. Read the entire Navigation Sys-tem Owner’s Manual to make sure youunderstand the system. Do not allow otherpeople to use this system until they haveread and understood the instructions in thismanual.For your safety, some functions may be-come inoperable when driving. Unavailablescreen buttons are dimmed. Only when thevehicle is not moving, can the destinationand route selection be done.

While driving, listen to the voice instructionsas much as possible and glance at thescreen briefly and only when it is safe. How-ever, do not totally rely on voice guidance.Use it just for reference. If the system can-not determine the current position correct-ly, there is a possibility of incorrect, late, ornon-voice guidance.The data in the system may occasionally beincomplete. Road conditions, includingdriving restrictions (no left turns, street clo-sures, etc.) frequently change. Therefore,before following any instructions from thesystem, look to see whether the instructioncan be done safely and legally.This system cannot warn about such thingsas the safety of an area, condition of streets,and availability of emergency services. If un-sure about the safety of an area, do not driveinto it. Under no circumstances is this sys-tem a substitute for the driver’s personaljudgement.Use this system only in locations where it islegal to do so. Some states/provinces mayhave laws prohibiting the use of video andnavigation screens next to the driver.

SAFETY INSTRUCTION CAUTION

●For safety, the driver should not operatethe navigation system while he/she isdriving. Insufficient attention to the roadand traffic may cause an accident.

●While driving, be sure to obey the trafficregulations and maintain awareness ofthe road conditions. If a traffic sign on theroad has been changed, route guidancemay not have the updated informationsuch as the direction of a one way street.

Page 6: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

TABLE OF CONTENTS

6

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION..................... 10

Remote Touch........................................................... 10MAP SCREEN......................................................... 12REGISTERING HOME....................................... 14REGISTERING PRESET

DESTINATIONS ................................................. 16OPERATION FLOW:

GUIDING THE ROUTE.................................. 18SETTING HOME AS

THE DESTINATION ......................................... 19

2. FUNCTION INDEX ..................................... 20

NAVIGATION SYSTEM FUNCTION INDEX.........................................20

3. QUICK REFERENCE.................................. 22

“Menu” SCREEN ................................................... 22“Destination” SCREEN........................................ 24“Setup” SCREEN.................................................... 26“Information” SCREEN........................................28

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION ............................................... 32

INITIAL SCREEN ..................................................32HOW TO USE THE Remote Touch .............34INPUTTING LETTERS AND

NUMBERS/LIST SCREEN OPERATION.......................................................36

SCREEN ADJUSTMENT ..................................39MAP SCREEN OPERATION.......................... 41

2. SETUP ................................................................ 52

GENERAL SETTINGS .......................................52VOICE SETTINGS ...............................................65

1. DESTINATION SEARCH............................ 70

DESTINATION SEARCH ................................ 70STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE ...............89

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE ................................... 93

ROUTE GUIDANCE SCREEN .................... 93TYPICAL VOICE GUIDANCE

PROMPTS............................................................. 96DISTANCE AND TIME TO

DESTINATION .................................................. 99SETTING AND DELETING

DESTINATIONS.............................................. 100SETTING ROUTE............................................... 102

3. ADDRESS BOOK ..........................................111

NAVIGATION SETTINGS................................111

4. SETUP ...............................................................127

DETAILED NAVIGATION SETTINGS............................................................ 127

VEHICLE SETTINGS.........................................137

5. GPS (GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM).......................................................144

LIMITATIONS OF THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM................................................................144

1 QUICK GUIDE

2 BASIC FUNCTION

3 NAVIGATION SYSTEM

Page 7: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

7

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. PHONE OPERATION................................148

QUICK REFERENCE .......................................148PHONE (HANDS-FREE SYSTEM

FOR CELLULAR PHONE) ........................150REGISTER A Bluetooth® PHONE ............. 156CALL ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE ..........161RECEIVE ON THE Bluetooth®

PHONE.................................................................168TALK ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE ......... 169Bluetooth® PHONE MESSAGE

FUNCTION........................................................ 172

2. SETUP .............................................................. 175

PHONE SETTINGS ........................................... 175Bluetooth® SETTINGS...................................... 197

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION.............................................. 212

QUICK REFERENCE........................................212SOME BASICS .....................................................214RADIO OPERATION .......................................221HD Radio™ TECHNOLOGY

INFORMATION............................................. 224RADIO OPERATION

(XM Satellite Radio BROADCAST) ...... 229RADIO OPERATION (INTERNET

RADIO BROADCAST)............................... 234DVD PLAYER OPERATION.......................235USB MEMORY OPERATION ...................256iPod OPERATION ............................................ 262Bluetooth® AUDIO OPERATION ...........269REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT

SYSTEM FEATURES .................................... 279AUDIO/VIDEO REMOTE CONTROLS

(STEERING SWITCHES) .......................... 300AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

OPERATING HINTS....................................302

2. SETUP .............................................................. 312

AUDIO SETTINGS ............................................ 312

4 PHONE 5 AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

Page 8: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

TABLE OF CONTENTS

8

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION ............................................. 316

QUICK REFERENCE ....................................... 316SOME BASICS.....................................................318AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM

OPERATION..................................................... 319

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION ............................................330

VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM................. 330NATURAL SPEECH INFORMATION

(ENGLISH ONLY) ........................................336EXPANDED VOICE COMMANDS ..... 338COMMAND LIST..............................................339

1. INFORMATION DISPLAY...................... 344

FUEL CONSUMPTION.................................344MAP DATABASE VERSION AND

COVERAGE AREA .....................................346

2. XM FUNCTION-OVERVIEW .............. 348

XM SERVICES ................................................... 348

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION ............. 351

XM Sports ............................................................... 351XM Stocks ..............................................................354XM Fuel Prices .....................................................357XM NavWeather™............................................. 361XM NavTraffic® ..................................................365

4. SETUP ............................................................. 368

XM SETTINGS ................................................... 368

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW ..................... 370

FUNCTIONAL OVERVIEW....................... 370TYPE A: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY

USING A CELLULAR PHONE................371TYPE B: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY

USING DCM AND THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM................. 376

TYPE C: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY USING DCM.................................................... 379

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION ...................380

APPS ........................................................................380Destination Assist................................................ 387eDestination...........................................................389Lexus Insider.......................................................... 392

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM........ 398

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM ...........398REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

PRECAUTIONS .............................................400THINGS YOU SHOULD KNOW............ 402

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST............... 404

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST .................... 404INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

SETTING.............................................................. 410

ALPHABETICAL INDEX............................... 414

6 AIR CONDITIONING

7 VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM

8 INFORMATION

9 LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

10 PERIPHERAL MONITORING SYSTEM

INDEX

Page 9: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

1

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. Remote Touch ............................................... 10

2. MAP SCREEN.............................................. 12

3. REGISTERING HOME............................. 14

4. REGISTERING PRESET DESTINATIONS....................................... 16

5. OPERATION FLOW: GUIDING THE ROUTE......................... 18

6. SETTING HOME AS THE DESTINATION ......................................... 19

1. NAVIGATION SYSTEM FUNCTION INDEX ............................... 20

1. “Menu” SCREEN ........................................ 22

2. “Destination” SCREEN ............................. 24

3. “Setup” SCREEN ........................................ 26

4. “Information” SCREEN............................. 28

1 NAVIGATION OPERATION

2 FUNCTION INDEX

3 QUICK REFERENCE

QUICK GUIDE

Page 10: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

10

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

1. Remote Touch

Page 11: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

11

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No. Name Function Page

“MENU” button Press to display the “Menu” screen. 22

“ · ” button Press to change the scale of the map and to scrollthe list screen. 34, 37, 49

“MAP/VOICE”button

Press to repeat a voice guidance, cancel thescreen scroll, start guidance, and display the cur-rent position.

41

Remote Touch knob

Move in the desired direction to select a function,letter and map screen button.Press to enter the selected function, letter or mapscreen button.

34

Page 12: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

12

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. MAP SCREEN

No. Name Function Page

North-up or heading-up symbol

This symbol indicates whether the map orienta-tion is set to north-up or heading-up. Selecting thissymbol changes the map orientation. Both north-up and heading-up symbols display the vehiclesdirection as a letter (e.g. N for north).

51

Scale indicator This figure indicates the map scale. 49

Zoom out button Select to reduce the map scale. 49

“Off”Select to obtain a broader view. Some of the but-tons on the screen will not be displayed. They aredisplayed again by selecting “On”.

133

Page 13: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

13

RX450h/350_Navi_U

“PWR·VOL” knob: Press and hold for 3 seconds or more to turn off the screen and restartthe navigation system. Do this when the vehicle-mounted device response is extremelyslow.

“Mark” Select to register the current position or the cur-sor position as an address book entry. 43

“Route” Select to change the route. 100, 102

“Show on Map”Select to browse information about guidanceroute, to set the POI (Point of Interest) icons to bedisplayed on the screen, to record the route, etc.

107, 366, 391

Zoom in button Select to magnify the map scale. 49

Foot print mapbutton

Select to display the foot print map and the build-ing information. 50

“Map Mode” Select to display the “Map Mode” screen. 46

Distance and time to destina-tion

Select to display the distance, estimated traveland arrival time to the destination. 99

XM indicator This mark is displayed when XM information is re-ceived. 364, 366

“GPS” mark (Global Position-ing System)

Whenever the vehicle is receiving signals from theGPS, this mark is displayed. 144

INFORMATION

●Remove dirt from the display and its surrounding area by lightly wiping with a soft, dry cloth,such as a cloth used for cleaning glasses with plastic lenses. Scrubbing too hard or using ahard cloth could scratch the display. Also, the display is treated with a coating, and could bedamaged by coming into contact with benzine or alkaline solution.

●When the screen is viewed through polarized sunglasses, a rainbow pattern may appear onthe screen due to optical characteristics of the screen. If this is disturbing, please operatethe screen without polarized sunglasses.

No. Name Function Page

Page 14: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

14

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. REGISTERING HOME

Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

Select “Destination” and press theRemote Touch knob.

Select “Go Home” and press theRemote Touch knob.

If a home address has not been regis-tered, it can be registered by selecting“Go Home”.

Select “Yes” and press the RemoteTouch knob.

There are 4 different methods tosearch your home. (See “DESTINA-TION SEARCH” on page 70.)

Select “Enter” and press theRemote Touch knob.

The “Edit Home” screen is displayed.

1

2

3

4

5

6

Page 15: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

15

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Select “OK” and press the RemoteTouch knob.

Registration of home is complete. Home can also be registered by selecting“Navigation” on the “Setup” screen. (See“REGISTERING HOME” on page 112.) The name, location, phone number andicon can be changed. (See “EDITINGHOME” on page 113.)The registered points can be used on the“Destination” screen. (See “DESTINA-TION SEARCH BY HOME” on page71.)

7

Page 16: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

16

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4. REGISTERING PRESET DESTINATIONS

Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

Select “Destination” and press theRemote Touch knob.

Select one of the preset destinationbuttons and press the RemoteTouch knob.

A preset destination can be set to any pre-set destination button that has not yetbeen set.

Select “Yes” and press the RemoteTouch knob.

There are 4 different methods tosearch preset destinations. (See“DESTINATION SEARCH” onpage 70.)

Select “Enter” and press theRemote Touch knob.

The “Edit Preset Destination” screen isdisplayed.

1

2

3

4

5

6

Page 17: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

17

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Select “OK” and press the RemoteTouch knob.

Registration of preset destinations is com-plete.Preset destinations can also be registeredby selecting “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen. (See “REGISTERING PRESETDESTINATIONS” on page 114.)The name, location, phone number andicon can be changed. (See “EDITINGPRESET DESTINATIONS” on page 115.)The registered points can be used on the“Destination” screen. (See “DESTINA-TION SEARCH BY PRESET DESTINA-TIONS” on page 71.)

7

Page 18: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

18

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5. OPERATION FLOW: GUIDING THE ROUTE

Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

Select “Destination” and press theRemote Touch knob.

There are 11 different methods tosearch destinations. (See “DESTI-NATION SEARCH” on page 70.)

Page 1

Page 2

Select “Go to ” and press theRemote Touch knob.

The navigation system performs a searchfor the route.

Select “OK” and press the RemoteTouch knob. Then start driving.

Routes other than the one recommendedcan also be selected. (See “STARTINGROUTE GUIDANCE” on page 89.)Guidance to the destination is displayedon the screen and can be heard via voiceguidance.

1

2

3

4

5

Page 19: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

19

1. NAVIGATION OPERATION

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6. SETTING HOME AS THE DESTINATION

Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

Select “Destination” and press theRemote Touch knob.

Select “Go Home” and press theRemote Touch knob.

“Go Home” can be used if your home ad-dress has been registered. (To registerhome, see “REGISTERING HOME” onpage 112.)Your home address is set as the destina-tion. The navigation system performs asearch for the route.

Select “OK” and press the RemoteTouch knob. Then start driving.

Routes other than the one recommendedcan also be selected. (See “STARTINGROUTE GUIDANCE” on page 89.)Guidance to the destination is displayedon the screen and can be heard via voiceguidance.

1

2

3

4

Page 20: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

20

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. FUNCTION INDEX

1. NAVIGATION SYSTEM FUNCTION INDEX

Map

Route guidance

Displaying maps Page

Viewing the map screen 12

Displaying the current position 41

Viewing the current position vicinity map 42

Changing the scale 49

Changing the map orientation 51

Displaying Points of Interest 107

Displaying the estimated travel/arrival time to the destination 99

Selecting the map mode 46

Deleting map screen buttons 133

Displaying traffic information 365

Searching destinations Page

Searching the destination 70

Changing the selected search area 70

Operating the map location of the selected destination 89

Before starting route guidance Page

Setting the destination 89

Viewing alternative routes 90

Starting route guidance 89

Before starting or during route guidance Page

Viewing the route 89

Adding destinations 100

Changing the route 102

Displaying the estimated travel/arrival time to the destination 99

Page 21: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

2. FUNCTION INDEX

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

21

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Useful functions

During route guidance Page

Pausing route guidance 106

Adjusting route guidance volume 67

Deleting the destination 101

Displaying the entire route map 103

Address book Page

Registering address book entries 116

Marking icons on the map 118

Information Page

Displaying vehicle maintenance 137

Hands-free system (for cellular phone) Page

Initiating Bluetooth® 150

Making a call on a Bluetooth® phone 161

Receiving a call on the Bluetooth® phone 168

Voice command system Page

Operating the system with your voice 330

Page 22: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

22

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. QUICK REFERENCE

1. “Menu” SCREEN

Press the “MENU” button on the Remote Touch to display the “Menu” screen.

Page 23: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

3. QUICK REFERENCE

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

23

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No. Name Function Page

“Destination” Select to display the “Destination” screen.14, 16, 18, 19, 24, 70, 387,

389

“Info/Apps” (“Info”)

Select to display the “Information” screen.For vehicles sold in Canada, “Info” is used insteadof “Info/Apps”.

28, 344, 346, 351, 354, 357, 361, 365,

380, 383, 392

“Display” Select to adjust the contrast and brightness of thescreens, turn the display off, etc. 39

“Setup” Select to display the “Setup” screen.

26, 52, 65, 111, 127, 137,

175, 197, 312, 368, 395, 410

“Phone” Select to display the hands-free operation screen. 156

“Climate” Select to display the air conditioning controlscreen. 318

“Media” Select to display the media control screen. 216

“Radio” Select to display the radio control screen. 216

Page 24: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

24

3. QUICK REFERENCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. “Destination” SCREEN

The “Destination” screen enables a destination search. Press the “MENU” button onthe Remote Touch, then select “Destination” to display the “Destination” screen.

No. Name Function Page

“Address” Select to input a house number and the street ad-dress using the input keys. 72

“Point of Interest” Select one of the POIs that have already beenstored in the system’s database. 75, 389

“Destination Assist”

Select to provide you with live assistance findingdestinations via the Lexus Enform with SafetyConnect response center.

82, 387

“Previous Destinations”

Select a destination from any of the last 100 previ-ously set destinations and from the previous start-ing point.

82

“Del.Dest.” Select to delete set destinations. 88

Page 25: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

3. QUICK REFERENCE

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

25

RX450h/350_Navi_U

“Address Book”

Select the desired location from a registered entryin “Address book”. (To register address book en-tries, see “REGISTERING ADDRESS BOOKENTRIES” on page 117.)

83

“Emergency”Select one of the 4 categories of emergency ser-vice points that have already been stored in thesystem’s database.

83

“Intersection & Freeway”

Select to enter the names of 2 intersecting streetsor a freeway (interstate) entrance or exit. This ishelpful if only the general vicinity, not the specificaddress, is known.

84

“Map” Select to enable setting a destination by specifyinga location on the map screen. 87

“Coordinates” Select to enter latitude and longitude coordinates. 87

Preset destina-tion buttons

Select one of the 5 preset destination points as adestination. If a preset destination point has notbeen registered, a message will be displayed ask-ing if it is desirable to set a destination to the presetscreen button. (To register a preset destination,see “REGISTERING PRESET DESTINATIONS”on page 114.)

71

“Go Home”

Select your personal home address without hav-ing to enter the address each time. If a home ad-dress has not been registered, a message will bedisplayed and the setting screen will automaticallyappear. (To register home, see “REGISTERINGHOME” on page 112.)

71

No. Name Function Page

Page 26: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

26

3. QUICK REFERENCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. “Setup” SCREEN

The items shown on the “Setup” screen can be set. Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup” to display the “Setup” screen.

Page 27: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

3. QUICK REFERENCE

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

27

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No. Name Function Page

“General” Select to change the selected language, opera-tion sound, automatic screen change settings, etc. 52

“Voice” Select to set the voice guidance settings. 65

“Navigation”Select to set home, preset destinations, addressbook, areas to avoid, etc. or to delete previousdestinations.

111

“Vehicle” Select to set vehicle information such as mainte-nance information. 137

“Other” Select to set Lexus Insider, XM Sports, XMStocks and XM Fuel Prices. 368, 395

“Audio” Select to HD Radio™ channel and iPod settings. 312

“Bluetooth*” Select to set Bluetooth® phones and Bluetooth®

audio devices. 197

“Phone” Select to set the phone sound, phonebook, mes-sage settings, etc. 175

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

Page 28: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

28

3. QUICK REFERENCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4. “Information” SCREEN

This screen can be used to display the XM satellite system, fuel consumption, etc.Press the “MENU” button on the Remote Touch, then select “Info/Apps” (“Info”) todisplay the “Information” screen.

Page 29: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

3. QUICK REFERENCE

1

QU

ICK

GU

IDE

29

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No. Name Function Page

“Apps” Select to display the “Apps” screen. 380, 383

“Fuel Consumption” Select to display the fuel consumption screen. 344

“Traffic Incidents” Select to display traffic incidents. 365

“Map Data” Select to display map data information. 346

“LEXUS Insider” Select to display the “LEXUS Insider” screen. 392

“XMNavWeather” Select to display weather information. 361

“XM Stocks” Select to display personally selected stocks infor-mation. 354

“XM Sports” Select to display personally selected sports teamsinformation. 351

“XM Fuel Prices” Select to display current fuel prices and gas sta-tion locations information. 357

Page 30: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

30

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Page 31: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

2

31

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. INITIAL SCREEN ....................................... 32

2. HOW TO USE THE Remote Touch ........................................... 34

3. INPUTTING LETTERS AND NUMBERS/LIST SCREEN OPERATION............................................ 36

4. SCREEN ADJUSTMENT ........................ 39

SCREEN SETTINGS ADJUSTMENT ............. 39

5. MAP SCREEN OPERATION ................ 41

CURRENT POSITION DISPLAY....................... 41

SCREEN SCROLL OPERATION..................... 42

SWITCHING THE SCREENS ............................. 46

MAP SCALE................................................................. 49

FOOT PRINT MAP .................................................. 50

ORIENTATION OF THE MAP............................ 51

STANDARD MAP ICONS .................................... 51

1. GENERAL SETTINGS.............................. 52

SCREENS FOR GENERAL SETTINGS........ 53

2. VOICE SETTINGS..................................... 65

SCREEN FOR VOICE SETTINGS ................... 66

1 BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2 SETUP

BASIC FUNCTION

Page 32: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

32

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

1. INITIAL SCREEN

1 When the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ACCES-SORY or ON <IGNITION ON> mode,the initial screen will be displayed andthe system will begin operating.

After a few seconds, the “CAUTION”screen will be displayed.

After about 5 seconds, the “CAUTION”screen automatically switches to the mapscreen. (If a button other than the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Remote Touch ispressed, the function’s correspondingscreen will be displayed.)

Images shown on the initial screen can bechanged to suit individual preferences.(See page 59.)

CAUTION

●When the vehicle is stopped with thehybrid system operating <the engine run-ning>, always apply the parking brake forsafety.

Page 33: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

33

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

MAINTENANCE INFORMATION

This system reminds users when to re-place certain parts or components andshows dealer information (if registered)on the screen.When the vehicle reaches a previouslyset driving distance or date specified fora scheduled maintenance check, the“Maintenance Reminder” screen will bedisplayed when the navigation system isturned on.

This screen goes off if the screen is notoperated for several seconds.To prevent this screen from being dis-

played again, select “Do Not DisplayThis Message Again”.To register maintenance information, see

“MAINTENANCE” on page 137.

Page 34: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

34

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. HOW TO USE THE Remote Touch

1 Use the Remote Touch knob to selectthe desired button on the screen.

2 To select the button on the screen, pressthe Remote Touch knob. Once a buttonhas been selected, the screen willchange.

When the pointer moves close to a button,it will be automatically pulled onto that but-ton. The strength of this pull can beadjusted. (See page 63.)The pointer will disappear from the screen

if it is not moved for 6 seconds. Operationof the Remote Touch knob will cause thepointer to reappear.Press the “ ” button on the Remote Touch

to zoom in on the map screen and the “ ”button to zoom out. These buttons can alsobe used to scroll up and down on listscreens.Press the “MENU” button on the Remote

Touch to set a destination or adjust settingsfor the audio/video system, air conditioningsystem, etc.The map screen can be returned to by

pressing the “MAP/VOICE” button on theRemote Touch.

This navigation system can be operatedby the Remote Touch when the“POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”>switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode.

CAUTION

●Do not allow fingers, fingernails or hair tobecome caught in the Remote Touch asthis may cause an injury.

●Be careful when touching the RemoteTouch in extreme temperatures as it maybecome very hot or cold due to the tem-perature inside the vehicle.

Page 35: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

35

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

NOTICE

●Do not allow the Remote Touch to comeinto contact with food, liquid, stickers or litcigarettes as doing so may cause it tochange color, emit a strange odor or stopfunctioning.

●Do not subject the Remote Touch toexcessive pressure or strong impact asthe knob may bend or break off.

●Do not allow coins, contact lenses orother such items to become caught in theRemote Touch as this may cause it to stopfunctioning.

●Items of clothing may rip if they becomecaught on the Remote Touch knob.

●If your hand or any object is on theRemote Touch knob when the “POWER”<“ENGINE START STOP”> switch isturned to ACCESSORY mode, theRemote Touch knob may not operateproperly.

INFORMATION

●Under extremely cold conditions, theRemote Touch knob may react slowly.

Page 36: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

36

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. INPUTTING LETTERS AND NUMBERS/LIST SCREEN OPERATION

1 Select “A-Z” to display the alphabetkeys.

2 Select the keys directly to enter lettersor numbers.

: Select to erase one character. Selectand hold to continue erasing characters.

On certain letter entry screens, letters canbe entered in upper or lower case.

1 Select “Other” to display symbol keys.

2 Select the symbol keys directly to entersymbols.

: Select to erase one symbol. Selectand hold to continue erasing symbols.

When searching for an address orname, or entering data, letters and num-bers can be input via the screen.

Keyboard layout can be changed. (Seepage 58.)

TO INPUT LETTERS AND NUMBERS

Icon Function

Select to enter in lower case.

Select to enter in upper case.

TO INPUT SYMBOLS

Page 37: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

37

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “OK” to search for an address ora name.

Matching items from the database arelisted even if the entered address or nameis incomplete.The list will be displayed automatically if the

maximum number of characters is enteredor the number of matching items is 5 orless.

TO DISPLAY THE LIST

INFORMATION

●The number of matching items is shownon the right side of the screen. If the num-ber of matching items is more than 999,the system displays “” on the screen.

LIST SCREEN OPERATION

When a list is displayed, use the appro-priate screen button to scroll throughthe list.

Icon Function

Select to skip to the next or previ-ous page.Select and hold or to scrollthrough the displayed list.

This indicates the displayedscreen’s position.

If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is toolong to display.Select to scroll to the end of thename.Select to move to the beginningof the name.

INFORMATION

●The “ ” and “ ” buttons on the RemoteTouch can be used to scroll up and downon list screens.

Page 38: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

38

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Sort”.

2 Select the desired sorting criteria.

SORTING

The order of a list displayed on thescreen can be rearranged.

Screen button Function

“Distance”Select to sort in order ofdistance from the currentposition.

“Date” Select to sort in order ofdate.

“Category” Select to sort in order ofcategory.

“Icon” Select to sort in order oficon.

“Name” Select to sort in order ofname.

“Brand”Select to sort in order ofbrand name. (XM func-tions)

“Price” Select to sort in order ofprice. (XM functions)

Page 39: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

39

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

4. SCREEN ADJUSTMENT

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Display”.

Adjusting the screen display

“Camera”: Select to adjust the image thecamera displays.Adjusting the image the camera displays

“Map·Menu”: Select to return to thescreen display settings.

The contrast and brightness of thescreen display and the image the cam-era displays can be adjusted. The displaycan also be turned off, and/or changedto either day or night mode. (For infor-mation regarding audio/video screenadjustment, see “AUDIO SCREENADJUSTMENT” on page 246.)

SCREEN SETTINGS ADJUSTMENT

ADJUSTING SCREEN DISPLAY AND CAMERA SETTINGS

Page 40: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

40

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “ ” or “ ” to select the desiredfunction (“Contrast” or “Brightness”).

2 Select the desired screen button to ad-just contrast and brightness.

3 After adjusting the screen, select “OK”.The screen goes off when “Screen Off” is

selected. To turn the screen back on, pressany button on the audio panel or on theRemote Touch. The selected screenappears.

1 To display the screen in day mode, evenwith the headlight switch on, select “DayMode” for brightness and contrast con-trol.

In the following conditions, the displayscondition is not changed to night modeeven if headlight switch is turned on:• The instrument panel light control switch

is adjusted full brightness.• The vehicle is in a bright area, such as out-

side in direct sunlight.

CONTRAST AND BRIGHTNESS ADJUSTMENT

The contrast and brightness of thescreen can be adjusted according to thebrightness of your surroundings. Thedisplay can also be turned off.

Screen button Function

“Contrast” “+” Select to strengthen thecontrast of the screen.

“Contrast” “-” Select to weaken thecontrast of the screen.

“Brightness” “+” Select to brighten thescreen.

“Brightness” “-” Select to darken thescreen.

CHANGING BETWEEN DAY AND NIGHT MODE

Depending on the position of the head-light switch, the screen changes to dayor night mode.

INFORMATION

●If the screen is set to day mode with theheadlight switch turned on, this conditionis memorized even with the hybrid system<engine> turned off.

Page 41: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

41

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

5. MAP SCREEN OPERATION

The current position mark ( ) appears inthe center or bottom center of the mapscreen.A street name will appear on the bottom of

the screen, depending on the scale of themap ( ).The screen can be returned to this map

screen that shows the current position atany time, from any screen by pressing the“MAP/VOICE” button on the RemoteTouch.

CURRENT POSITION DISPLAY

When starting the navigation system,the current position is displayed first.This screen displays the current positionand a map of the surrounding area.

To correct the current position manually,see page 134.

INFORMATION

●While driving, the current position markis fixed on the screen and the map moves.

●The current position is automatically setas the vehicle receives signals from theGPS (Global Positioning System). If thecurrent position is not correct, it is auto-matically corrected after the vehiclereceives signals from the GPS.

●After 12-volt battery disconnection, or ona new vehicle, the current position maynot be correct. As soon as the systemreceives signals from the GPS, the cor-rect current position is displayed.

Page 42: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

42

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Use the scroll feature to move the desiredpoint to the center of the screen for lookingat a point on the map that is different fromthe current position.To scroll over the map, place the pointer in

a position near the desired destination andthen press and hold the Remote Touchknob. The map will continue scrolling in thatdirection until the knob is released.A street name, city name, etc. of the

selected point will be shown, depending onthe scale of the map ( ). Distance fromthe current position to will also beshown ( ).

1 Select “Enter ”.

The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “STARTINGROUTE GUIDANCE” on page 89.)

SCREEN SCROLL OPERATION

When any point on the map is selected,that point moves to the center of thescreen and is shown by the cursor mark( ).

After the screen is scrolled, the mapremains centered at the selected locationuntil another function is activated. Thecurrent position mark will continue tomove along your actual route and maymove off the screen. When the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Remote Touch ispressed, the current position markreturns to the center of the screen andthe map moves as the vehicle proceedsalong the designated route.When the scroll feature is used, the cur-

rent position mark may disappear fromthe screen. Press the “MAP/VOICE”button on the Remote Touch to displaythe current position on the map screen.

TO SET THE CURSOR POSITION AS A DESTINATION

A specific point on the map can be set asa destination using the scroll function.

Page 43: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

43

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Mark”.

2 This screen is displayed.

The registered point is shown by on themap.

To display information about an icon, setthe cursor on it.

■ POI INFORMATION

1 Select “Info”.

TO REGISTER THE CURSOR POSITION AS AN ADDRESS BOOK ENTRY

Address book entry registration enableseasy access to a specific point.

To change the icon or name, etc., see“EDITING ADDRESS BOOKENTRIES” on page 117.

INFORMATION

●Up to 100 address book entries can beregistered. If there is an attempt to regis-ter more than 100 address book entries,an error message will appear.

TO SEE INFORMATION ABOUT THE ICON WHERE THE CURSOR IS SET

When the cursor is set on a POI icon, thename and “Info” are displayed at the topof the screen.

Page 44: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

44

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Information such as the name, address,position and phone number are dis-played.

■ ADDRESS BOOK ENTRY INFOR-MATION

1 Select “Info”.

2 Information such as the name, address,position and phone number are dis-played.

If “Enter ” is selected, the cursor posi-tion will be set as a destination. If a destination has already been set, “Go

Directly” and “Add to Route” will be dis-played.

“Go Directly”: Select to delete the exist-ing destination(s) and set a new one.“Add to Route”: Select to add a destina-tion.To register this POI as an address book

entry, select “Mark”. (See “REGISTER-ING ADDRESS BOOK ENTRIES” onpage 117.) If is selected, the registered

phone number can be called.The desired POI can be displayed on the

map screen. (See “DISPLAY POIICONS” on page 107.)

When the cursor is set on an addressbook entry icon, the name and “Info” aredisplayed at the top of the screen.

Page 45: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

45

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ DESTINATION INFORMATION

1 Select “Info”.

2 Information such as the name, address,position and phone number are dis-played.

To delete a destination, select “Delete”.

If “Enter ” is selected, the cursor posi-tion will be set as a destination. If a destination has already been set, “Go

Directly” and “Add to Route” will be dis-played.

“Go Directly”: Select to delete the exist-ing destination(s) and set a new one.“Add to Route”: Select to add a destina-tion.To edit an address book entry, select

“Edit”. (See “EDITING ADDRESSBOOK ENTRIES” on page 117.)To delete an address book entry, select

“Delete”. If is selected, the registered

phone number can be called.

When the cursor is set on a destinationicon, the name and “Info” are displayedon the top of the screen.

If is selected, the registeredphone number can be called.

Page 46: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

46

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ XM NavTraffic® TEXT INFORMA-TION

1 Select “Info”.

2 Traffic information will be displayed onthe screen.

To display detailed traffic event information,select “Detail”.

1 Select “Map Mode”.

2 Select the screen buttons to select thedesired configuration.

Depending on the conditions, certainscreen configuration buttons cannot beselected.

When the XM NavTraffic® icon on themap screen is selected, the XMNavTraffic® information bar will appearon the upper part of the screen.

SWITCHING THE SCREENS

Any of the screen configurations can beselected.

Page 47: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

47

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ MAP ONLY

The screen shows the single map.

■ AUDIO

Information on the current radio station ortrack is displayed.

Screen button Function

“Map Only”Select to display the singlemap screen. (See page47.)

“Turn List” Select to display the turnlist screen. (See page 95.)

“Intersection”

Select to display the inter-section guidance screenor the guidance screen onthe freeway. (See page94.)

“Audio” Select to display the audioscreen. (See page 47.)

“Fuel Con-sumption”

Select to display the fuelconsumption screen. (Seepage 48.)

“Other Information”

Select to display the fol-lowing 4 screen configu-rations: “Dual map”,“Compass”, “Turn-by-Turn Arrow” and “FreewayExit List”.

“Dual map”Select to display the dualmap screen. (See page48.)

“Compass”Select to display the com-pass mode screen. (Seepage 49.)

“Turn-by-Turn Arrow”

Select to display the turn-by-turn arrow screen. (Seepage 95.)

“Freeway Exit List”

Select to display the free-way exit list screen. (Seepage 93.)

SCREEN CONFIGURATIONS

This is a regular map screen.

While on a different screen, selecting“Map Only” will display the single mapscreen.

The audio screen and the map screenare displayed.

If a different screen is displayed, select“Audio” on the “Map Mode” screen.For audio system operation, refer to

“AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERA-TION”. (See page 212.)

Page 48: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

48

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ FUEL CONSUMPTION

Selecting “ ” or “ ” allows selection of thedesired mode (“Energy Monitor”*, “TripInformation” or “Past Record”).

*: Vehicles with hybrid system

■ DUAL MAP

This screen shows the dual map. The mapon the left is the main map.

■ EDITING RIGHT MAP

1 Select the desired screen button.

The following procedures can be per-formed on this screen:

2 Select “OK” when editing is completed.The screen returns to the dual map screen.

The fuel consumption screen and themap screen are displayed.

If a different screen is displayed, select“Fuel Consumption” on the “MapMode” screen.For an explanation on each fuel con-

sumption mode, refer to “FUEL CON-SUMPTION”. (See page 344.)

The map screen can be split into two.

While on a different screen, selecting“Dual map” will display the dual mapscreen.

The right side map can be edited by se-lecting any point on the right side map.

No. Function

Changing the orientation of the map

Displaying POI icons

Showing XM NavTraffic® information (See page 366.)

Displaying eDestination icons (Seepage 391.)

Changing the map scale

Page 49: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

49

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ COMPASS

Information about the destination, currentposition and a compass is displayed on thescreen.

1 Select or to change the scaleof the map screen.

The scale bar and indicator at the bottom ofthe screen indicate the map scale menu.The scale range is from 150 ft. (50 m) to250 miles (400 km).

Select and hold or to continuechanging the scale of the map screen.The scale of the map screen can be

changed by selecting the scale bar directly.This function is not available while driving.

The current position is indicated with acompass.

While on a different screen, selecting“Compass” will display the compassmode screen.

INFORMATION

●The destination mark is displayed in thedirection of the destination. When driv-ing, refer to the longitude and latitudecoordinates, and the compass, to makesure that the vehicle is headed in thedirection of the destination.

●When the vehicle travels out of the cover-age area, the guidance screen changes tothe compass mode screen.

MAP SCALE

INFORMATION

●Press the “ ” button on the RemoteTouch to zoom in on the map screen andthe “ ” button to zoom out.

●The map scale is displayed under thenorth-up or heading-up symbol at the topleft of the screen.

●When the map scale is at the maximumrange of 250 miles (400 km), is notshown. When the map scale is at the min-imum range of 150 ft. (50 m), is notshown. In areas where the foot print mapis available the map scale changes from

to when at the minimumrange.

Page 50: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

50

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 To display the foot print map, select.

To delete the foot print map display, select.

1 Select “Info” while the foot print map isdisplayed.

Details of POIs in some buildings may bedisplayed.For detailed POI information, select the

building name. Details of the selected POIscan be seen.

FOOT PRINT MAP

For the area which is covered by the footprint map (Some areas in the followingcities: Detroit, Chicago, N.Y., L.A), youcan switch to the foot print map on ascale of 75 ft. (25 m).

TO SWITCH TO THE FOOT PRINT MAP

changes into when the map isscaled down to 150 ft. (50 m).

INFORMATION

●If the map or the current position ismoved to the area which is not coveredby the foot print map, the screen scaleautomatically changes to 150 ft. (50 m).

●On the foot print map, a one way street is

displayed by .●It is not possible to perform scrolling on

the foot print map while driving.

Building footprints in the database werecreated and provided byMAPMASTER.

TO DISPLAY BUILDING INFORMATION

Information is available only for build-ings for which information is recordedon the map data.

Page 51: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

51

1. BASIC INFORMATION BEFORE OPERATION

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select or .

North-up screen

Heading-up screen

: North-up symbolRegardless of the direction of vehicle travel,north is always up.

: Heading-up symbolThe direction of vehicle travel is always up.

ORIENTATION OF THE MAP

The orientation of the map can bechanged from north-up to heading-upby selecting the orientation symbol atthe top left of the screen.

Both the north-up and heading-up sym-bols display the vehicles direction as aletter (e.g. N for north).

STANDARD MAP ICONS

Icon Name

Island

Park

Industry

Business facility

Airport

Military

University

Hospital

Stadium

Shopping mall

Golf

Page 52: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

52

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. SETUP

1. GENERAL SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “General”.

4 Select the items to be set.

5 Select “Save”.

Used for language selection and the on/off settings of operation sounds and au-tomatic screen change, etc.

Page 53: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

53

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed:

SCREENS FOR GENERAL SETTINGS

No. Function

Select to change the time zone andselect “On” or “Off” for daylight sav-ing time and automatic adjustment ofthe clock. (See “CLOCK SET-TINGS” on page 54.)

Select to change the language. (See“SELECTING A LANGUAGE” onpage 56.)

Select to change the distance unit.(See “UNIT OF MEASUREMENT”on page 57.)

Select to change the screen buttoncolor. (See “SELECTING A BUT-TON COLOR” on page 57.)

Select to change the keyboard layout.(See “SELECTING A KEYBOARDLAYOUT” on page 58.)

Select to customize the startup im-age. (See “CHANGING THESTARTUP IMAGE” on page 59.)

Select to customize the screen off im-age. (See “CHANGING THESCREEN OFF IMAGE” on page 61.)

Select to set automatic screen chang-es from the audio/air conditioningcontrol screen to the previous screento “On” or “Off”. If “On” is selected,the screen will automatically return tothe previous screen from the audio/air conditioning control screen after20 seconds.

Page 54: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

54

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Clock”.

Select to turn the selection sounds“On” or “Off”.

Select to turn the pointer sounds“On” or “Off”.

Select to turn the error sounds “On”or “Off”.

Select to adjust the pointer sound vol-ume. (See “POINTER SOUNDVOLUME SETTINGS” on page 62.)

Select to adjust the strength of thepull from the buttons to the pointer.(See “SETTING A FEEDBACKFORCE” on page 63.)

Select to delete personal data. (See“DELETING PERSONAL DATA”on page 63.)

Select to update program versions.For details, contact your Lexus deal-er.

Select to update gracenote databaseversions. For details, contact yourLexus dealer.

No. Function CLOCK SETTINGS

Used for changing time zones and theon/off settings of daylight saving timeand automatic adjustment of the clock.

Page 55: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

55

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

4 Select the items to be set.

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed:

5 Select “Save”.

■ TIME ZONE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Clock” on the “General Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Time Zone”.

5 Select the desired time zone.

If “Other” is selected, the zone can beadjusted manually. Select “+” or “-” toadjust the time zone and then select “OK”.

6 Select “Save”.

No. Function

Select to change the time zone. (See“TIME ZONE” on page 55.)

Select “On” or “Off” for daylight sav-ing time.

Select “On” or “Off” for automaticadjustment of the clock. (See “MAN-UAL CLOCK SETTING” on page56.)

A time zone can be selected and GMTcan be set.

Page 56: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

56

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ MANUAL CLOCK SETTING

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Clock” on the “General Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Auto Adjust Clock”.

*e.g. 1:00 to 1:29 1:001:30 to 1:59 2:00

5 Select “Save”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Language”.

4 Select the desired screen button.

5 Select “Yes”.The previous screen will be displayed.

6 Select “Save”.

When “Auto Adjust Clock” is turned“Off”, the clock can be manually adjust-ed.

Screen button Function

“Hours” “+”, “-”

Select “+” to set the timeforward one hour and “-”to set the time back onehour.

“Minutes” “+”, “-”

Select “+” to set the timeforward one minute and“-” to set the time backone minute.

“Minutes” “:00” Select to round to thenearest hour*.

SELECTING A LANGUAGE

The language can be changed.

Page 57: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

57

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Unit of Measurement”.

4 Select “km” or “mile”.

The previous screen will be displayed.

5 Select “Save”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Button Color”.

4 Select the desired screen button color.

The previous screen will be displayed.

5 Select “Save”.

UNIT OF MEASUREMENT

Distance unit can be changed.

This function is available only in Englishor Spanish. To change language, see“SELECTING A LANGUAGE” on page56.

SELECTING A BUTTON COLOR

The color of the screen buttons can bechanged.

Page 58: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

58

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Keyboard Layout”.

4 Select “ABC” or “QWERTY” of “Key-board Layout” to change the keyboardlayout.

The previous screen will be displayed.

5 Select “Save”.

■ LAYOUT TYPE

“ABC” type

“QWERTY” type

SELECTING A KEYBOARD LAYOUT

Keyboard layout can be changed.

Page 59: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

59

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

■ TRANSFERRING DATA

1 Pull up the lever to release the lock, andlift the armrest.

2 Open the cover and connect a USBmemory.

Turn on the power of the USB memory if itis not turned on.

3 Close the console box.

4 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

5 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

CHANGING THE STARTUP IMAGE

When the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ACCES-SORY or ON <IGNITION ON> mode,the initial screen will be displayed.An image can be copied from a USBmemory and used as the startup image.(For information regarding the startupimage, see “INITIAL SCREEN” on page32.)

INFORMATION

●When saving the images to a USB, namethe folder that the startup image is savedto “StartupImage” and name the folderthat the screen off image is saved to“DisplayOffImage”. If these folder namesare not used, the navigation system can-not download the images. (The foldernames are case sensitive.)

●The images file extension is JPG orJPEG.

●The images file name, including the fileextension, can be up to 32 characters.

●Image files of 10 MB or less can be saved.●Up to 3 images can be downloaded.

Page 60: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

60

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Select “Customize Startup Image”.

7 Select “Transfer”.

8 Select “Yes”.

■ SETTING THE STARTUP IMAGE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Customize Startup Image” onthe “General Settings” screen.

4 Select the desired image.

5 Select “Save”.

■ DELETING TRANSFERRED IMAG-ES

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Customize Startup Image” onthe “General Settings” screen.

4 Select “Delete All”.

5 Select “Yes”.

Page 61: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

61

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

■ TRANSFERRING DATA

1 Pull up the lever to release the lock, andlift the armrest.

2 Open the cover and connect a USBmemory.

Turn on the power of the USB memory if itis not turned on.

3 Close the console box.

4 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

5 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

6 Select “Customize Screen Off Image”.

7 Select “Transfer”.

8 Select “Yes”.

CHANGING THE SCREEN OFF IMAGE

Select “Screen Off” to turn off thescreen. An image can be copied from aUSB memory and can be set to displaywhen “Screen Off” is selected. (Formore information on “Screen Off”, see“SCREEN ADJUSTMENT” on page39.)

Page 62: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

62

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ SETTING THE SCREEN OFF IM-AGE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Customize Screen Off Image”on the “General Settings” screen.

4 Select the desired image.

5 Select “Save”.

■ DELETING TRANSFERRED IMAG-ES

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Customize Screen Off Image”on the “General Settings” screen.

4 Select “Delete All”.

5 Select “Yes”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Pointer Sound Volume”.

4 Select the desired button.

5 Select “OK”.

6 Select “Save”.

POINTER SOUND VOLUME SETTINGS

The pointer sound volume can be ad-justed.

Page 63: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

63

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Feedback Force”.

4 Select “+” or “-”.

5 Select “OK”.

6 Select “Save”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “General” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Delete Personal Data”.

4 Select “Delete”.

5 Select “Yes”.

SETTING A FEEDBACK FORCE

When the pointer moves close to a but-ton, it will be automatically pulled ontothat button. The strength of this pull canbe adjusted.

DELETING PERSONAL DATA

Page 64: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

64

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The following personal data can be deletedor returned to their default settings:• Maintenance conditions• Maintenance information off setting• Address book• Areas to avoid• Previous points• Route guidance• Route trace• Phonebook data• Call history data• Speed dial data• Bluetooth® phone data• Phone sound settings• Phone display settings• Message settings• Audio/video setting• Bluetooth® audio setting• Startup image data • Screen off image data• Downloaded Apps

INFORMATION

●This function is not available while driving.

Page 65: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

65

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

2. VOICE SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Voice”.

4 Select the items to be set.

5 Select “Save”.

Voice guidance etc. can be set.

Page 66: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

66

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed:

To reset all setup items, select “Default”.

SCREEN FOR VOICE SETTINGS

No. Function

The voice guidance volume can beadjusted or switched off. (See“VOICE VOLUME” on page 67.)

Voice guidance during route guid-ance can be set to “On” or “Off”.

Voice guidance during audio/videoand/or air conditioning system usecan be set to “On” or “Off”.

Voice recognition prompts can beset to “On” or “Off”. This setting canalso be changed on the “ShortcutMenu” screen. (See page 330.)

When “On” is selected, the audio/video and air conditioning systemscan be operated using voice com-mands.

When using the traffic informationfunction, voice guidance can be set to“On” or “Off”. (See “TRAFFIC INCI-DENT WARNING” on page 67.)

When using the XM NavWeather™function, the severe weather warningcan be set to “On” or “Off”.

Page 67: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

67

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2

BASIC

FUN

CTIO

N

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Voice” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select the desired level by selecting theappropriate number.

If voice guidance is not needed, select“Off” to disable the feature.

4 Select “Save”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Voice” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “On” of “Traffic Incident Warn-ing”.

4 Select “Save”.

VOICE VOLUME

The voice guidance volume can be ad-justed or switched off.

TRAFFIC INCIDENT WARNING

Traffic congestion information can bereceived via voice guidance while beingguided to the desired destination.

INFORMATION

●When the “Traffic Information” indicatoris dimmed, “Avoid Traffic”, “Traffic IncidentWarning” and “Show Free Flowing Traffic”will not operate. (See page 366.)

Page 68: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

68

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. DESTINATION SEARCH........................ 70

SELECTING THE SEARCH AREA .................. 70

DESTINATION SEARCH BY HOME.............. 71

DESTINATION SEARCH BY PRESET DESTINATIONS................................... 71

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Address” ....... 72

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Point of Interest” ..................................................... 75

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Destination Assist”................................................ 82

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Previous Destinations”........................................ 82

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Address Book” ....................................................... 83

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Emergency”............................................................. 83

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Intersection & Freeway”..................................... 84

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Map” ............... 87

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Coordinates”............................................................ 87

DELETING SET DESTINATIONS.................... 88

2. STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE ....... 89

1 DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NAVIGATION SYSTEM

Page 69: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

3

69

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. ROUTE GUIDANCE SCREEN ............ 93

2. TYPICAL VOICE GUIDANCE PROMPTS ................................................. 96

3. DISTANCE AND TIME TO DESTINATION ........................................ 99

4. SETTING AND DELETING DESTINATIONS.................................... 100

ADDING DESTINATIONS ............................... 100

REORDERING DESTINATIONS................... 100

DELETING DESTINATIONS ............................. 101

5. SETTING ROUTE .................................... 102

DETOUR SETTING ................................................ 102

ROUTE OVERVIEW ............................................. 103

ROUTE PREFERENCE......................................... 104

PAUSING AND RESUMING GUIDANCE ........................................................... 106

SHOW ON MAP..................................................... 107

ROUTE TRACE ......................................................... 110

1. NAVIGATION SETTINGS ...................... 111

SETTING UP THE “Home” ................................... 112

SETTING UP THE “Preset Destinations” ........ 114

SETTING UP THE “Address Book” .................. 116

SETTING UP THE “Areas to Avoid”................. 121

DELETING PREVIOUS DESTINATIONS................................................... 125

1. DETAILED NAVIGATION SETTINGS................................................ 127

SCREENS FOR NAVIGATION SETTINGS................................................................ 128

2. VEHICLE SETTINGS .............................. 137

MAINTENANCE ..................................................... 137

VEHICLE CUSTOMIZATION ......................... 142

1. LIMITATIONS OF THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM .................... 144

2 ROUTE GUIDANCE 3 ADDRESS BOOK

4 SETUP

5 GPS (GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM)

NAVIGATION SYSTEM

Page 70: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

70

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Destination”.

3 This screen is displayed.

One of 11 different methods can be used tosearch a destination. (See pages 71 through87.)

1 Select “Change State/Province” to dis-play a list of the states/provinces/terri-tories of the United States and Canada.

2 Select the desired state (province).

The previous screen will be displayed.

INFORMATION

●When searching a destination, theresponse to the screen button may beslow.

SELECTING THE SEARCH AREA

The selected state (province) can bechanged to set a destination from adifferent state (province) by using“Address”, “Point of Interest” or“Intersection & Freeway”.

For map database information andupdates, see “MAP DATABASE VER-SION AND COVERAGE AREA” onpage 346. If a state (province) has not been

selected yet, “Select State/Province” isdisplayed.

Page 71: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

71

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Go Home”.

Your home address is set as the destination.The navigation system performs a searchfor the route.

4 Select “OK”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select any of the preset destination but-tons (1-5).

The selected preset destination point is setas the destination. The navigation systemperforms a search for the route. (See“STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE” onpage 89.)

4 Select “OK”.

DESTINATION SEARCH BY HOME

To use this function, it is necessary to set ahome address. (To register home, seepage 112.)

INFORMATION

●If a home address has not been regis-tered, a message confirming if it is desir-able to set a home will be displayed, andthe setting screen will appear.

●Guidance starts from the current positionto the set home address if “OK” isselected even while driving.

DESTINATION SEARCH BY PRESET DESTINATIONS

To use this function, it is necessary to setpreset destinations to the preset screenbuttons (1-5). (See “REGISTERINGPRESET DESTINATIONS” on page 114.)

INFORMATION

●If a preset destination point has not beenregistered, a message confirming if it isdesirable to set a preset destination willbe displayed, and the setting screen willappear.

●Guidance starts from the current positionto the preset destination point if “OK” isselected even while driving.

Page 72: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

72

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Address” on the “Destination”screen.

4 Select the desired search method.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Address” on the “Destination”screen.

3 Select “City”.

4 Input a city name.

5 Select the screen button of the desiredcity name from the displayed list.

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Address”

There are 2 methods to search a desti-nation by address:(a) Search by city(b) Search by street address

SELECTING A CITY TO SEARCH

Page 73: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

73

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Input the street name and select “OK”.

7 When the desired street name is found,select the corresponding screen button.

When the desired street name is selected,the “Confirm Destination” screen may bedisplayed. If “Go” is selected on the “Con-firm Destination” screen, the navigationsystem performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.)

8 Input a house number.

If the same address exists in more than 1city, the current screen changes to theaddress list screen.

■ SEARCHING FROM THE LAST 5CITIES

1 Select “Last 5 Cities”.

2 Select the screen button of the desiredcity name from the displayed list.

The current screen changes to thescreen for inputting a street name. (See“SELECTING A CITY TO SEARCH” onpage 72.)

INFORMATION

●If the navigation system has never beenused, this function will not be available.

Page 74: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

74

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Address” on the “Destination”screen.

3 Select “Street Address”.

4 Select numbers directly on the screen toinput the house number.

After inputting the house number, select“OK” to display the screen for inputting thestreet name.

5 Input the street name and select “OK”.

6 When the desired street name is found,select the corresponding screen button.

When the desired street name is selected,the “Confirm Destination” screen may bedisplayed. If “Go” is selected on the “Con-firm Destination” screen, the navigationsystem performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.) If the same address exists in more than 1

city, a screen requesting the city name to beinput or selected will be displayed.

7 Input a city name.

8 Select the screen button of the desiredcity name from the displayed list.

SEARCH BY STREET ADDRESS

Page 75: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

75

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Point of Interest” on the “Desti-nation” screen.

4 Select the desired search method.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Point of Interest” on the “Desti-nation” screen.

3 Select “Name” on the “Point of Interest”screen.

4 Input the name of the POI.

5 Select the screen button of the desireddestination.

When the desired destination is selected,the “Confirm Destination” screen may bedisplayed. If “Go” is selected on the “Con-firm Destination” screen, the navigationsystem performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.)When inputting the name of a specific POI,

and there are 2 or more sites with the samename, the list screen is displayed.

INFORMATION

●A street name can be searched usingonly the body part of its name.

●For example: S WESTERN AVE• A search can be performed by inputting

“S WESTERN AVE”, “WESTERN AVE”or “WESTERN”.

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Point of Interest”

There are 4 methods to search a desti-nation by Points of Interest:(a) Search by name(b) Search by category(c) Search by phone #(d) Search by eDestination

SEARCH BY “Name”

Page 76: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

76

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Select the screen button of the desireddestination.

If the same name exists in more than 1 city, asearch can be performed more easily using“City” or “Category”. (See “SELECTINGA CITY TO SEARCH” on page 72 and“SELECTING FROM THE CATEGO-RIES” on page 77.)

■ SELECTING A CITY TO SEARCH

1 Select “City”.

2 Input the city name.

To cancel the city setting, select “Any City”.

3 Select the screen button of the desiredcity name from the displayed list.

The desired POI can be displayed on themap screen. (See “DISPLAY POIICONS” on page 107.)

INFORMATION

●To search for a facility name using multi-ple search words, put a space betweeneach word.

Page 77: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

77

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ SELECTING FROM THE CATEGO-RIES

1 Select “Category”.

2 Select the screen button of the desiredcategory.

If the desired POI category is on thescreen, select its screen button to display adetailed list of the POI category. If the desired POI category is not on the

screen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories.

When the desired category is selected, thePOI name list screen is displayed.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Point of Interest” on the “Desti-nation” screen.

3 Select “Category”.

4 This screen is displayed.

On this screen, the following operationscan be performed:

SEARCH BY “Category”

The destination can be set by selectingthe search point and the POI category.

No. Function

Select to set the search point fromnear the current position.

Select to set the search point fromalong the selected route.

Select to set the search point fromnear a city center.

Select to set the search point fromnear a destination.

Page 78: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

78

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ SETTING THE SEARCH POINTFROM NEAR HERE

1 Select “Near Here”.The search point is set at the current posi-

tion, and the “POI Category” screen will bedisplayed. (See page 80.)

■ SETTING THE SEARCH POINTFROM ALONG MY ROUTE

1 Select “Along My Route”.The search point is set and the “POI Cate-

gory” screen will be displayed. (See page80.)

■ SETTING THE SEARCH POINTFROM NEAR CITY CENTER

1 Select “Near a City Center in XX*”.

2 Input the city center name.

3 Select the screen button of the desiredcity center name.

The search point is set and the “POI Cate-gory” screen will be displayed. (See page80.)*: XX represents the selected search area

name.

INFORMATION

●The names of POIs located withinapproximately 200 miles (320 km) fromthe selected search point can be dis-played.

Page 79: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

79

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ SELECTING FROM THE LAST 5CITIES

1 Select “Near a City Center in XX*”.

2 Select “Last 5 Cities”.

3 Select the screen button of the desiredcity center name.

The search point is set and the “POI Cate-gory” screen will be displayed. (See page80.)*: XX represents the selected search area

name.

■ SETTING THE SEARCH POINTFROM NEAR A DESTINATION

1 Select “Near a Destination”.

2 Select the screen button of the desireddestination.

The search point is set and the “POI Cate-gory” screen will be displayed. (See page80.)

Page 80: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

80

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ TO SEARCH FOR POIs NEAR THESEARCH POINT

1 Select the desired POI category.

If the desired POI category is not on thescreen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories. If “Favorite POI Categories” is selected, a

search can be performed using the 6 POIsthat have been previously set. For moredetails, see “POI CATEGORY CHANGE(SELECT POI ICONS)” on page 132.

2 Select the desired POI category fromthe list.

3 Select the screen button of the desireditem.

When the desired item is selected, the“Confirm Destination” screen may be dis-played. If “Go” is selected on the “ConfirmDestination” screen, the navigation systemperforms a search for the route. (See“STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE” onpage 89.)

When the search point is set, the “POICategory” screen will be displayed.

Page 81: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

81

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Point of Interest” on the “Desti-nation” screen.

3 Select “Phone #” on the “Point of Inter-est” screen.

4 Input a phone number.

5 After inputting a phone number, select“OK”.

When a phone number is input, the “Con-firm Destination” screen may be displayed.If “Go” is selected on the “Confirm Desti-nation” screen, the navigation system per-forms a search for the route. (See“STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE” onpage 89.) If there is more than 1 site with the same

number, the following screen will be dis-played.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Point of Interest” on the “Desti-nation” screen.

3 Select “eDestination” on the “Point ofInterest” screen.

With the eDestination feature, you can goonline, via the Lexus.com owner’s Web site,to select and organize destinations of yourchoice and then wirelessly send them toyour vehicle’s navigation system. Up to200 locations can be stored online andaccessed or updated at any time. Locationscan be organized into up to 20 folders.(See “eDestination” on page 389.)

SEARCH BY “Phone #” To set an address book entry as a desti-nation using the phone number, the num-ber must already be registered with theaddress book entry. (See page 116.)

INFORMATION

●If there is no match for the phone numberinput, a list of identical numbers with dif-ferent area codes will be displayed.

SEARCH BY “eDestination”

Page 82: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

82

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Destination Assist” on the“Destination” screen.

Destination Assist provides you with liveassistance for finding destinations via theLexus Enform with Safety Connectresponse center. You can request either aspecific business, address, or ask for helplocating your desired destination by cate-gory, such as restaurants, gas stations,shopping centers or other points of interest(POI). After you tell the agent your choiceof destination, its coordinates are sent wire-lessly to your vehicle’s navigation system.(See “Destination Assist” on page 387.)

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Previous Destinations” on the“Destination” screen.

4 Select the screen button of the desireddestination.

The previous starting point and up to 100previously set destinations are displayed onthe screen.

“Delete”: Select to delete the previous des-tination. (To delete previous destinations,see page 88.)When the desired destination is selected,

the “Confirm Destination” screen may bedisplayed. If “Go” is selected on the “Con-firm Destination” screen, the navigationsystem performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.)

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Destination Assist”

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Previous Destinations”

The list of previous destinations can alsobe deleted by selecting “Delete Previ-ous Dest.” on the “Navigation Settings”screen when the vehicle is stopped. (See“DELETING PREVIOUS DESTINA-TIONS” on page 125.)

Page 83: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

83

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Address Book” on the “Destina-tion” screen.

4 Select the screen button of the desiredaddress book entry.

A list of registered address book entries isdisplayed.

“Options”: Select to register or edit addressbook entries. (See page 117.)When the desired address book entry is

selected, the “Confirm Destination” screenmay be displayed. If “Go” is selected on the“Confirm Destination” screen, the naviga-tion system performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.)

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Emergency” on the secondpage of the “Destination” screen.

The display changes to a screen to selectpolice stations, dealers, hospitals or fire sta-tions.

4 Select the desired emergency category.

The selected emergency category is dis-played.

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Address Book”

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Emergency”

Page 84: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

84

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5 Select the screen button of the desireddestination.

When the desired destination is selected,the “Confirm Destination” screen may bedisplayed. If “Go” is selected on the “Con-firm Destination” screen, the navigationsystem performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.)

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Intersection & Freeway” on thesecond page of the “Destination”screen.

4 Select the desired method.INFORMATION

●The navigation system does not guide inareas where route guidance is unavail-able. (See page 145.)

●The emergency function can be usedeven while driving.

●While driving, only the currently dis-played items and the items on the nextpage can be viewed.

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Intersection & Freeway”

There are 2 methods to search a desti-nation by Intersection & Freeway:(a) Search by intersection(b) Search by freeway

Page 85: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

85

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Intersection & Freeway” on thesecond page of the “Destination”screen.

3 Select “Intersection” on the “Intersec-tion & Freeway” screen.

4 Input the name of the first intersectingstreet which is located near the destina-tion to be set, and select “OK”.

5 Select the screen button of the desireditem.

6 Input the name of the second intersect-ing street.

7 Select the screen button of the desireditem.

When the desired item is selected, the“Confirm Destination” screen may be dis-played. If “Go” is selected on the “ConfirmDestination” screen, the navigation systemperforms a search for the route. (See“STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE” onpage 89.)

SEARCH BY “Intersection”

INFORMATION

●If the same 2 streets cross at more than 1intersection, the screen changes and dis-plays the menu to select the city namewhere the streets intersect. Select thecity, and the map location of the selecteddestination and the route preference.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUID-ANCE” on page 89.)

Page 86: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

86

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.

2 Select “Intersection & Freeway” on thesecond page of the “Destination”screen.

3 Select “Freeway Entrance / Exit” onthe “Intersection & Freeway” screen.

4 Input a freeway name.

5 Select the screen button of the desiredfreeway.

6 Select “Entrance” or “Exit”.

7 Input a freeway entrance or exit name,and select “OK”.

8 Select the screen button of the desiredentrance or exit name.

When the desired entrance or exit isselected, the “Confirm Destination” screenmay be displayed. If “Go” is selected on the“Confirm Destination” screen, the naviga-tion system performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.)

SEARCH BY “Freeway Entrance / Exit”

INFORMATION

●Be sure to use the complete name of thefreeway or highway, including the hyphen,when entering the destination. Freewaysand interstates use an “I” (I-405). UShighways use the state designation beforethe number (CA-118).

Page 87: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

87

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Map” on the second page of the“Destination” screen.

4 Scroll the map to the desired point.

5 Select “Go to ”.The navigation system performs a search

for the route. (See “STARTING ROUTEGUIDANCE” on page 89.)

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Coordinates” on the secondpage of the “Destination” screen.

4 Input the latitude and the longitude.

5 After inputting the latitude and longi-tude, select “OK”.

When the desired screen button isselected, the “Confirm Destination” screenmay be displayed. If “Go” is selected on the“Confirm Destination” screen, the naviga-tion system performs a search for the route.(See “STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE”on page 89.)

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Map”

INFORMATION

●Guidance starts if “OK” is selected evenwhile driving. However, the cursor cannotbe moved.

DESTINATION SEARCH BY “Coordinates”

Page 88: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

88

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Del.Dest.” on the “Destination”screen.

When more than 1 destination is set, a listwill be displayed on the screen.

4 Select the destination to be deleted.

“Delete All”: Select to delete all destina-tions on the list.

5 Select “Yes” to delete the destination(s).

A message appears to confirm the requestto delete. If “Yes” is selected, the data cannot be

recovered. If more than 1 destination hasbeen set, the system will recalculate theroute(s) to the set destination(s) as neces-sary. If “No” is selected, the previous screen will

be displayed.

DELETING SET DESTINATIONS

A set destination can be deleted.

Set destinations can also be deleted byselecting “Route”. (See “DELETINGDESTINATIONS” on page 101.)

Page 89: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

89

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

2. STARTING ROUTE GUIDANCE

1 Scroll the map to the desired point.

“Adjust Location”: Select to adjust the posi-tion in smaller increments.

When an arrow facing the desired point isselected, the map scrolls in that direction.The scroll stops when the selection of the

arrow is released.

2 Select “Go to ”.The system starts route search and displays

recommended routes.

3 To start guidance, select “OK”.

When “Map” is selected on the “Con-firm Destination” screen, the mapscreen will be displayed. The map loca-tion of the selected destination can beset as a destination.

If a destination has already been set, “Goto ” and “Add to Route” will be dis-played.

“Go to ”: Select to delete the existingdestination(s) and set a new one.“Add to Route”: Select to add a destina-tion.“Info”: If this screen button is displayed onthe top of the screen, select it to viewitems such as name, address, position andphone number.

No. Function

Current position

Destination point

Type of route and its distance

Distance of the entire route

Select to display a list of the turns re-quired to reach the destination.

Select to change the route. (Seepage 91.)

Select the desired route from 3 pos-sible routes. (See page 90.)

Page 90: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

90

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “3 Routes”.

2 Select “Preferred”, “Alternate” or“Short”.

Guidance can be paused or resumed.(See “PAUSING AND RESUMINGGUIDANCE” on page 106.) If “OK” is selected until a beep sounds,

demo mode will start. Press the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Remote Touch toend demo mode.

CAUTION

● Be sure to obey traffic regulations andkeep road conditions in mind while driv-ing. If a traffic sign on the road has beenchanged, the route guidance may notindicate such changed information.

INFORMATION

●The route for returning may not be thesame as that for going.

●The route guidance to the destinationmay not be the shortest route nor a routewithout traffic congestion.

●Route guidance may not be available ifthere is no road data for the specifiedlocation.

●When setting the destination on a mapwith a scale larger than 0.5 miles (800m), the map scale changes to 0.5 miles(800 m) automatically. If this occurs, setthe destination again.

●If a destination that is not located on aroad is set, the vehicle will be guided tothe point on a road nearest to the destina-tion. The road nearest to the pointselected is set as the destination.

3 ROUTES SELECTION

No. Function

Select to display the recommendedroute.

Select to display the alternativeroute.

Select to display the route that is theshortest distance to the set destina-tion.

Select to display the informationshown below about each of the 3routes.

Page 91: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

91

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Edit Route”.

2 This screen is displayed.

No. Function

Time necessary for the entire trip

Distance of the entire trip

Toll road

Freeway

Ferry

EDIT ROUTE

Conditions for the route to the destina-tion can be set again.

No. Function Page

Select to add destinations. 100

Select to delete destina-tions. 101

Select to reorder destina-tions. 100

Select to display the choic-es available when settingthe conditions the systemuses to determine the routeto the destination.

104

Page 92: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

92

1. DESTINATION SEARCH

RX450h/350_Navi_U

INFORMATION

●Even if the “Freeways” indicator isdimmed, the route cannot avoid includinga freeway in some cases. (See page 104.)

●If the calculated route includes a trip byferry, the route guidance shows a searoute. After you travel by ferry, the cur-rent position may be incorrect. Uponreception of GPS signals, it is automati-cally corrected.

Page 93: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

93

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

1. ROUTE GUIDANCE SCREEN

During route guidance, various types ofguidance screens can be displayed de-pending on conditions.

SCREEN LAYOUT

No. Function

Distance to the next turn and an ar-row indicating the turning direction

Guidance route

Current position

Distance and travel/arrival time tothe destination

Current street name

INFORMATION

●If the vehicle goes off the guidance route,the route is searched again.

●For some areas, the roads have not beencompletely digitized in our database. Forthis reason, the route guidance mayselect a road that should not be traveledon.

●When arriving at the set destination thedestination name will be displayed on thetop of the screen. Selecting “Off” clearsthe display.

●When the head-up display is on, turn-by-turn guidance arrows will be displayed onthe windshield.

DURING FREEWAY DRIVING

During freeway driving, the freeway exitinformation screen will be displayed.This screen displays the distance to thenext junction/exit, or POIs in the vicinityof the freeway exit.

No./Icon Function

Distance from the current position tothe exit or junction

Exit number and junction name

Current position

POIs that are close to a freeway exit

Current street name

Select to display the selected map ofthe exit vicinity.

Select to scroll to farther junctions orexits.

Select to scroll to closer junctions orexits.

Select to display the closest 3 junc-tions or exits.

Page 94: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

94

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

: Select to hide the freeway guidancescreen.Select “Intersection”, or press the “MAP/

VOICE” button on the Remote Touch, tochange back to the freeway guidancescreen.

: Select to hide the intersection guid-ance screen.Select “Intersection”, or press the “MAP/

VOICE” button on the Remote Touch, tochange back to the intersection guidancescreen.

WHEN APPROACHING A FREEWAY EXIT OR JUNCTION

When the vehicle approaches an exit orjunction, the freeway guidance screenwill be displayed.

No. Function

Next street name

Current position

Distance from the current position tothe exit or junction

WHEN APPROACHING AN INTERSECTION

When the vehicle approaches an inter-section, the intersection guidancescreen will be displayed.

No. Function

Next street name

Current position

Distance to the intersection

Page 95: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

95

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

■ TURN LIST SCREEN

1 Select “Turn List” during guidance todisplay the turn list.

■ ARROW SCREEN

1 Select “Turn-by-Turn Arrow” duringguidance to display the arrow screen.

OTHER SCREENS

On this screen, the list of turns on theguidance route can be viewed.

No. Function

Turn direction

Distance between turns

Next street or destination name

Current street name

On this screen, information about thenext turn on the guidance route can beviewed.

No. Function

Exit number or street name

Turn direction

Distance to the next turn

Current street name

Page 96: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

96

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. TYPICAL VOICE GUIDANCE PROMPTS

As the vehicle approaches an intersec-tion, or point, where maneuvering thevehicle is necessary, the system’s voiceguidance will provide various messages.

No. Voice guidance

“Proceed about 5 miles to Mainstreet.”

“In half of a mile, right turn onto Mainstreet.”

“Next right.”/“Right turn ahead.”

(Beep sound only)

INFORMATION

●The street names may not be pro-nounced correctly or clearly due to thetext-to-speech function.

●On freeways, interstates or other high-ways with higher speed limits, the voiceguidance will be made at earlier pointsthan on city streets in order to allow timeto maneuver the vehicle.

0.5 miles5 miles

No. Voice guidance

“Proceed about 4 miles to the trafficcircle.”

“In half of a mile, traffic circle aheadand then the 3rd exit onto Mainstreet.”

“The 3rd exit ahead.”

“The exit ahead.”

(Beep sound only)

4 miles0.5 miles

Page 97: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

97

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

*: The system indicates a U-turn if the dis-tance between 2 one-way roads (of oppo-site directions) is less than 50 ft. (15 m) inresidential areas or 164 ft. (50 m) in non-residential areas.

The system announces the approach to thefinal destination.

No. Voice guidance

“In half of a mile, make a legal U-turn.”

“Make a legal U-turn ahead.”

(Beep sound only)

No. Voice guidance

“In half of a mile, your destination isahead.”

“Your destination is ahead.”

“You have arrived at your destina-tion. The route guidance is now fin-ished.”

If a voice guidance command cannot beheard, press the “MAP/VOICE” buttonon the Remote Touch to hear it again.To adjust the voice guidance volume, see

“VOICE VOLUME” on page 67.

INFORMATION

●If the system cannot determine the cur-rent position correctly (in cases of poorGPS signal reception), the voice guid-ance may be early or late.

Page 98: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

98

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ ROUTES INCLUDING IPD ROADS

After it has made a route calculation, thesystem will advise the user whether IPDroads are included in the route or not.The portion of the route that covers IPD

roads is indicated by light blue.

Even when on IPD roads (roads that arenot completely digitized in our data-base), you will be guided along thesearched route via voice guidance.

No. Voice guidance

“On the way to your destination,there will be roads with incompletedata.”

“In half of a mile, left turn.”

“Next left. Upcoming roads have in-complete data. Please carefully ob-serve the local traffic restrictions, asthey may not match the navigationguidance.”

IPD roads are roads that are not yet com-pletely digitized in our database. How-ever, their geometry, name andadministrative coding are already known.

CAUTION

● Be sure to obey the traffic regulations andkeep the road condition in mind espe-cially when you are driving on IPD roads.The route guidance may not have theupdated information such as the directionof a one way street.

Page 99: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

99

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

3. DISTANCE AND TIME TO DESTINATION

1 Select the screen button indicated bythe arrow.

2 Select the number screen button to dis-play the desired destination.

The distance, estimated travel time andestimated arrival time from the currentposition to the selected destination are dis-played.

When the vehicle is on the guidanceroute, the distance and the estimatedtravel/arrival time to the destination aredisplayed. When the vehicle is not on theguidance route, the distance and direc-tion of the destination are displayed.When driving on the guidance routewith more than 1 destination set, the dis-tance and estimated travel/arrival timefrom the current position to each desti-nation are displayed.

Icon Function

Estimated travel time is dis-played.

Estimated arrival time is dis-played.

Select to switch to estimated ar-rival time.

Select to switch to estimatedtravel time.

Displayed while driving off theguidance route. The destinationdirection is indicated by an arrow.

INFORMATION

●When the vehicle is on the guidanceroute, the distance measured along theroute is displayed. Travel time and arrivaltime are calculated based on the set vehi-cle speed information. (See “DRIVINGSPEEDS” on page 129.) However, whenthe vehicle is not on the guidance route,the distance is the linear distancebetween the current position and thedestination.

Page 100: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

100

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4. SETTING AND DELETING DESTINATIONS

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Add”.

3 Input an additional destination in thesame way as a destination search. (See“DESTINATION SEARCH” on page70.)

4 Select the desired “Add DestinationHere” to insert the new destination intothe route.

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Reorder”.

3 Select the desired destination and se-lect “Move Up” or “Move Down” tochange the arrival order.

4 After selecting the destinations, select“OK”.

The system searches for the guidanceroute again, and displays the entire route.

ADDING DESTINATIONS

Destinations can be added and routescan be searched again.

REORDERING DESTINATIONS

When more than 1 destination is set, thearrival order of the destinations can bechanged.

Page 101: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

101

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Delete”.

When more than 1 destination is set, a listwill be displayed on the screen.

3 Select the destination to be deleted.

“Delete All”: Select to delete all destina-tions on the list.A message appears to confirm the request

to delete.

4 Select “Yes” to delete the destination(s). If “Yes” is selected, the data cannot be

recovered. If more than 1 destination hasbeen set, the system will recalculate theroute(s) to the set destination(s) as neces-sary. If “No” is selected, the previous screen will

be displayed.

DELETING DESTINATIONS

A set destination can be deleted.

Page 102: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

102

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5. SETTING ROUTE

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Detour”.

3 Select a screen button to select the de-sired detour distance.

“1 mile (km)”, “3 miles (km)” or “5 miles(km)”: Select one of these screen buttons tostart the detour process. After detouring,the system returns to the original guidanceroute.“Whole Route”: Select to make the systemcalculate an entire new route to the destina-tion.“Around Traffic”: Select to make the systemsearch for the route based on the trafficcongestion information received from XMNavTraffic®. For details, see “XMNavTraffic®” on page 365.

DETOUR SETTING

While the route guidance is operating,the route can be changed to detouraround a section of the route where adelay is caused by road repairs, or an ac-cident, etc.

INFORMATION

●This picture shows an example of how thesystem would guide around a delaycaused by a traffic jam.

This position indicates the location of atraffic jam caused by road repairs, an ac-cident, etc.

This route indicates the detour suggest-ed by the system.

●When the vehicle is on a freeway, thedetour distance selections are 5, 15 and25 miles (or 5, 15 and 25 km if units arein km).

●The system may not be able to calculate adetour route depending on the selecteddistance and surrounding road condi-tions.

Page 103: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

103

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Overview”.

3 The entire route from the current posi-tion to the destination is displayed.

1 Select or to skip to the next page

of the list of roads. Select and hold or

to scroll through the list of roads.

: This mark indicates the direction inwhich you should turn at the intersection.“Map”: The selected point is displayed onthe map screen.

ROUTE OVERVIEW

No. Function

Select to display a list of the turns re-quired to reach the destination.

Select to start guidance.

TURN LIST

INFORMATION

●However, not all road names in the routemay appear on the list. If a road changesits name without requiring a turn (such ason a street that runs through 2 or morecities), the name change will not appearon the list. The street names will be dis-played in order from the starting point,along with the distance to the next turn.

Page 104: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

104

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Preferences”.

3 Select “Preferred”, “Short” or “Alter-nate” and select “OK”.

4 The entire route from the starting pointto the destination is displayed.

“OK”: Select to start guidance.

1 Select “Route”.

ROUTE PREFERENCE

TO SELECT ROUTE TYPE

The Preferred, Short or Alternativeroute can be selected.

“Edit Route”: Select to change a route.(See page 91.)

TO SELECT ROUTE FEATURES

A number of choices are available whensetting the conditions the system uses todetermine the route to the destination.

Page 105: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

105

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

2 Select “Preferences” to display condi-tions that can be selected when the sys-tem determines the route to thedestination.

3 Select the desired route preferences.

The system will avoid using routes thatinclude items whose indicators are off.

4 After selecting the desired route prefer-ence, select “OK”.

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Preferences”.

3 Select “Start from Adjacent Road”.

STARTING ROUTE FROM ADJACENT ROAD

The route guidance can be started froman adjacent road.(e.g. When route guidance is set on thefreeway, but the vehicle is driven parallelalong the freeway.)

INFORMATION

●When there is no adjacent road, thisscreen button will not be displayed.

Page 106: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

106

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Pause Guidance”.

The screen will return to the current posi-tion map without route guidance.

1 Select “Route”.

2 Select “Resume Guidance”.

The map screen, with the current positiondisplayed, will be returned to.

PAUSING AND RESUMING GUIDANCE

TO PAUSE GUIDANCE

INFORMATION

●Without route guidance, “Pause Guid-ance” cannot be used.

TO RESUME GUIDANCE

Page 107: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

107

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Select “Show on Map”.

2 Select “Select POI” to display a partic-ular type of POI icon on the screen.

When the POI icons to be displayed on themap screen have already been set,“Change POI” is displayed.

A screen with a limited choice of POIs willbe displayed. (To change the displayed POIlist, see page 132.)

1 Select the desired POI category to dis-play POI location icons on the mapscreen.

By selecting the desired POI category andthen selecting “OK”, the selected POIicons are displayed on the map screen.To turn off the POI icons on the map

screen, select “Clear”.“Other POIs”: Select to display other POIscategories if the desired POIs cannot befound on the limited choice screen.“Find Local POI”: Select to search for thenearest POIs. Then select one of the cate-gories. The system will list the points within20 miles (32 km). (See page 108.)

2 Select “Other POIs” on the “Select POIIcons” screen.

When a POI category is selected fromeither the limited list or the complete list,the icons of those locations will be dis-played on the map screen.

SHOW ON MAP

DISPLAY POI ICONS

POI icons such as gas stations and res-taurants can be displayed on the mapscreen. Their location can also be set asa destination and used for route guid-ance.

SELECTING POI ICONS TO BE DISPLAYED

Up to 5 categories of icons can be dis-played on the map screen.

Page 108: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

108

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3 Select the desired POI categories.

The selected category’s icon will appear onthe top left of the screen.By selecting the desired POI category and

then selecting “OK”, the selected POIicons are displayed on the map screen. If the desired POI category is not on the

screen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories.

Select the desired POI categories from thelist.• The selected category icon appears on

the top left of the screen.• By selecting the desired POI category

and then selecting “OK”, the selectedPOI icons are displayed on the mapscreen.

• To return to the POI category selectionscreen, select “More”.

1 Select “Find Local POI”.

2 Select the screen button of the desiredPOI.

The selected POIs are displayed on themap screen.

“Near...”: Select to search for POIs near thecurrent position or along the route.

TO DISPLAY THE LOCAL POI LIST

Points of Interest that are within 20miles (32 km) of the current position willbe listed from among the selected cate-gories.

Page 109: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

109

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Directly select the desired POI icon toset it as a destination.

The map will shift so that the icon is cen-tered on the screen and overlaps with thecursor . At this time, the distance fromthe current position is displayed on thescreen. The distance shown is measured asa straight line from the current position tothe POI.

2 When the desired POI overlaps with thecursor, select “Enter ”.

The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination androute preference. (See “STARTINGROUTE GUIDANCE” on page 89.)

1 Select “Show on Map”.

2 Select “POI Icons”.

The “POI Icons” indicator is dimmed.The map screen will be displayed with the

POI icons hidden.To display the POI icons again, select “POI

Icons” on the “Show on Map” screen.

No. Function

Select to display the list of POIs nearthe current position.

Select to display the list of POIsalong the route.

TO SET A POI AS A DESTINATION

One of the Point of Interest icons can beselected on the map screen as a destina-tion and can be used for route guidance.

TO HIDE POI ICONS

Page 110: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

110

2. ROUTE GUIDANCE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Show on Map”.

2 Select “Route Trace”.

The “Route Trace” indicator is highlighted.

1 Select “Show on Map”.

2 Select “Route Trace”.

Selecting “Yes” stops recording and theroute trace remains displayed on thescreen.Selecting “No” stops recording and the

route trace is erased.

ROUTE TRACE

Up to 124 miles (200 km) of the trav-eled route can be stored and retracedon the display.

INFORMATION

●This feature is available when the mapscale is more than 30 miles (50 km).

TO START RECORDING THE ROUTE TRACE

TO STOP RECORDING THE ROUTE TRACE

Page 111: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

111

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

3. ADDRESS BOOK

1. NAVIGATION SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Navigation”.

4 Select the desired items to be set.

On this screen, the following operationscan be performed:

Points or areas on the map can be regis-tered.The registered points can be used on the“Destination” screen. (See “DESTINA-TION SEARCH BY HOME” on page71, and “DESTINATION SEARCH BY“Address Book”” on page 83.)Registered areas to avoid, will be avoid-ed when the system searches for a route.

No. Function Page

Select to set home. 112

Select to set preset destina-tions. 114

Select to set the addressbook. 116

Select to set areas to avoid. 121

Select to delete previousdestinations. 125

Select to set detailed navi-gation settings. 127

Page 112: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

112

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Home”.

5 Select the desired screen button.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Home” on the “Navigation Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Set Home”.

5 Select the desired screen button andenter the location in the same way as fora destination search. (See “DESTINA-TION SEARCH” on page 70.)

When registration of home is completed,the “Edit Home” screen will be displayed.

6 Select “OK”.

SETTING UP THE “Home”

If home has been registered, that infor-mation can be recalled by selecting “GoHome” on the “Destination” screen.(See “DESTINATION SEARCH BYHOME” on page 71.)

No. Function Page

Registering home 112

Editing home 113

Deleting home 113

REGISTERING HOME

To edit registered information, see“EDITING HOME” on page 113.

Page 113: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

113

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Home” on the “Navigation Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Edit”.

5 Select “Edit” next to the item to be edit-ed.

“Show Name on Map”: The name of a homecan be set to be displayed on the map by se-lecting “On” or “Off”. (See page 119.)

6 Select “OK”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Home” on the “Navigation Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Delete”.

5 Select “Yes” to delete home and select“No” to cancel the deletion.

EDITING HOME

No. Function Page

Select to edit the homename. The name can be dis-played on the map.

119

Select to edit location infor-mation. 119

Select to edit the phonenumber. 120

Select to change the icon tobe displayed on the map. 118

DELETING HOME

Page 114: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

114

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Preset Destinations”.

5 Select the desired screen button.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Preset Destinations” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Set”.

5 Select the desired screen button andenter the location in the same way as fora destination search. (See “DESTINA-TION SEARCH” on page 70.)

SETTING UP THE “Preset Destinations”

If preset destination has been regis-tered, that information can be recalledby using “Preset Destinations” on the“Navigation Settings” screen. (See“DESTINATION SEARCH BY PRE-SET DESTINATIONS” on page 71.)

No. Function Page

Registering a preset desti-nation 114

Editing a preset destination 115

Deleting a preset destina-tion 116

REGISTERING PRESET DESTINATIONS

Page 115: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

115

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

6 Select a position for this preset destina-tion.

When registration of a preset destination iscompleted, the “Edit Preset Destination”screen will be displayed.

7 Select “OK”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Preset Destinations” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Edit”.

5 Select the screen button of the desiredpreset destination.

6 Select “Edit” next to the item to be edit-ed.

“Show Name on Map”: The name of a pre-set destination can be set to be displayed onthe map by selecting “On” or “Off”. (Seepage 119.)

7 Select “OK”.

To edit registered information, see“EDITING PRESET DESTINATIONS”on page 115.

EDITING PRESET DESTINATIONS No. Function Page

Select to edit the presetdestination name. Thename can be displayed onthe map.

119

Select to edit location infor-mation. 119

Select to edit the phonenumber. 120

Select to change the icon tobe displayed on the map. 118

Page 116: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

116

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Preset Destinations” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Delete”.

5 Select the preset destination to be de-leted.

6 Select “Delete”.

7 Select “Yes” to delete the preset desti-nation and select “No” to cancel the de-letion.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Address Book”.

5 Select the desired screen button.

DELETING PRESET DESTINATIONS

Screen button Function

“Select All” Select all preset destina-tions.

“Unselect All” Select to cancel the“Select All” function.

SETTING UP THE “Address Book”

Points or areas on the map can be regis-tered.

No. Function Page

Registering address bookentries 117

Editing address book en-tries 117

Deleting address book en-tries 120

Page 117: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

117

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Address Book” on the “Naviga-tion Settings” screen.

4 Select “New”.

5 Select the desired screen button andenter the location in the same way as fora destination search. (See “DESTINA-TION SEARCH” on page 70.)

After the address book entry has been reg-istered, the “Edit Address Book Entry”screen will be displayed.

6 Select “OK”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Address Book” on the “Naviga-tion Settings” screen.

4 Select “Edit”.

5 Select the screen button of the desiredaddress book entry.

REGISTERING ADDRESS BOOK ENTRIES

To edit registered information, see“EDITING ADDRESS BOOKENTRIES” on page 117.

INFORMATION

● Up to 100 address book entries can beregistered.

EDITING ADDRESS BOOK ENTRIES

The icon, name, location and/or phonenumber of a registered address bookentry can be edited.

Page 118: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

118

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Select “Edit” next to the item to be edit-ed.

“Show Name on Map”: The name of an ad-dress book entry can be set to be displayedon the map by selecting “On” or “Off”. (Seepage 119.)

7 Select “OK”.

■ TO CHANGE “Icon”

1 Select “Edit”.

2 Select the desired icon.

Change pages by selecting the “Page 1”,“Page 2” or “With Sound” tab.

■ SOUND ICONS

1 Select the “With Sound” tab on the “Ad-dress Book Entry Icon” screen.

2 Select the desired sound icon.

The next screen appears when “Bell (withDirection)” is selected.

No. Function Page

Select to edit the addressbook entry name. Thename can be displayed onthe map.

119

Select to edit location infor-mation. 119

Select to edit the phonenumber. 120

Select to change the icon tobe displayed on the map. 118

A sound for some address book entriescan be set. When the vehicle approach-es the location of the address book en-try, the selected sound will be heard.

Page 119: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

119

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

3 Select either or to adjust the di-rection. Then select “OK”.

■ TO CHANGE “Name”

1 Select “Edit”.

2 Enter the name using the alphanumerickeys.

Up to 70 characters can be entered.

3 Select “OK”. The previous screen will be displayed.

■ DISPLAYING ADDRESS BOOKENTRY NAMES

1 Select “On” to display the name on themap and select “Off” to not display it.

■ TO CHANGE “Location”

1 Select “Edit”.

2 Select one of the 8 directional screenbuttons to move the cursor to the de-sired point on the map.

3 Select “OK”. The previous screen will be displayed.

INFORMATION

● The bell sounds only when the vehicleapproaches this point in the direction thathas been set.

Page 120: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

120

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ TO CHANGE “Phone #” (PHONE NUMBER)

1 Select “Edit”.

2 Enter the number using the numberkeys.

3 Select “OK”. The previous screen will be displayed.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Address Book” on the “Naviga-tion Settings” screen.

4 Select “Delete”.

5 Select the address to be deleted.

6 Select “Delete”.

7 Select “Yes” to delete the address bookentries and select “No” to cancel the de-letion.

DELETING ADDRESS BOOK ENTRIES

Screen button Function

“Select All” Select all registered ad-dresses.

“Unselect All” Select to cancel the“Select All” function.

Page 121: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

121

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Areas to Avoid”.

5 Select the desired screen button.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Areas to Avoid” on the “Naviga-tion Settings” screen.

4 Select “New”.

5 Select the desired screen button andenter the location in the same way as fora destination search, or display the mapof the area to be avoided. (See “DESTI-NATION SEARCH” on page 70.)

SETTING UP THE “Areas to Avoid”

Areas to be avoided because of trafficjams, construction work or other rea-sons can be registered as areas to avoid.

No. Function Page

Registering areas to avoid 121

Editing areas to avoid 122

Deleting areas to avoid 125

REGISTERING AREAS TO AVOID

Page 122: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

122

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Scroll the map to the desired point.

“Adjust Location”: Select to adjust the posi-tion in smaller increments.

7 Select “Enter”.

8 Select either or to change thesize of the area to be avoided.

9 Select “OK”.When registration of an area to avoid is

completed, the “Area to Avoid” screen willbe displayed.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Areas to Avoid” on the “Naviga-tion Settings” screen.

4 Select “Edit”.

5 Select the area to be avoided.

INFORMATION

● If a destination is input in the area to avoidor the route calculation cannot be madewithout running through the area toavoid, a route passing through the area tobe avoided may be shown.

● Up to 10 locations can be registered aspoints/areas to avoid.

EDITING AREA TO AVOID

The name, location and/or area size of aregistered area can be edited.

Page 123: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

123

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

6 Select “Edit” next to the item to be edit-ed.

“Show Name on Map”: The name of an areato be avoided can be set to be displayed onthe map by selecting “On” or “Off”. (Seepage 123.)“Active”: The area to avoid feature can beset to “On” or “Off”.

7 Select “OK”.

■ TO CHANGE “Name”

1 Select “Edit”.

2 Enter the name using the alphanumerickeys.

Up to 70 characters can be entered.

3 Select “OK”. The previous screen will be displayed.

■ DISPLAYING NAMES OF AREASTO BE AVOIDED

1 Select “On”, next to “Show Name onMap”, to display the name of an area tobe avoided on the map. Select “Off” notto display it.

No. Function Page

Select to edit the name ofthe area to avoid. The namecan be displayed on themap.

123

Select to edit area location. 124

Select to edit area size. 124

Page 124: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

124

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ TO CHANGE “Location”

1 Select “Edit”.

2 Select one of the 8 directional screenbuttons to move the cursor to the de-sired point on the map.

3 Select “OK”. The previous screen will be displayed.

■ TO CHANGE “Size”

1 Select “Edit”.

2 Select either or to change thesize of the area to be avoided.

3 Select “OK”. The previous screen will be displayed.

Page 125: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

125

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Areas to Avoid” on the “Naviga-tion Settings” screen.

4 Select “Delete”.

5 Select the area to be deleted.

6 Select “Delete”.

7 Select “Yes” to delete the area(s) andselect “No” to cancel the deletion.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Delete Previous Dest.”.

5 Select the previous destination to be de-leted.

DELETING AREAS TO AVOID

Screen button Function

“Select All” Select all registered ar-eas to avoid.

“Unselect All” Select to cancel the“Select All” function.

DELETING PREVIOUS DESTINATIONS

Previous destinations can be deleted.

Page 126: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

126

3. ADDRESS BOOK

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Select “Delete”.

7 Select “Yes” to delete the destination(s)and select “No” to cancel the deletion.

Screen button Function

“Select All” Select all previous desti-nations.

“Unselect All” Select to cancel the“Select All” function.

Page 127: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

127

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

4. SETUP

1. DETAILED NAVIGATION SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Navigation”.

4 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings”.

5 Select the items to be set.

6 Select “Save”.

Settings are available for driving speeds,favorite POI categories, automaticscreen change, “ Off” function, etc.

Page 128: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

128

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed:

SCREENS FOR NAVIGATION SETTINGS

No. Function

Select to set the average drivingspeed. (See “DRIVING SPEEDS”on page 129.)

Select to set the automatic inputfunction to “On” or “Off”.

Select to set the voice guidance forthe next street name to “On” or“Off” during route guidance.

Select to set the automatic reroute ofthe guidance route to avoid heavycongestion to “On” or “Off”. (See“AUTO AVOID TRAFFIC” on page130.)

Select to set the indication of freelyflowing traffic by the arrow to “On”or “Off”. (See “SHOW FREEFLOWING TRAFFIC” on page 131.)

Select to set displayed POI icon cat-egories. (See “POI CATEGORYCHANGE (SELECT POI ICONS)”on page 132.)

Select to set screen buttons to bedisplayed on the map screen when“Off” is selected. (See“SCREEN LAYOUT FUNCTION(“Off” Function)” on page 133.)

Page 129: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

129

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

To reset all setup items, select “Default”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Driving Speeds”.

5 Select “ ” or “ ” to set the average ve-hicle speeds for “Residential”, “MainStreets” and “Freeways”.

To set the default speeds, select “Default”.To use settings based on traffic information,

select “Consider Traffic Info.”.

6 After setting of the desired speeds iscompleted, select “Save”.

Select to adjust the current positionmark manually. Miscalculation of thedistance caused by tire replacementcan also be adjusted. (See “CUR-RENT POSITION/TIRE CHANGECALIBRATION” on page 134.)

Select to set the display of pop-up in-formation to “On” or “Off”. (See“POP-UP INFORMATION” onpage 135.)

Select to set IPD road guidance to“On” or “Off”. (For information onIPD roads, see page 98.)

No. Function DRIVING SPEEDS

The speed that is used for the calculationof the estimated travel time and estimat-ed arrival time can be set.

Page 130: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

130

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Avoid Traffic”.

INFORMATION

●The displayed time to the destination isthe approximate driving time that is cal-culated based on the selected speedsand the actual position along the guid-ance route.

●The time shown on the screen may varygreatly depending on progress along theroute, which may be affected by condi-tions such as traffic jams and constructionwork.

●Up to 99 hours 59 minutes can be dis-played.

AUTO AVOID TRAFFIC

The guidance route automaticallychanges to another route to avoid heavycongestion when “Avoid Traffic” isturned on.

Page 131: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

131

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

5 Select “On” or “Off”.

6 Select “Save”.When congestion information about the

guidance route has been received, ascreen will appear to ask if it is desirable toreroute to avoid the congestion.Select “Yes” to reroute. Another route to

avoid the congestion will appear.Select “No” if it is not desirable to reroute.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Show Free Flowing Traffic”.

5 Select “On” or “Off”.

6 Select “Save”.

INFORMATION

●When the “Traffic Information” indicatoris dimmed, “Avoid Traffic”, “Traffic IncidentWarning” and “Show Free Flowing Traffic”will not operate. (See page 366.)

SHOW FREE FLOWING TRAFFIC

Free flowing traffic can be shown by anarrow when “Show Free FlowingTraffic” is turned on.

INFORMATION

●When the “Traffic Information” indicatoris dimmed, “Avoid Traffic”, “Traffic IncidentWarning” and “Show Free Flowing Traffic”will not operate.

Page 132: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

132

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Favorite POI Categories”.

5 Select the category to be changed.

6 Select the desired group.

If the desired POI category is not on thescreen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories.

7 Select the desired category.

The screen returns to the “Favorite POICategories” screen.

8 Select “OK”.

POI CATEGORY CHANGE (SELECT POI ICONS)

Select up to 6 POI icons to be displayedon the map screen.

Page 133: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

133

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “ “Off” Function”.

5 Select the screen buttons to be turnedoff. The selected screen buttons will bedimmed.

To set the setting as a default, select“Default”.

6 Select “OK”.The previous screen will be displayed.

7 Select “Save”.

SCREEN LAYOUT FUNCTION (“Off” Function)

Each screen button and current streetname on the map screen can be dis-played or hidden.

Page 134: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

134

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Calibration”.

5 Select the desired screen button.

■ POSITION/DIRECTION CALI-BRATION

1 Select “Position / Direction”.

2 Select one of the 8 directional screenbuttons to move the cursor to the de-sired point on the map.

3 Select “OK”.

CURRENT POSITION/TIRE CHANGE CALIBRATION

The current position mark can be adjust-ed manually. Miscalculation of the dis-tance caused by tire replacement canalso be adjusted.

For additional information on the accu-racy of a current position, see “LIMITA-TIONS OF THE NAVIGATIONSYSTEM” on page 144.

When driving, the current position markwill be automatically corrected by GPSsignals. If GPS reception is poor due tolocation, the current position mark canbe adjusted manually.

Page 135: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

135

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

4 Select either or to adjust the di-rection of the current position mark.

5 Select “OK”.The map will be displayed.

■ TIRE CHANGE CALIBRATION

1 To perform the distance calibration pro-cedure, select “Tire Change”.

The message appears and the quick dis-tance calibration is automatically started. Afew seconds later, a map will be displayed.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Navigation” on the “Setup”screen.

3 Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4 Select “Pop-up Information”.

5 Select “On” or “Off”.

6 Select “Save”.When “Pop-up Information” is turned off,

the following messages will not be dis-played.

The tire change calibration function willbe used when replacing the tires. Thisfunction will adjust miscalculationcaused by the circumference differencebetween the old and new tires.

INFORMATION

●If this procedure is not performed whenthe tires are replaced, the current posi-tion mark may be incorrectly displayed.

POP-UP INFORMATION

When “Pop-up Information” is turnedon, pop-up information will be displayed.

Page 136: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

136

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

This message appears when the mapscale is over 0.5 miles (800 m).

This message appears when the map isswitched to dual map screen mode.

Page 137: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

137

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

2. VEHICLE SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Vehicle”.

4 Select “Maintenance”.

5 Select the desired screen button.

Setting maintenance information. (Seepage 138.)Setting dealer. (See page 140.)

MAINTENANCE

When the navigation system is turnedon, the “Maintenance Reminder” screendisplays when it is time to replace a partor certain components. (See page 33.)

Page 138: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

138

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Maintenance” on the “VehicleSettings” screen.

4 Select the desired screen button.

When the vehicle needs to be serviced, thescreen button color will change to orange.

MAINTENANCE INFORMATION SETTING

Screen button Function

“Engine oil” Replace engine oil

“Oil filter” Replace engine oil filter

“Rotation” Rotate tires

“Tires” Replace tires

“Battery” Replace 12-volt battery

“Brake pad” Replace brake pads

“Wipers” Replace wiper blades

“Coolant” Replace coolant

“Brake oil” Replace brake fluid

“Trans. fluid” Replace transmission flu-id

“Service” Scheduled maintenance

“Air filter” Replace air filter

“Personal”New information itemscan be created separatelyfrom provided ones.

“Delete All”Select to cancel all condi-tions which have been in-put.

“Reset All”Select to reset the itemwhich has satisfied a con-dition.

Page 139: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

139

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

5 Input the conditions.

6 Select “OK”.The screen then returns to the “Mainte-

nance” screen.

“Set Dealer”

Select to register dealerinformation. (See “DEAL-ER SETTING” on page140.)

“Dealer Info.”Select to edit dealer infor-mation. (See “DEALERSETTING” on page 140.)

“Reminder”

When this screen buttonis selected, the indicator isilluminated. The system isset to give maintenanceinformation with the“Maintenance Reminder”screen. (See page 33.)

Screen button Function

No. Function

Select to input the next maintenancedate.

Select to input the driving distanceuntil the next maintenance check.

Select to cancel the date and distanceconditions.

Select to reset the date and distanceconditions.

INFORMATION

●For scheduled maintenance information,refer to “Warranty and Services Guide/Owner’s Manual Supplement/ScheduledMaintenance”.

●Depending on driving or road conditions,the actual date and distance maintenanceshould be performed may differ from thestored date and distance in the system.

Page 140: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

140

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Maintenance” on the “VehicleSettings” screen.

4 Select “Set Dealer”.

5 If a dealer has not been registered, enterthe location of a dealer in the same wayas for a destination search. (See “DES-TINATION SEARCH” on page 70.)

When “Set Dealer” registration is finished,the “Dealer” screen is displayed.

6 Select “Edit” next to the item to be edit-ed.

DEALER SETTING

Dealer information can be registered inthe system. With dealer information reg-istered, route guidance to the dealer isavailable.

No. Function Page

Select to enter the name ofa dealer. 141

Select to enter the name ofa dealer member. 141

Select to set the location. 141

Select to enter the phonenumber. 142

Select to delete the dealerinformation displayed onthe screen.

Select to set the displayeddealer as a destination. 89

Page 141: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

141

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

■ TO EDIT “Dealer” OR “Contact”

1 Select “Edit” next to “Dealer” or “Con-tact”.

2 Enter the name using the alphanumerickeys.

Up to 70 characters can be entered fordealer and 24 characters for contact.

3 Select “OK”.The previous screen will be displayed.

■ TO EDIT “Location”

1 Select “Edit” next to “Location”.

2 Select one of the 8 directional screenbuttons to move the cursor to the de-sired point on the map screen.

3 Select “OK”.The previous screen will be displayed.

Page 142: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

142

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ TO EDIT “Phone #” (PHONE NUMBER)

1 Select “Edit” next to “Phone #”.

2 Enter the number using number keys.

3 Select “OK”.The previous screen will be displayed.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup” screen.

4 Select “Vehicle Customization”.

5 Select the desired items to be set.For a list of the settings that can be

changed, refer to “Owner’s Manual”.

6 After changing the settings, select“Save”. A message indicating that thesettings are being saved will appear. Donot perform any other operations whilethis message is displayed.

VEHICLE CUSTOMIZATION

Vehicle settings can be changed.

Page 143: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

143

4. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

CAUTION

● When performing the customization pro-cedure, ensure that there is sufficient ven-tilation in the vehicle and surroundingarea. If there is insufficient ventilation,exhaust gases may collect and enter thevehicle. Exhaust gases include harmfulcarbon monoxide (CO) and inhalingthem may lead to death or a serioushealth hazard.

INFORMATION

●To avoid discharging the 12-volt battery,perform the customization procedurewith the hybrid system operating <theengine running>.

Page 144: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

144

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5. GPS (GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM)

1. LIMITATIONS OF THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM

The Global Positioning System (GPS) de-veloped and operated by the U.S. Depart-ment of Defense provides an accuratecurrent position, normally using 4 or moresatellites, and in some case 3 satellites. TheGPS system has a certain level of inaccura-cy. While the navigation system will com-pensate for this most of the time, occasionalpositioning errors of up to 300 ft. (100 m)can and should be expected. Generally, po-sition errors will be corrected within a fewseconds.

When the vehicle is receiving signals fromsatellites, the “GPS” mark appears at thetop left of the screen.The GPS signal may be physically obstruct-ed, leading to inaccurate vehicle position onthe map screen. Tunnels, tall buildings,trucks, or even the placement of objects onthe instrument panel may obstruct the GPSsignals.The GPS satellites may not send signals dueto repairs or improvements being made tothem.Even when the navigation system is receiv-ing clear GPS signals, the vehicle positionmay not be shown accurately or inappropri-ate route guidance may occur in some cas-es.

This navigation system calculates thecurrent position using satellite signals,various vehicle signals, map data, etc.However, an accurate position may notbe shown depending on satellite condi-tions, road configuration, vehicle condi-tion or other circumstances.

NOTICE

● The installation of window tinting mayobstruct the GPS signals. Most windowtinting contains some metallic contentthat will interfere with GPS signal recep-tion of the antenna in the instrumentpanel. We advise against the use of win-dow tinting on vehicles equipped withnavigation systems.

Page 145: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

145

5. GPS (GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM)

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3

NA

VIG

ATIO

N SY

STEM

Accurate current position may not beshown in the following cases:• When driving on a small angled Y-shaped

road.• When driving on a winding road.• When driving on a slippery road such as

in sand, gravel, snow, etc.• When driving on a long straight road.• When freeway and surface streets run in

parallel.• After moving by ferry or vehicle carrier.• When a long route is searched during

high speed driving.• When driving without setting the current

position calibration correctly.• After repeating a change of direction by

going forward and backward, or turningon a turntable in a parking lot.

• When leaving a covered parking lot orparking garage.

• When a roof carrier is installed.• When driving with tire chains installed.• When the tires are worn.• After replacing a tire or tires.• When using tires that are smaller or

larger than the factory specifications.• When the tire pressure in any of the 4

tires is not correct.

Inappropriate route guidance may occur inthe following cases:• When turning at an intersection off the

designated route guidance.• If you set more than 1 destination but skip

any of them, auto reroute will display aroute returning to the destination on theprevious route.

• When turning at an intersection for whichthere is no route guidance.

• When passing through an intersection forwhich there is no route guidance.

• During auto reroute, the route guidancemay not be available for the next turn tothe right or left.

• During high speed driving, it may take along time for auto reroute to operate. Inauto reroute, a detour route may beshown.

• After auto reroute, the route may not bechanged.

• If an unnecessary U-turn is shown orannounced.

• If a location has multiple names and thesystem announces 1 or more of them.

• When a route cannot be searched.• If the route to your destination includes

gravel, unpaved roads or alleys, the routeguidance may not be shown.

• Your destination point might be shown onthe opposite side of the street.

• When a portion of the route has regula-tions prohibiting the entry of the vehiclethat vary by time or season or other rea-sons.

• The road and map data stored in the navi-gation system may not be complete ormay not be the latest version.

If the vehicle cannot receive GPS signals,the current position can be adjustedmanually. For information on setting thecurrent position calibration, see page134.

After replacing a tire, implement theoperation described in “TIRE CHANGECALIBRATION”. (See page 135.)

Page 146: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

146

5. GPS (GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM)

RX450h/350_Navi_U

INFORMATION

● This navigation system uses tire turningdata and is designed to work with factory-specified tires for the vehicle. Installingtires that are larger or smaller than theoriginally equipped diameter may causeinaccurate display of the current position.The tire pressure also affects the diame-ter of the tires, so make sure that the tirepressure of all 4 tires is correct.

Page 147: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

4

147

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. QUICK REFERENCE ............................ 148

2. PHONE (HANDS-FREE SYSTEM FOR CELLULAR PHONE) .......................... 150

USING THE PHONE SWITCH......................... 151

USING THE STEERING SWITCHES............ 152

ABOUT THE PHONEBOOK IN THIS SYSTEM .................................................. 153

WHEN SELLING OR DISPOSING OF THE VEHICLE ............................................... 153

3. REGISTER A Bluetooth® PHONE..... 156

CONNECTING A Bluetooth® PHONE ..... 158

RECONNECTING THE Bluetooth® PHONE............................................ 160

4. CALL ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE ............................... 161

BY DIAL......................................................................... 161

BY PHONEBOOK .................................................. 161

BY SPEED DIAL ....................................................... 163

BY CALL HISTORY ............................................... 163

BY VOICE RECOGNITION............................. 165

CALLING USING AN SMS/MMS MESSAGE .................................................. 167

BY POI* CALL .......................................................... 167

5. RECEIVE ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE ............................. 168

6. TALK ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE ............................. 169

WHEN YOU SELECT “0-9” .............................. 169

INCOMING CALL WAITING........................... 171

7. Bluetooth® PHONE MESSAGE FUNCTION............................................. 172

CHECKING MESSAGES ................................... 172

REPLYING (QUICK REPLY) ............................ 173

NEW MESSAGE NOTIFICATION................ 174

1. PHONE SETTINGS................................. 175

PHONE SOUND SETTINGS............................ 175

PHONEBOOK......................................................... 177

MESSAGE SETTINGS .......................................... 190

PHONE DISPLAY SETTINGS .......................... 194

2. Bluetooth® SETTINGS ........................... 197

REGISTERED DEVICES ...................................... 197

SELECTING A Bluetooth® PHONE............ 202

SELECTING PORTABLE PLAYER.............. 203

DETAILED Bluetooth® SETTINGS ............... 205

1 PHONE OPERATION

2 SETUP

PHONE

*: Point of Interest

Page 148: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

148

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. PHONE OPERATION

1. QUICK REFERENCE

Bluetooth® phones can be operated via the navigation system’s screen. To display thehands-free operation screen, press the “MENU” button on the Remote Touch andthen select “Phone”, or the switch on the steering wheel.

Page 149: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

149

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No. Name Function

The condition of Bluetooth® connection

No connection GoodAn antenna for the Bluetooth® connection is built in the instrumentpanel. The condition of the Bluetooth® connection may deteriorateand the system may not function when a Bluetooth® phone is used inthe following conditions and/or places: The cellular phone is obstructed by certain objects (such as when

it is behind the seat or in the glove box and console box). The cellular phone touches or is covered with metal materials.Leave the Bluetooth® phone in a place where the condition of theBluetooth® connection is good.When the cellular phone is not connected, “No Connect” is dis-played.

The amount ofbattery chargeleft

Empty FullThis is not displayed when the Bluetooth® is not connected.The amount displayed does not always correspond with the amountdisplayed on the cellular phone. The amount of battery charge leftmay not be displayed depending on the type of phone you have. Thissystem does not have a charging function.

The receiving area

“Rm” is displayed when receiving in a roaming area.The receiving area may not be displayed depending on the type ofphone you have.

The level of reception

Poor ExcellentThe level of reception does not always correspond with the level dis-played on the cellular phone. The level of reception may not be dis-played depending on the phone you have.When the cellular phone is out of the service area or in a place inac-cessible by radio waves, “No Service” is displayed.

Page 150: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

150

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. PHONE (HANDS-FREE SYSTEM FOR CELLULAR PHONE)

*: This profile is necessary when usingApps. (See “APPS” on page 380.)

The hands-free system enables calls tobe made and received without having totake your hands off the steering wheel.

This system supports Bluetooth®.Bluetooth® is a wireless data systemthat enables cellular phones to be usedwithout being connected by a cable orplaced in a cradle.The operating procedure of the phone isexplained here.

For registering and setting of the phone,see “PHONE SETTINGS” on page 175and “Bluetooth® SETTINGS” on page197.

CAUTION

●While driving, do not use a cellular phoneor connect the Bluetooth® phone.

●An antenna for the Bluetooth® connec-tion is built in the instrument panel. Peo-ple with implanted pacemakers orcardiac defibrillators should maintain areasonable distance between them-selves and the Bluetooth® antennas. Theradio waves may affect the operation ofsuch devices.

●Before using cellular phones, users of anyelectrical medical device other thanimplanted pacemakers and implantedcardiac defibrillators should consult themanufacturer of the device for informa-tion about its operation under the influ-ence of radio waves. Radio waves couldhave unexpected effects on the operationof such medical devices.

NOTICE

● Do not leave your cellular phone in thevehicle. The temperature inside may riseto a level that could damage the phone.

INFORMATION

●If your cellular phone does not supportBluetooth®, this system cannot function.

●In the following conditions, the systemmay not function:• The cellular phone is turned off.• The current position is outside the com-

munication area.• The cellular phone is not connected.• The cellular phone has a low battery.

●When using Bluetooth® audio andhands-free at the same time, the followingproblems may occur:

• The Bluetooth® connection may be cut.

• Noise may be heard on the Bluetooth®

audio playback.●This system supports the following ser-

vices:

• Bluetooth® SpecificationVer. 1.1 or higher(Recommended: Ver. 2.1 + EDR orhigher)

• ProfilesHFP (Hands Free Profile)Ver. 1.0 or higher(Recommended: Ver. 1.5 or higher)OPP (Object Push Profile)Ver. 1.1 or higherPBAP (Phone Book Access Profile)Ver. 1.0 or higherMAP (Message Access Profile)Ver. 1.0 or higherSPP (Serial Port Profile)Ver. 1.1 or higher*

Page 151: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

151

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

The microphone can be used when talkingon the phone.

INFORMATION

●If your cellular phone does not supportHFP, registering the Bluetooth® phoneor using OPP, PBAP, MAP or SPP pro-files individually will not be possible.

●If the connected Bluetooth® phone ver-sion is older than recommended orincompatible, this function may not beused.

●Refer to http://www.lexus.com/ to findapproved Bluetooth® phones for this sys-tem.

USING THE PHONE SWITCH

By pressing the phone switch, a call canbe received or ended without takingyour hands off the steering wheel.

Page 152: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

152

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Volume control switchPress the “+” side to increase the volume.Press the “-” side to decrease the volume.

INFORMATION

●The other party’s voice will be heard fromthe front speakers. The audio/video sys-tem will be muted during phone calls orwhen hands-free voice commands areused.

●Talk alternately with the other party onthe phone. If both parties speak at thesame time, the other party may not hearwhat has been said. (This is not a malfunc-tion.)

●Keep call volume down. Otherwise, theother party’s voice may be audible out-side the vehicle and voice echo mayincrease. When talking on the phone,speak clearly towards the microphone.

●The other party may not hear you clearlywhen:• Driving on an unpaved road. (Making

excessive traffic noise.)• Driving at high speeds.• The roof or windows are open.• The air conditioning vents are pointed

towards the microphone.• The sound of the air-conditioning fan is

loud.• There is a negative effect on sound

quality due to the phone and/or networkbeing used.

USING THE STEERING SWITCHES

Page 153: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

153

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The following data is stored for every regis-tered phone. When another phone is con-nected, the following registered datacannot be read:• Phonebook data• Call history data• Speed dial data• Image data• All phone settings• Message settings

The following data in the system can be ini-tialized:• Phonebook data• Call history data• Speed dial data• Image data• All phone settings• Message settings

ABOUT THE PHONEBOOK IN THIS SYSTEM

INFORMATION

●When a phone’s registration is deleted,the above-mentioned data is alsodeleted.

WHEN SELLING OR DISPOSING OF THE VEHICLE

A lot of personal data is registered whenthe hands-free system is used. Whenselling or disposing of the vehicle, initial-ize the data. (See “DELETING PER-SONAL DATA” on page 63.)

INFORMATION

●Once initialized, the data and settings willbe erased. Pay much attention when ini-tializing the data.

Page 154: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

154

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

U.S.A. Canada

FCC ID : AJDK041This device complies with part 15 of the

FCC Rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.

CAUTION

●FCC WARNING: Changes ormodifications not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliancecould void the user’s authority to operatethe equipment.

●This equipment complies with FCCradiation exposure limits set forth for anuncontrolled environment and meets theFCC radio frequency (RF) ExposureGuidelines in Supplement C to OET65.This equipment has very low levels of RFenergy that it deemed to comply withoutmaximum permissive exposureevaluation (MPE). But it is desirable that itshould be installed and operated keepingthe radiator at least 20cm or more awayfrom person’s body (excludingextremities: hands, wrists, feet andankles).

●Co-location: This transmitter must not beco-located or operated in conjunctionwith any other antenna or transmitter.

IC : 775E-K041This device complies with Industry

Canada licence-exempt RSSstandard(s). Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) this devicemay not cause interference, and (2) thisdevice must accept any interference,including interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.Le présent appareil est conforme auxCNR d’Industrie Canada applicablesaux appareils radio exempts de licence.L’exploitation est autorisée aux deuxconditions suivantes : (1) l’appareil ne doitpas produire de brouillage, et (2)l’utilisateur de l’appareil doit acceptertout brouillage radioélectrique subi,même si le brouillage est susceptible d’encompromettre le fonctionnement.

CAUTION

●NOTEOperation is subject to the following twoconditions; (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation of the device.L’utilisation de ce dispositif est autoriséeseulement aux deux conditions suivantes:(1) il ne doit pas produire de brouillage, et(2) l’utilisateur du dispositif doit être prêtà accepter tout brouillageradioélectrique reçu, même si cebrouillage est susceptible decompromettre le fonctionnement dudispositif.

Page 155: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

155

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

CAUTION

●This equipment complies with ICradiation exposure limits set forth for anuncontrolled environment and meetsRSS-102 of the IC radio frequency (RF)Exposure rules. This equipment has verylow levels of RF energy that it deemed tocomply without maximum permissiveexposure evaluation (MPE). But it isdesirable that it should be installed andoperated keeping the radiator at least20cm or more away from person’s body(excluding extremities: hands, wrists, feetand ankles).Cet équipement est conforme aux limitesd’exposition aux rayonnements énoncéespour un environnement non contrôlé etrespecte les règles d’exposition auxfréquences radioélectriques (RF) CNR-102 de l’IC. Cet équipement émet uneénergie RF très faible qui est considéréeconforme sans évaluation de l’expositionmaximale autorisée. Cependant, cetéquipement doit être installé et utilisé engardant une distance de 20 cm ou plusentre le dispositif rayonnant et le corps (àl’exception des extrémités : mains,poignets, pieds et chevilles).

●The Bluetooth* antenna cannot beremoved (or replaced) by user.L’antenne Bluetooth* ne peut pas êtresupprimé (ou remplacé) par l’utilisateur.

Page 156: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

156

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. REGISTER A Bluetooth® PHONE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

3 Select “Yes” to register a phone.

If 5 Bluetooth® devices have already beenregistered, a registered device needs to bedeleted. See “When 5 Bluetooth®

devices have already been registered” onpage 158.

To use the hands-free system, it is neces-sary to register a phone with the system.Once the phone has been registered, itis possible to make a hands-free call.

If a Bluetooth® phone has not been reg-istered yet, it is necessary to register itfirst according to the following proce-dure. A Bluetooth® phone cannot beregistered while driving.

See “REGISTERING A Bluetooth®

DEVICE” on page 198 of additional reg-istration when registering.

Page 157: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

157

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4 When this screen is displayed, input thepasscode displayed on the screen intothe phone.

For details about entering the passcodeinto the Bluetooth® device, see the manualthat comes with it.

Depending on the type of Bluetooth®

phone being connected, it may be neces-sary to perform additional steps on thephone.A passcode is not required for SSP (Secure

Simple Pairing) compatible Bluetooth®

phones. Depending on the type ofBluetooth® phone being connected, amessage confirming registration may bedisplayed on the Bluetooth® phone’sscreen. Respond and operate theBluetooth® phone according to the confir-mation message.To cancel the registration, select “Cancel”.

If the Bluetooth® phone to be registeredhas a Bluetooth® audio function, this canbe registered at the same time.

5 This screen will be displayed when reg-istration is complete.

When using the same phone, it is not nec-essary to register it again.

When this screen is displayed, follow theguidance on the screen to try again.

When another Bluetooth® device is con-nected

When another Bluetooth® device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.

To disconnect the Bluetooth® device,select “Yes”.

Page 158: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

158

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

When 5 Bluetooth® devices have al-ready been registered

1 When 5 Bluetooth® devices have al-ready been registered, a registered de-vice needs to be deleted. Select “Yes” todelete 1 or more.

2 Select the device to be deleted, then se-lect “Remove”.

3 Select “Yes”.

If the Bluetooth® phone has aBluetooth® audio function

When the Bluetooth® phone to be regis-tered has a Bluetooth® audio function, thisaudio function will be registered automati-cally at the same time and this screen maybe displayed. If this screen is displayed,select “Yes” to connect the audio functionor select “No” to cancel the connection.

For automatic connection, see “CHANG-ING “Bluetooth* Power”” on page 206.

When the “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode, the systemsearches for a nearby registered cellularphone.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

CONNECTING A Bluetooth® PHONE

AUTOMATICALLY

When a phone is registered, auto con-nection is turned on. Always set it to thismode and leave the Bluetooth® phonein a location where connection can beestablished.

Page 159: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

159

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The system will connect with the phone thatwas last connected, if it is nearby.When “Display Phone Status” is set to“On”, the connection status is displayed.(See “Bluetooth® DEVICE CONNEC-TION STATUS DISPLAY SETTINGS” onpage 207.)

This screen appears when the Bluetooth®

phone is first connected after the“POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”>switch is in ACCESSORY or ON <IGNI-TION ON> mode.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Connect Phone”.

3 Select the screen button correspondingto the desired phone connection.

When the cellular phone’s device name hasnot been able to be obtained, “Device 1” to“Device 5” will be displayed in the order thephones were registered.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

INFORMATION

●It may take time if the phone connectionis carried out during Bluetooth® deviceplayback.

●Depending on the type of Bluetooth®

phone being connected, it may be neces-sary to perform additional steps on thephone.

MANUALLY

When the auto connection has failed or“Bluetooth* Power” is turned off, it isnecessary to connect Bluetooth® man-ually.

Page 160: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

160

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4 This screen is displayed.

5 When the connection is completed, thisscreen is displayed.

Now you can use the Bluetooth® phone.

When a phone is connected whileBluetooth® audio is playing

This screen is displayed, and theBluetooth® audio will stop temporarily.

If a Bluetooth® phone is disconnected onpurpose, such as turning it off, this does nothappen. Reconnect the Bluetooth® phonemanually.

RECONNECTING THE Bluetooth® PHONE

If a Bluetooth® phone is disconnecteddue to poor reception from theBluetooth® network when the“POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”>switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode, the system au-tomatically reconnects the Bluetooth®

phone. When “Display Phone Status” isset to “On”, the connection status is dis-played.

Page 161: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

161

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

4. CALL ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Phone” on the “Menu” screen.The “Phone” screen can be displayed by

pressing on the steering wheel.

3 Select the desired key to input thephone number.

Each time is selected, an input digit isdeleted.

4 Select or press the switch onthe steering wheel.

Depending on the type of Bluetooth®

phone being connected, it may be neces-sary to perform additional steps on thephone.

1 Select “Contacts”.

2 Select the desired data from the list.

After a Bluetooth® phone has been reg-istered, a call can be made using thehands-free system. There are 7 methodsby which a call can be made. These aredescribed below.

BY DIAL

A call can be made by inputting thephone number.This cannot be operated while driving.

BY PHONEBOOK

Calls can be made by using the phone-book data which is transferred from theregistered cellular phone.The phonebook changes depending onthe phone connected. Up to 1000 con-tacts (maximum of 3 numbers per con-tact) can be registered in eachphonebook.This cannot be operated while driving.

Page 162: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

162

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3 Select the desired number from the list.

4 Select or press the switch onthe steering wheel.

1 Select “Contacts”.

2 Select “Yes” or “Transfer” to automati-cally transfer the phonebook from theconnected phone.

Select “Manual” to transfer the phonebookmanually. (See “TRANSFERRING APHONE NUMBER” on page 178.)Select “No” or “Cancel” to cancel transfer-

ring. If your cellular phone is neither PBAP nor

OPP compatible, the phonebook cannotbe transferred.

PBAP compatible models

PBAP incompatible but OPP compatiblemodels

3 Transfer the phonebook data to the sys-tem using the Bluetooth® phone.

This operation may be unnecessarydepending on the type of cellular phone.Depending on the type of cellular phone,

OBEX authentication may be requiredwhen transferring phonebook data. Enter“1234” into the Bluetooth® phone.

This screen appears while transferring. Tocancel this function, select “Cancel”.

WHEN THE PHONEBOOK IS EMPTY

Page 163: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

163

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4 When the data transfer from a PBAP in-compatible but OPP compatible modelis complete, “Done” will appear on thescreen. Select “Done”.

1 Select “Speed Dials”.

2 Select the desired number to call.

The list to be displayed can be changed byselecting the “Speed Dial 1”, “Speed Dial2” or “Speed Dial 3” tab.

BY SPEED DIAL

Calls can be made using registeredphone numbers which can be selectedfrom a phonebook. (See “REGISTER-ING THE SPEED DIAL” on page 186for registering the speed dial.)This can be operated while driving.

BY CALL HISTORY

CALLS CAN BE MADE BY CALL HISTORY WHICH HAS 4 FUNCTIONS

All: all calls (missed, incoming or outgo-ing)Up to 25 call history items can be select-ed from the “All” tab while driving.Missed: calls that were missedIncoming: calls that were receivedOutgoing: calls that were made

Page 164: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

164

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Call History”.

2 Select the desired data from the list.

The list to be displayed can be changed byselecting the “All”, “Missed”, “Incoming” or“Outgoing” tab.

3 Select or press the switch onthe steering wheel.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Press the switch on the steeringwheel to display the “Call History”screen.

3 Press the switch on the steeringwheel to select the latest history item.

4 Select or press the switch onthe steering wheel to call the latest his-tory item.

When making a call by phonebook, thename (if registered) is displayed.When making a call to the same number

continuously, only the most recent call islisted in call history.When a phone number registered in the

phonebook is received, the name and thenumber are displayed.Number-withheld calls are also memorized

in the system. International phone calls may not be made

depending on the type of cellular phoneyou have.

CALLS CAN BE MADE USING THE LATEST CALL HISTORY ITEM

Page 165: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

165

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the talk switch. “Call <name> <type>” is displayed in the

“Shortcut Menu” screen.When “Call <name> <type>” on the “Short-

cut Menu” screen is dimmed, the phone-book’s voice command recognition cannotbe used. Check the Bluetooth® connec-tion and if the contacts have been trans-ferred to the navigation system.

2 Say the name, or the name and type ofphone, of a registered contact.

In the same manner as it is displayed on thescreen, “Call <name> <type>”, after saying“Call” say the name, or the name and typeof phone, of a contact.For example: “Call”, “John Smith” or “Call”,“Mary Davis”, “Mobile”There are 4 types of phones: Home,

Mobile, Office and Other.Short or abbreviated names in the phone-

book may not be recognized. Changenames in the phonebook to full names. Sometimes a voice recognition result con-

firmation screen will be displayed. Afterconfirming the result, say “Yes” or “No”.When the system recognizes multiple

names from the phonebook, a name candi-date list will be displayed on the screen. Ifthe desired name is not displayed on thetop of the screen, say the number of thename from the candidate list (number 1 andnumber 2) to select a name from the candi-date list.When a contact has multiple phone num-

bers registered in the phonebook, a candi-date list will be displayed. If the desiredphone number is not displayed on the topof the screen, say the number of the desiredphone number from the candidate list(number 1 and number 2) to select a phonenumber from the candidate list.

3 Say “Dial” to call the phone number.

BY VOICE RECOGNITION

Calls can be made by giving a voicecommand. (For the operation and com-mand of voice recognition, see “VOICECOMMAND SYSTEM” on page 330.)This can be operated while driving.

VOICE COMMAND EXAMPLE: CALL NAME

Page 166: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

166

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the talk switch. “Dial <number>” is displayed in the “Short-

cut Menu” screen.When “Dial <number>” on the “Shortcut

Menu” screen is dimmed, the phone num-ber voice recognition cannot be used.Check the Bluetooth® phone connection.

2 Say the phone number. In the same manner as it is displayed on the

screen, “Dial <number>”, after saying “Dial”say the phone number. Say the phone number one digit at a time.

For example, if the phone number is2345678:Say “two three four five six seven eight”Do not say “twenty three forty five sixtyseven eight”The system can recognize the following

types of phone numbers:3 digit numbers (911, 411, 611)7 digit numbers (Local phone numbers)10 digit numbers (Area code + Localphone number)11 digit phone numbers (1 + Area code +Local phone number)As the system cannot recognize additional

numbers, say the complete number withoutstopping.When the system recognizes multiple

phone numbers, a phone number candi-date list will be displayed on the screen. Ifthe desired phone number is not displayedon the top of the screen, say the number ofthe desired phone number from the candi-date list (number 1 and number 2) to selecta phone number from the candidate list.

3 Say “Dial” to call the phone number.

■ INTERNATIONAL CALL

1 Go to the “Main Menu” screen bypressing the talk switch on the steeringwheel and saying “Main menu” or select“Main Menu”.

2 Say “Use a phone”.

3 Say “International call”.Up to 24 digits can be recognized when

using the international call function. Thenumber can also be divided into multiplegroups and recognized.

VOICE COMMAND EXAMPLE: DIAL NUMBER To dial a phone number that is not a 3, 7,

10 or 11 digit number, for example an in-ternational number, use “InternationalCall”.

Calling without the voice recognition:After the desired phone number is dis-played, a call can also made by pressingthe switch on the steering wheel.Canceling the voice recognition: Thevoice recognition will be canceled wheneither of the following is performed:

• Press and hold the talk switch.• Select “Cancel”.

Page 167: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

167

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Messages”.

When “Message Transfer” is set to “Off”, aconfirmation screen will be displayed.Select “Yes”. (See page 190.)

2 Select the “SMS/MMS” tab and thenselect the desired received messagefrom the list.

The tab display may vary depending on thetype of cellular phone.

3 Select or press the switch onthe steering wheel.

CALLING USING AN SMS/MMS MESSAGE

Calls can be made to an SMS (ShortMessage Service)/MMS (MultimediaMessaging Service) message sender’sphone number.This can be operated while driving.

BY POI CALL

A call can be made by selecting when it is displayed on the screen fromthe navigation system. (See “TO SEEINFORMATION ABOUT THE ICONWHERE THE CURSOR IS SET” onpage 43 and “VIEW DETAILED FUELPRICE INFORMATION” on page357.)

Page 168: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

168

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5. RECEIVE ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE

1 Select or press the switch onthe steering wheel to talk on the phone.

When a call is received, this screen isdisplayed with a sound.

To refuse to receive the call: Select

or press the switch on thesteering wheel.To adjust the volume of a received call:Select “-” or “+”, turn the “PWR·VOL”knob, or use the volume switch on thesteering wheel.

INFORMATION

●During international phone calls, theother party’s name or number may not bedisplayed correctly depending on thetype of cellular phone you have.

●The incoming call display mode can beset. (See “INCOMING CALL DIS-PLAY” on page 195.)

Page 169: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

169

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

6. TALK ON THE Bluetooth® PHONE

1 Select the desired number to input thekey.

While talking on the phone, this screen isdisplayed. The operations outlined be-low can be performed on this screen.

To adjust the volume of the other party’svoice: Select “-” or “+”, turn the“PWR·VOL” knob, or use the volumeswitch on the steering wheel.

To hang up the phone: Select orpress the switch on the steeringwheel.To mute your voice: Select “Mute”.To input a key: Select “0-9”.To transfer the call: Select “HandsetMode” to change from hands-free call tocellular phone call. Select “HandsfreeMode” to change from cellular phone callto hands-free call.

INFORMATION

●Changing from hands-free call to cellularphone call is not possible while driving.

●When cellular phone call is changed tohands-free call, the hands-free screen willbe displayed and its functions can beoperated on the screen.

●Changing between cellular phone calland hands-free call can be performed byoperating the cellular phone directly.

●Transferring methods and operations willbe different depending on the type of cel-lular phone you have.

●For the operation of the cellular phone,see the manual that comes with it.

WHEN YOU SELECT “0-9”

INPUTTING A KEY

Inputting a key is not possible while driv-ing.

To hang up the phone: Select orpress the switch on the steeringwheel.

Page 170: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

170

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Confirm the number displayed on thescreen and select “Send”. The numberbefore marked sign will be sent.

When “Clear” is selected, this function isfinished and the normal tone screenappears.

TONE SIGNAL

If a continuous tone signal is registeredin a phonebook, this screen appears. (Ifnot registered, “Send” and “Clear” arenot displayed.) This can be operatedwhile driving.

To hang up the phone: Select orpress the switch on the steeringwheel.

INFORMATION

●The continuous tone signal is the markedsign (p or w) and the number that followsthe phone number. (e.g.056133w0123p#1)

●When the “p” pause tone is used, afterwaiting 2 seconds the tone data up untilthe next pause tone will be automaticallysent. When the “w” pause tone is used,the tone data up until the next pause tonewill be automatically sent after user oper-ation.

●This operation can be done when it isdesirable to operate an answeringmachine or use a telephone service in abank for example. The phone numberand the code number in the phonebookcan be registered.

BY VOICE RECOGNITION

“Send Tones” can be operated by givinga command during a call.

The operating procedure is similar toother voice recognition operations. (Forthe operation of voice recognition, see“VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM” onpage 330.)

Page 171: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

171

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select or press the switchon the steering wheel to start talkingwith the other party.

INCOMING CALL WAITING

When a call is interrupted by a third par-ty while talking, this screen is displayed.

Select or press the switchon the steering wheel to refuse the call.

Each time is selected or the switch on the steering wheel is pressedduring an interrupted call, the party whois on hold will be switched.

INFORMATION

●If your cellular phone does not supportHFP Ver. 1.5, this function cannot be used.

Page 172: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

172

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

7. Bluetooth® PHONE MESSAGE FUNCTION

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Phone” on the “Menu” screen.The “Phone” screen can be displayed by

pressing on the steering wheel.

3 Select “Messages”.

Depending on the type of Bluetooth®

phone being connected, it may be neces-sary to perform additional steps on thephone.When “Message Transfer” is set to “Off”, a

confirmation screen will be displayed.Select “Yes”. (See page 190.)

4 Select the screen button correspondingto the desired message.

Messages are displayed in the appropriateconnected Bluetooth® phone’s registeredmail address folder. Select the tab of thedesired folder to be displayed.

5 Messages can be checked.

Selecting “Previous” or “Next” displays theprevious or next message.Only received messages on the connected

Bluetooth® phone can be displayed.The text of the message is not displayed

while driving.

6 Select “Play” to start reading out of themessage. Select “Stop” to stop the func-tion.

Select “-” or “+”, turn the “PWR·VOL”knob, or use the volume switch on thesteering wheel to adjust the message readout volume.The message read out function is available

even while driving.

Received messages can be forwardedfrom the connected Bluetooth® phone,enabling checking and replying usingthe navigation system (Quick reply).

CHECKING MESSAGES

Page 173: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

173

1. PHONE OPERATION

4

PHO

NE

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Reply”.

2 Select the screen button correspondingto the desired message.

3 Select “Send”.While the message is being sent, a sending

message screen is displayed.

4 This screen will be displayed if messagedelivery fails.

Select “Retry” to attempt to send the mes-sage again or select “Cancel” to cancel.

When the received message is an e-mailand “Update Message Read Status onPhone” is set to “On”, “Mark as Unread”or “Mark as Read” can be selected.Select “Mark as Unread” to mark mailsthat have been read on the Bluetooth®

phone as unread. Conversely, select“Mark as Read” to mark mails that havenot been read on the Bluetooth® phoneas read. (See “MESSAGE SETTINGS”on page 190.)For SMS/MMS, selecting or

pressing the switch on the steeringwheel calls the sender. (See page 167.)Select “Reply” to reply to the message.

(See page 173.)

REPLYING (QUICK REPLY)

Page 174: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

174

1. PHONE OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Reply messages can be edited while thevehicle is parked. Select “Edit”.

2 Select the screen button correspondingto the desired message.

3 Select “OK” when editing is completed.

4 Select .

1 Select “Read” to check the message.The “Messages” screen will be displayed.When “Automatic Message Readout” is

set to “On”, the message will be automati-cally read out. (See “MESSAGE SET-TINGS” on page 190.)

EDITING REPLY MESSAGES NEW MESSAGE NOTIFICATION

If “New Message Pop-up” and “NewMessage Voice Notification” are set to“On”, a notification appears on thescreen and a voice notification will beheard when a new message arrives.(See “MESSAGE SETTINGS” on page190.)

For SMS/MMS, selecting orpressing the switch on the steeringwheel calls the sender. (See page 167.)To check the message later, select

“Ignore” or .

Page 175: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

175

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

2. SETUP

1. PHONE SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Phone”.

4 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

1 Select “Phone Sound Settings”.

2 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

3 When all settings are completed, select“Save”.

The phonebook can be edited. Volume,display and message settings can alsobe changed.

PHONE SOUND SETTINGS

The call and ring tone volume can be ad-justed. A ring tone can be selected.

Page 176: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

176

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Call Volume” on the “PhoneSound Settings” screen.

2 Select “-” or “+” to adjust the call vol-ume.

3 Select “OK”.

1 Select “Ring Tone Volume” on the“Phone Sound Settings” screen.

2 Select “-” or “+” to adjust the ring tonevolume.

3 Select “OK”.

1 Select “Ring Tone” on the “PhoneSound Settings” screen.

2 Select the screen button correspondingto the desired ring tone.

Ring tones can be heard by selecting thescreen buttons.

3 Select “OK”.

1 Select “Default” on the “Phone SoundSettings” screen.

2 Select “Yes”.

INFORMATION

●The system will automatically increasethe volume when the speed exceeds 50mph (80 km/h).

CALL VOLUME SETTING

RING TONE VOLUME SETTING

RING TONE SETTING

INITIALIZING THE SETTINGS

The settings can be initialized.

Page 177: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

177

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Phone” on the “Setup” screen.

4 Select “Phonebook”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Phone” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Phonebook” on the “Phone Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Manage Contacts”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

PHONEBOOK

The call history can be deleted andphonebook and speed dial settings canbe changed.

INFORMATION

●Phonebook data is managed indepen-dently for every registered phone. Whenone phone is connected, another phone’sregistered data cannot be read.

SETTING THE PHONEBOOK

The phonebook can be transferred froma Bluetooth® phone to the system. Thephonebook also can be added, editedand deleted.

Page 178: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

178

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ THE “Contacts” SCREEN CANALSO BE DISPLAYED

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Contacts” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select “Options”.

4 Select “Manage Contacts”.

■ TRANSFERRING A PHONE NUM-BER

The phone numbers in a Bluetooth®

phone can be transferred to the system.The system can manage up to 5 phone-books. Up to 1000 contacts (maximumof 3 numbers per contact) can be regis-tered in each phonebook.Operation methods differ betweenPBAP compatible and PBAP incompat-ible but OPP compatible Bluetooth®

phones.If your cellular phone is neither PBAPnor OPP compatible, the phonebookcannot be transferred.

Page 179: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

179

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

For PBAP compatible Bluetooth®

phones

1 Select “Transfer Contacts”.

2 Select “Update Contacts”.

3 Transfer the phonebook data to the sys-tem using the Bluetooth® phone.

This operation may be unnecessarydepending on the type of cellular phone.Depending on the type of cellular phone,

OBEX authentication may be requiredwhen transferring phonebook data. Enter“1234” into the Bluetooth® phone.

This screen appears while transferring. Tocancel this function, select “Cancel”.

If another Bluetooth® device is connectedwhen transferring phonebook data,depending on the phone, the connectedBluetooth® device may need to be discon-nected.

PBAP compatible models automaticdata transfer setting

1 Select “Transfer Contacts”.

When a PBAP compatible phone is con-nected, the phone’s phonebook data canbe automatically transferred.

Page 180: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

180

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Select “Automatically DownloadContacts” to transfer the phonebookfrom a connected cellular phone.Select “Automatically Download CallHistory” to transfer the call history froma connected cellular phone.

3 Select “On”.

4 Select “Save”.

For PBAP incompatible but OPP com-patible Bluetooth® phones

1 Select “Transfer Contacts”.

2 Select “Replace Contacts” or “AddContacts”.

If the phonebook contains phonebookdata, this screen is displayed.

Page 181: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

181

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

3 Transfer the phonebook data to the sys-tem using a Bluetooth® phone.

Depending on the type of cellular phone,OBEX authentication may be requiredwhen transferring phonebook data. Enter“1234” into the Bluetooth® phone.

This screen appears while transferring. Tocancel this function, select “Cancel”. If“Add Contacts” is selected and there is aninterruption during the transfer of data, thephonebook data transferred until then willbe stored in the system. This is not the casewhen “Cancel” is selected.This operation may be unnecessary

depending on the type of cellular phone.

4 When the transfer is complete, “Done”will appear on the screen. Select“Done”.

When another Bluetooth® device is con-nected

When another Bluetooth® device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.To disconnect it, select “Yes”.

From “Contacts” screen

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Contacts” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select “Transfer”.

4 This screen is displayed. The followingoperations are performed in the samemanner as when they are performedfrom the “Setup” screen.

Phonebooks of PBAP incompatible butOPP compatible phones can also betransferred from the “Contacts” screen.

Page 182: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

182

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ REGISTERING THE PHONE-BOOK DATA

1 Select “New Contact”.

2 Use the software keyboard to input thename and select “OK”.

3 Input the phone number and select“OK”.

To use a tone signal after the phone num-ber, input the tone signal too.

4 Select the phone type.

5 When 2 or less numbers in total are reg-istered to this contact, this screen is dis-played.

To add a number to this contact, select“Yes”.

■ EDITING THE PHONEBOOKDATA

The phonebook data can be registered.Up to 3 numbers per person can be reg-istered. New phonebook data cannot beadded for PBAP compatibleBluetooth® phones.

The phone number can be registered in“Phone # 1”, “Phone # 2” and “Phone #3” separately. Phonebooks cannot beedited for PBAP compatibleBluetooth® phones via the navigationsystem.

Page 183: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

183

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

1 Select “Edit Contacts”.

2 Select the desired data to edit.

3 Select the desired name or number.

4 Edit the name or the number. (See“REGISTERING THE PHONEBOOKDATA” on page 182.)

5 Select “Save” when editing is complet-ed.

■ THE “Edit Contact” SCREEN CANALSO BE DISPLAYED

From the “Contact” screen

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Contacts” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select the desired data from the list onthe “Contacts” screen.

4 Select “Options”.

5 Select “Edit”.

Page 184: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

184

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

From the “Call History” screen

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Call History” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select the desired number from the liston the “Call History” screen.

4 Select “Add to Contacts” or “UpdateContact”.

5 If “Update Contact” has been selected,this screen will be displayed. Select thedesired data from the list.

■ DELETING THE PHONEBOOKDATA

1 Select “Delete Contacts”.

2 Select the desired data or “Select All”,then select “Delete”.

Multiple data can be selected and deletedat the same time.

3 Select “Yes”.

The data can be deleted.When selling or disposing of the vehicle,delete all your data on the system.For PBAP compatible phones, deletethe phonebook data after setting “Auto-matically Download Contacts” to“Off”. (See “PBAP compatible mod-els automatic data transfer setting” onpage 179.)

Page 185: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

185

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

■ ALTERNATIVE PHONEBOOKDATA DELETION METHOD

PBAP incompatible but OPP compatiblemodels

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Contacts” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select the desired data from the list onthe “Contacts” screen.

4 Select “Options”.

5 Select “Delete”.

6 Select “Yes”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Phone” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Phonebook” on the “Phone Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Manage Speed Dials”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

INFORMATION

●When a Bluetooth® phone is deleted, thephonebook data will be deleted at thesame time.

SPEED DIALS SETTING

Speed dials can be registered and delet-ed.

Page 186: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

186

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ THE “Speed Dials” SCREEN CANALSO BE DISPLAYED

From the “Speed Dial” screen

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Speed Dials” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select “Options”.

From the “Contacts” screen

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Contacts” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select “Options”.

4 Select “Manage Speed Dials”.

■ REGISTERING THE SPEED DIAL

1 Select “New”.

2 Select the desired data to be registered.

Speed dial numbers can be registeredby selecting the desired number fromthe phonebook. Up to 18 numbers perphone can be registered as a speed dial.

Page 187: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

187

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

3 Select the desired phone number.

4 Select the desired speed dial location.

5 If a location that is already in use is se-lected, this screen will be displayed.

Select “Yes” to replace it.

6 When this screen is displayed, the oper-ation is complete.

■ THE SPEED DIAL CAN ALSO BEREGISTERED

From the “Speed Dial” screen

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Speed Dials” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select “(add new)”.

4 Select “Yes” to set new speed dial.

5 Select the desired data to be registered.

Page 188: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

188

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Select the desired phone number.

From the “Contact” screen

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Contacts” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select the desired data from the list onthe “Contacts” screen.

4 Select “Options”.

5 Select “Set Speed Dial”.

6 This screen is displayed.

The following operations are performed inthe same manner as when they are per-formed from the “Setup” screen.

■ DELETING THE SPEED DIAL

1 Select “Delete”.

2 Select the desired data, or to delete allthe data select “Select All”, then select“Delete”.

Multiple data can be selected and deletedat the same time.

3 Select “Yes”.

The speed dial can be deleted.

Page 189: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

189

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Phone” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “Phonebook” on the “Phone Set-tings” screen.

4 Select “Delete Call History”.

5 Select the desired history to be deleted.

6 Select the desired data, or to delete allthe data select “Select All”, then select“Delete”.

Multiple data can be selected and deletedat the same time.

7 Select “Yes”.

■ THE CALL HISTORY CAN ALSOBE DELETED

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Call History” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select “Delete”.

DELETING CALL HISTORY

The call history can be deleted.For PBAP compatible phones, deletethe call history after setting “Automati-cally Download Call History” to “Off”.(See “PBAP compatible models auto-matic data transfer setting” on page179.)

Page 190: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

190

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4 This screen is displayed.

The following operations are performed inthe same manner as when they are per-formed from the “Setup” screen.Other call history can be operated simi-

larly.

Deleting after call history has been dis-played

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Call History” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select the desired history to be deleted.

4 Select “Delete”.

5 Select “Yes”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Phone” on the “Setup” screen.

4 Select “Messaging Settings”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

6 Select “Save” when each setting is com-pleted.

MESSAGE SETTINGS

Message settings can be changed.

Page 191: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

191

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Phone”.

The “Phone” screen can be displayed bypressing on the steering wheel.

2 Select “Messages” on the “Phone”screen.

3 Select “Options”.

On this screen, the following functions canbe operated:

To reset all setup items, select “Default”.

THE “Messaging Settings” SCREEN CAN ALSO BE DISPLAYED

SCREEN FOR “Messaging Settings”

No. Function

Select to set message forwardingfrom cellular phones to “On” or “Off”.

Select to set the new message notifi-cation display to “On” or “Off”.

Select to set the new message voicenotification to “On” or “Off”.

Select to adjust the new message noti-fication volume. (See “NEW MES-SAGE NOTIFICATION VOLUMESETTINGS” on page 192.)

Select a new message voice notifica-tion tone. (See “NEW MESSAGENOTIFICATION TONE SET-TINGS” on page 192.)

Select to set the automatic messageread out function to “On” or “Off”.

Select to adjust the message read outvolume. (See “MESSAGE READOUT VOLUME SETTINGS” on page193.)

Select to set the cellular phone’s mes-sage read and unread status updatefunction to “On” or “Off”.

Select to edit quick reply messages.(See “EDIT QUICK REPLY MES-SAGES” on page 193.)

INFORMATION

●Depending on the phone, these functionsmay not be available.

Page 192: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

192

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “New Message NotificationVolume”.

2 Select “-” or “+” to adjust the new mes-sage notification volume.

3 Select “OK”.

1 Select “New Message NotificationTone”.

2 Select the desired new message notifi-cation tone.

New message notification tones can beheard by selecting the screen buttons.

3 Select “OK”.

NEW MESSAGE NOTIFICATION VOLUME SETTINGS

The new message notification volumecan be adjusted.

INFORMATION

●The system will automatically increasethe volume when the speed exceeds 50mph (80 km/h).

NEW MESSAGE NOTIFICATION TONE SETTINGS

A new message voice notification tonecan be selected.

Page 193: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

193

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

1 Select “Message Readout Volume”.

2 Select “-” or “+” to adjust the messageread out volume.

3 Select “OK”.

1 Select “Edit Quick Reply Messages”.

2 Select the screen button correspondingto the desired message.

3 Use the software keyboard to edit themessage.

4 Select “OK”.

MESSAGE READ OUT VOLUME SETTINGS

Message read out volume can be ad-justed.

INFORMATION

●The system will automatically increasethe volume when the speed exceeds 50mph (80 km/h).

EDIT QUICK REPLY MESSAGES

Quick reply messages can be edited. 15messages have already been stored.

Page 194: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

194

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Default”.

2 Select “Yes”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Phone” on the “Setup” screen.

4 Select “Phone Display Settings”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

6 When each setting is completed, select“Save”.

INITIALIZING THE SETTINGS

The settings can be initialized.

PHONE DISPLAY SETTINGS

The phone display settings can bechanged.

Page 195: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

195

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

On this screen, the following functions canbe operated:

To reset all setup items, select “Default”.

1 Select “Incoming Call Display Mode”.

2 Select “Full Screen” or “Drop Down”.

3 Select “Save”.

SCREEN FOR “Phone Display Settings”

No. Function

Select to change the incoming calldisplay. (See “INCOMING CALLDISPLAY” on page 195.)

For PBAP compatible models, se-lect to set the display of the automat-ic phonebook transfer completionmessage to “On” or “Off”.

For PBAP compatible models, se-lect to set the display of the automat-ic call history transfer completionmessage to “On” or “Off”.

For PBAP compatible models, se-lect to set the display of images dur-ing calls to “On” or “Off”.

For PBAP compatible models, se-lect to set the orientation of imagesdisplayed during calls. (See “RO-TATING CONTACT IMAGES” onpage 196.)

INFORMATION

●Depending on the phone, these functionsmay not be available even if the phone isPBAP compatible.

INCOMING CALL DISPLAY

The type of incoming call display can beselected.

Screen button Function

“Full Screen”

When a call is received,the hands-free screen isdisplayed and it can beoperated on the screen.

“Drop Down”

The message is displayedon the upper side of thescreen and it can only beoperated via the steeringwheel switches.

Page 196: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

196

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Rotate Contact Images”.

2 Select the desired orientation of the im-age to be displayed.

3 Select “Save”.

1 Select “Default”.

2 Select “Yes”.

ROTATING CONTACT IMAGES

For PBAP compatible models, when“Contact Image for Incoming Calls” isset to “On”, images stored together withphone numbers in the cellular phone’sphonebook will be transferred and dis-played during the incoming call. The ori-entation of the image can be set.

INITIALIZING THE SETTINGS

The settings can be initialized.

Page 197: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

197

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

2. Bluetooth® SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Bluetooth*”.

4 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Bluetooth*” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Registered Devices”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

A Bluetooth® device can be set up. REGISTERED DEVICES

A Bluetooth® device can be registered,deleted or set up.

Page 198: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

198

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Add New” to register aBluetooth® device to the system.

If 5 Bluetooth® devices have already beenregistered, a registered device needs to bedeleted. See “When 5 Bluetooth®

devices have already been registered” onpage 199.

2 When this screen is displayed, input thepasscode displayed on the screen intothe Bluetooth® device.

For details about entering the passcodeinto the Bluetooth® device, see the manualthat comes with it.A passcode is not required for SSP (Secure

Simple Pairing) compatible Bluetooth®

devices. Depending on the type ofBluetooth® phone being connected, amessage confirming registration may bedisplayed on the Bluetooth® phone’sscreen. Respond and operate theBluetooth® phone according to the confir-mation message.To cancel the registration, select “Cancel”.

3 When the connection is completed, thisscreen is displayed.

When using the same device, it is not nec-essary to register it again.

When this screen is displayed, follow theguidance on the screen to try again.

REGISTERING A Bluetooth® DEVICE

Bluetooth® devices compatible withphones (HFP) and portable players(AVP) can be registered simultaneous-ly. Phones (HFP) and portable players(AVP) (maximum of 5) can be regis-tered.

Page 199: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

199

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

When another Bluetooth® device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.

To disconnect the Bluetooth® device,select “Yes”.

When 5 Bluetooth® devices have al-ready been registered

1 When 5 Bluetooth® devices have al-ready been registered, a registered de-vice needs to be deleted. Select “Yes” todelete 1 or more.

2 Select the device to be deleted, then se-lect “Remove”.

3 Select “Yes”.

1 Select “Remove”.

2 Select the desired device, or to deleteall the devices select “Select All”, thenselect “Remove”.

Multiple devices can be selected anddeleted at the same time.

3 Select “Yes”.

DELETING A Bluetooth® DEVICE

INFORMATION

●When deleting a Bluetooth® phone, thephonebook data will be deleted at thesame time.

Page 200: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

200

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

“Device Name”: The name of theBluetooth® device which is displayed onthe screen. It can be changed to a desiredname.

• Even if the device name is changed, thename registered in your Bluetooth®

device does not change.“Device Address”: The device address isunique to each device. It cannot bechanged.

• If 2 Bluetooth® devices have been regis-tered with the same device name, thedevices can be distinguished referring tothe device’s address.

“My Phone Number”: The phone number ofthe Bluetooth® phone is displayed on thescreen. Depending on the type of phone,the phone number may not be displayed.“Profiles”: The compatibility profile of theBluetooth® device is displayed on thescreen.“Connect Portable Player from”: There are2 portable player connection settings avail-able; “Vehicle” and “Portable Player”.

■ CHANGING A DEVICE NAME

1 Select “Details”.

2 Select the device to be edited.

3 Select “Device Name”.

EDITING THE Bluetooth® DEVICE

The Bluetooth® device’s informationcan be displayed on the screen. The dis-played information can also be edited.

Page 201: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

201

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

4 Use the software keyboard to input thedevice name and select “OK”.

5 Confirm the device name and select“OK”.

■ SETTING PORTABLE PLAYERCONNECTION METHOD

1 Select “Connect Portable Playerfrom”.

2 Select the desired connection method.

“Vehicle”: Select to connect the audio sys-tem to the portable player.“Portable Player”: Select to connect theportable player to the audio system.Depending on the portable player, the

“Vehicle” or “Portable Player” connectionmethod may be best. As such, refer to themanual that comes with the portable player.

3 Select “OK”.

Page 202: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

202

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Bluetooth*” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Connect Phone”.

5 Select the phone to be connected.

The indicator of the selected Bluetooth®

phone will turn on.

6 This screen is displayed.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

SELECTING A Bluetooth® PHONE

If more than 1 Bluetooth® phone hasbeen registered, it is necessary to selectwhich phone to connect to.It is possible to select from up to 5 regis-tered Bluetooth® devices (Phones(HFP) and portable players (AVP)(maximum of 5) can be registered.)

Although up to 5 Bluetooth® phonescan be registered in the system, only 1Bluetooth® phone can function at atime.

If the desired Bluetooth® phone is not onthe list, select “Add New” to register thephone. (See page 198.)

The currently connected Bluetooth®

phone’s screen button will have aBluetooth® mark displayed on it. If thecurrently connected Bluetooth® phone’sscreen button is selected, theBluetooth® phone can be disconnected.Select “Yes” to disconnect.

Page 203: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

203

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

7 When the result message is displayed,the Bluetooth® phone can be used.

When a phone is connected whileBluetooth® audio is playing

This screen is displayed, and theBluetooth® audio will stop temporarily.

When another Bluetooth® device is con-nected

When another Bluetooth® device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.To disconnect the Bluetooth® device,select “Yes”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Bluetooth*” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Connect Portable Player”.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

SELECTING PORTABLE PLAYER

If more than 1 portable player has beenregistered, it is necessary to select whichportable player to connect to.It is possible to select from up to 5 regis-tered Bluetooth® devices (Phones(HFP) and portable players (AVP)(maximum of 5) can be registered.)Although up to 5 portable players canbe registered in the system, only 1 porta-ble player can function at a time.

Page 204: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

204

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5 Select the desired portable player to beconnected.

The indicator of the selected portableplayer will turn on.

6 This screen is displayed.

7 When the result message is displayed,the portable player can be used.

When another Bluetooth® device is con-nected

When another Bluetooth® device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.To disconnect it, select “Yes”.

If the desired portable player is not on thelist, select “Add New” to register the por-table player. (See page 198.)The currently connected portable

player’s screen button will have aBluetooth® mark displayed on it. If thecurrently connected portable player’sscreen button is selected, the portableplayer can be disconnected. Select “Yes”to disconnect.

Page 205: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

205

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Setup” on the “Menu” screen.

3 Select “Bluetooth*” on the “Setup”screen.

4 Select “Detailed Bluetooth* Settings”.

5 This screen is displayed.

The information displays the followingitems:

If it is desirable to change the settings, referto the following pages.When the settings have been changed,

select “Save”.*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of

Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

DETAILED Bluetooth® SETTINGS

The Bluetooth® settings can be con-firmed and changed.

Screen button/Screen item Information

“Device Name”

This name will be dis-played on the devicewhen it is connected. Itcan be changed to a de-sired name.

“Passcode”

The password that wasset when the Bluetooth®

device was registeredcan be changed.

Device Address

The device address isunique to each device. Itcannot be changed.

Profiles

The compatibility profileof the Bluetooth® deviceis displayed on thescreen. (See pages 150and 269.)

Page 206: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

206

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ CHANGING “Bluetooth* Power”

When “Bluetooth* Power” is “On”:

The Bluetooth® device is automaticallyconnected when the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode.When “Bluetooth* Power” is “Off”: The Bluetooth® device is disconnected,and the system will not connect to it nexttime.The “Bluetooth* Power” auto connection

state can be set on or off.• “On”: The auto connection is turned on.• “Off”: The auto connection is turned off.The auto connection state cannot be

changed from “On” to “Off” while driving,but it can be changed from “Off” to “On”.

1 Select “Bluetooth* Power”.

2 Select “On” or “Off”.

3 Select “Save”. In the event the state of “Bluetooth*

Power” is changed from “Off” to “On”,Bluetooth® connection will begin.

■ EDITING THE DEVICE NAME

1 Select “Device Name”.

2 Use the software keyboard to input thedevice name and select “OK”.

3 Select “Save”.*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of

Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

CHANGING THE Bluetooth® SETTINGS

The Bluetooth® settings can bechanged according to the following pro-cedures.

The “Bluetooth* Power” display showsthe following state.

Page 207: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

207

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

■ EDITING THE PASSCODE

1 Select “Passcode”.

2 Input a passcode and select “OK”.

3 Select “Save”.

■ Bluetooth® DEVICE CONNEC-TION STATUS DISPLAY SETTINGS

1 Select “Display Phone Status” or“Display Portable Player Status”.

2 Select “On”.

3 Select “Save”.*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of

Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

When “Bluetooth* Power” is “On” andthe “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY orON <IGNITION ON> mode, theBluetooth® phone and portable player’sconnection status can be displayed.(See “CHANGING “Bluetooth* Pow-er”” on page 206.)

Page 208: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

208

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Default”.

2 Select “Yes”. If the state of “Bluetooth* Power” is

changed from “Off” into “On”, Bluetooth®

connection will begin.*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of

Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

INITIALIZING THE Bluetooth® SETTINGS

The settings can be initialized.

Page 209: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

209

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4

PHO

NE

Page 210: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

210

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. QUICK REFERENCE ............................. 212

2. SOME BASICS .......................................... 214VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM........................ 215

AUDIO SPLIT SCREEN DISPLAY ................. 215

TURNING THE SYSTEM ON AND OFF ....................................................... 215

SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNCTIONS ......................................................... 216

DSP CONTROL....................................................... 217

TONE AND BALANCE....................................... 217

SELECTING SCREEN SIZE .............................. 218

DVD PLAYER............................................................ 219

AUX PORT ................................................................. 219

USB PORT................................................................. 220

3. RADIO OPERATION............................. 221

LISTENING TO THE RADIO ............................ 221

PRESETTING A STATION ................................. 221

SELECTING A STATION .................................. 222

RADIO BROADCAST DATA SYSTEM ..... 222

TRAFFIC ANNOUNCEMENT ....................... 223

4. HD Radio™ TECHNOLOGY INFORMATION .................................. 224

USING HD Radio™ TECHNOLOGY......... 224

AVAILABLE HD Radio™ TECHNOLOGY................................................. 225

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE ..................... 227

5. RADIO OPERATION (XM Satellite Radio BROADCAST) ..................................... 229

HOW TO SUBSCRIBE TO AN XM Satellite Radio ............................................... 229

DISPLAYING THE RADIO ID ......................... 229

LISTENING TO SATELLITE RADIO ........... 230

CHANNEL CATEGORY ................................. 230

PRESETTING A CHANNEL............................ 230

SELECTING A CHANNEL................................ 231

DISPLAYING THE TITLE AND NAME........ 231

IF THE SATELLITE RADIO TUNER MALFUNCTIONS ............................................. 232

6. RADIO OPERATION (INTERNET RADIO BROADCAST)..................... 234

LISTENING TO INTERNET RADIO............. 234

7. DVD PLAYER OPERATION ............. 235

INSERTING A DISC............................................. 235

EJECTING A DISC ............................................... 235

PLAYING A DISC.................................................. 236

PLAYING AN AUDIO DISC ........................... 236

PLAYING AN MP3/WMA DISC ................. 238

OPERATING A DVD DISC ............................... 241

PLAYING A DVD DISC ..................................... 242

DVD OPTIONS....................................................... 244

IF THE PLAYER MALFUNCTIONS ............ 253

DVD PLAYER AND DVD VIDEO DISC INFORMATION..................................... 254

8. USB MEMORY OPERATION ........... 256

CONNECTING A USB MEMORY............. 256

PLAYING A USB MEMORY ........................... 257

1 AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

Page 211: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

5

211

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

9. iPod OPERATION.................................. 262

CONNECTING iPod ........................................... 262

PLAYING iPod MUSIC ...................................... 263

PLAYING iPod VIDEO ....................................... 266

10. Bluetooth® AUDIO OPERATION......................................... 269

CONNECTING A Bluetooth® AUDIO PLAYER ................................................................... 273

PLAYING Bluetooth® AUDIO........................ 274

11. REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM FEATURES .......................... 279

DISPLAY .................................................................... 280

REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM CONTROLLER .............................. 280

HEADPHONE JACKS ......................................... 281

HEADPHONES ....................................................... 281

VOLUME..................................................................... 281

CAUTION SCREEN.............................................. 281

TURNING THE REAR DISPLAY ON/OFF................................................................. 282

CHANGING THE DISPLAY TO BE OPERATED .......................................................... 282

TURNING THE REAR DISPLAY OFF USING THE REMOTE CONTROLLER................................................... 282

CHANGING THE SOURCE .......................... 282

CHANGING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT.... 283

OPERATION FROM THE FRONT SEATS .................................................... 284

USING THE RADIO............................................. 285

USING THE RADIO (INTERNET RADIO BROADCAST) .................................. 286

PLAYING iPod........................................................ 286

PLAYING A USB MEMORY .......................... 287

PLAYING Bluetooth® AUDIO....................... 288

PLAYING AN AUDIO CD/CD TEXT ....... 289

PLAYING MP3/WMA DISCS ....................... 290

PLAYING DVD VIDEO ..................................... 290

USING THE VIDEO MODE ............................. 297

CHANGING SETTINGS.................................... 297

12. AUDIO/VIDEO REMOTE CONTROLS (STEERING SWITCHES) .................. 300

13. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATING HINTS .......................... 302

RADIO RECEPTION........................................... 302

iPod................................................................................ 303

USB MEMORY....................................................... 304

CARING FOR YOUR DVD PLAYER AND DISC......................................... 304

MP3/WMA FILES ................................................. 306

CD-R AND CD-RW DISCS ............................. 308

TERMS ......................................................................... 308

1. AUDIO SETTINGS .................................. 312

HD Radio™ SYSTEM SETTINGS..................... 312

iPod SETTINGS......................................................... 313

2 SETUP

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

Page 212: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

212

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

1. QUICK REFERENCE

Operations such as selecting a preset station and adjusting the sound balance are car-ried out on the screen. Using the instrument panelPress the “RADIO” or “MEDIA” button to display the audio/video screen.Using the Remote TouchPress the “MENU” button on the Remote Touch, then select “Radio” or “Media” todisplay the audio/video screen.If a Mark Levinson brand audio system is installed, the “Mark Levinson” logo is shownon the panel.

Page 213: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

213

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No. Name Function Page

Function menu tab Select the desired radio or media mode screentab. 216

Function menu display screen

Select to control the selected radio or mediamode. 216

“ ” button Press to mute/unmute or pause/resume the cur-rent operation. —

“TUNE·SCROLL”knob

Turn to step up and step down the station band,change to the next or previous satellite radiochannel, or skip to the next or previous track,DVD chapter, etc.

221, 230, 236, 238, 243, 259, 264, 275

“PRST·TRACK”button

Press the “ ” or “ ” button to preset up or downfor a station or channel, or to change a desiredtrack, file or chapter.Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button to seek up ordown for a station or channel, or to fast forward-ing/rewinding for a track, file or chapter.

222, 231, 236, 239, 243, 259, 264, 267,

275

Disc slot Insert discs into the slot. 235

“MEDIA” button Press to display the media control screen. 215

“RADIO” button Press to display the radio control screen. 215

“PWR·VOL” knob Press to turn the audio/video system on and off,and turn to adjust the volume. 215

“ ” button Press to eject a disc. 235

Page 214: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

214

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. SOME BASICS

This section describes some of the basicfeatures of the audio/video system.Some information may not pertain toyour system.Your audio/video system works whenthe “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is turned to ACCESSO-RY or ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

CAUTION

●For vehicles sold in U.S.A.:Part 15 of the FCC RulesFCC WARNING: Changes ormodifications not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliancecould void the user’s authority to operatethe equipment.

●Laser products• USE OF CONTROL OR

ADJUSTMENT OR PERFORMANCEOF PROCEDURES OTHER THANTHOSE SPECIFIED HEREIN MAYRESULT IN HAZARDOUSRADIATION EXPOSURE.

• THE USE OF OPTICALINSTRUMENTS WITH THISPRODUCT WILL INCREASE EYEHAZARD.

NOTICE

●To prevent the 12-volt battery from beingdischarged, do not leave the audio/videosystem on longer than necessary whenthe hybrid system is not operating <theengine is not running>.

Page 215: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

215

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

“PWR·VOL” knob: Press to turn the audio/video system on and off. Turn this knob toadjust the volume. The system turns on inthe last mode used.“RADIO”, “MEDIA” button: Press to dis-play screen buttons for the audio/video sys-tem.

VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM

Press this switch to operate the voicecommand system.

For the operation of the voice commandsystem and its list of commands, seepages 330 and 339.

AUDIO SPLIT SCREEN DISPLAY

The audio split screen can be displayedwhile the map screen is displayed. Fordetails, see page 47.

TURNING THE SYSTEM ON AND OFF

A function that enables automatic returnto the previous screen from the audio/video screen can be selected. See page53 for details.

Page 216: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

216

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Using the instrument panel

1 Each time the “RADIO” or “MEDIA”button is pressed, the audio controlmode changes.

“RADIO” button: To display the “AM”,“FM”, “SAT” and “Apps” tabs on the screen.(Radio mode)“MEDIA” button: To display the “DISC”,“BT Audio”, “AUX” and “USB”/“iPod” tabson the screen. (Media mode)

Using the Remote Touch

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Radio” or “Media”.

3 Select the desired tab.

SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNCTIONS

Up to 4 tabs can be displayed on thescreen. Select or , located eitherside of the screen tabs, to display tabsfrom the previous or next page.The desired audio mode can be found by

selecting or and then selectingthat audio mode tab.The “Rear” tab can only be displayed by

selecting or on the screen.

INFORMATION

●If a disc is not inserted, the DVD playercannot be turned on.

●The DVD player can be turned off byejecting a disc.

●When radio or media mode is selected,the respective screen buttons are dis-played on the screen.

●Dimmed screen buttons cannot be oper-ated.

Page 217: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

217

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “RADIO” or “MEDIA” but-ton. (Using the instrument panel)Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch and select “Radio” or“Media”. (Using the Remote Touch)

2 Select .

3 Select the “DSP” tab to display thisscreen.

4 Select the desired items to be set.

5 Select “OK”.

1 Select “Automatic Sound Levelizer”.

2 Select “On” or “Off”.

1 Select “Surround”.

2 Select “On” or “Off”.

1 Select the “Sound” tab to display thisscreen.

DSP CONTROL

AUTOMATIC SOUND LEVELIZER (ASL)

The system adjusts to the optimum vol-ume and tone quality according to vehi-cle speed to compensate for increasedvehicle noise.

SURROUND FUNCTION

This function can create a feeling ofpresence.

TONE AND BALANCE

TONE

How good an audio program sounds islargely determined by the mix of the tre-ble, mid and bass levels. In fact, differentkinds of music and vocal programs usu-ally sound better with different mixes oftreble, mid and bass.

BALANCE

A good balance of the left and right ste-reo channels and of the front and rearsound levels is also important.Keep in mind that when listening to a ste-reo recording or broadcast, changingthe right/left balance will increase thevolume of 1 group of sounds while de-creasing the volume of another.

Page 218: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

218

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Select the desired screen button.

3 Select “OK”.

1 Press the “MEDIA” button. (Using theinstrument panel)Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch and select “Media”.(Using the Remote Touch)

2 Select the “DISC” tab.

3 Select “Options”.

4 Select “Wide”.

5 Select the desired screen button.

When is selected, the previousscreen is displayed.

6 Select “Save”.

Screen button Function

“Treble”“+” or “-”

Select to adjust high-pitched tones.

“Mid”“+” or “-”

Select to adjust mid-pitched tones.

“Bass”“+” or “-”

Select to adjust low-pitched tones.

“Front” or “Rear”

Select to adjust thesound balance betweenthe front and rearspeakers.

“L” or “R”

Select to adjust thesound balance betweenthe left and right speak-ers.

INFORMATION

●The tone of each mode (such as AM, FMand DVD player) can be adjusted.

SELECTING SCREEN SIZE

Before selecting screen size, it is neces-sary to insert a DVD disc and selectDISC mode.

No. Function

Select to display a 4 : 3 screen, witheither side in black.

Select to widen the 4 : 3 screen hori-zontally to fill the screen.

Select to widen the 4 : 3 screen verti-cally and horizontally, by the same ra-tio, to fill the screen.

Page 219: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

219

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 When inserting a disc, gently insert thedisc with the label facing up.

1 Press the “MEDIA” button to display themedia control screen and select the“AUX” tab or press the “MEDIA” buttonrepeatedly to change to AUX mode.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

DVD PLAYER

NOTICE

●Never try to disassemble or oil any part ofthe DVD player. Do not insert anythingother than a disc into the slot.

INFORMATION

●The player is intended for use with 4.7 in.(12 cm) discs only.

AUX PORT

The sound of portable audio playersconnected to the AUX port can be en-joyed. For details, refer to “Owner’sManual”.

CAUTION

●Do not connect portable audio device oroperate the controls.

NOTICE

●Depending on the size and shape of theportable audio device that is connectedto the system, the armrest may not closefully. In this case, do not forcibly close thearmrest as this may damage the portableaudio device or the terminal, etc.

●Do not leave portable audio device in thevehicle. The temperature inside the vehi-cle may become high, resulting in dam-age to the player.

●Do not push down on or apply unneces-sary pressure to the portable audiodevice while it is connected as this maydamage the portable audio device or itsterminal.

●Do not insert foreign objects into the portas this may damage the portable audiodevice or its terminal.

Page 220: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

220

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MEDIA” button to display themedia control screen and select the“USB” or “iPod” tab or press the“MEDIA” button repeatedly to changeto USB memory or iPod mode.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

INFORMATION

●When the portable audio player is notconnected to the AUX port, the tab willbe dimmed.

USB PORT

A USB memory/iPod can be connectedto the USB port. For details, see “CON-NECTING A USB MEMORY” on page256 and “CONNECTING iPod” onpage 262.

INFORMATION

●When a USB memory/iPod is not con-nected with the USB port, the tab will bedimmed.

Page 221: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

221

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

3. RADIO OPERATION

1 Press the “RADIO” button.

2 Select the “AM”, “FM”, “SAT” or “Apps”tab or press the “RADIO” button re-peatedly to select the desired tab.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

1 Turn the knob clockwise to step up thestation band or counterclockwise tostep down.

1 Tune in the desired station.

2 Select one of the left side screen buttons(1-6) and hold it until a beep is heard.This sets the frequency to the screenbutton. The station’s frequency will bedisplayed in the screen button.

To change the preset station to a differentone, follow the same procedure.

LISTENING TO THE RADIO

SELECTING A RADIO STATION

STEP UP AND DOWN THE STATION BAND

INFORMATION

●The radio automatically changes to ste-reo reception when a stereo broadcast isreceived.

PRESETTING A STATION

Radio mode has a mix preset function,which can store up to 36 stations (6 sta-tions per page x 6 pages) from any of theAM, FM or SAT bands.

Page 222: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

222

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Preset tuning: Select one of the mix presetchannels on the left side of the screen orpress the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to select the desired sta-tion. The screen button is highlighted andthe station frequency appears on thescreen.Seek tuning: Press and hold the “ ” or “ ”button of “PRST·TRACK”. The radio willbegin seeking up or down for a station of thenearest frequency and will stop when a sta-tion is found. Each time the button ispressed, the stations will be searched auto-matically one after another.To scan all the frequencies: Select“SCAN”. “SCAN” will appear on thescreen. The radio will find the next stationand stay there for 10 seconds if “All” or “HDOnly” is selected, or 5 seconds if “Analog”is selected, and then scan again. To staytuned to a station and stop the scanning, se-lect “SCAN” again. (To set HD Radio™system, see page 312.)

1 Select “Options”.

SELECTING A STATION

Tune in the desired station using one ofthe following methods.

RADIO BROADCAST DATA SYSTEM

This audio system is equipped with Ra-dio Broadcast Data Systems (RBDS).RBDS mode allows text messages to bereceived from radio stations that utilizeRBDS transmitters.When RBDS is on, the radio can— only select stations of a particular pro-gram type,— display messages from radio stations,— search for a stronger signal station.RBDS features are available only whenlistening to an FM station thatbroadcasts RBDS information and the“FM info” indicator is on.

SELECTING A DESIRED TYPE

Page 223: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

223

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Select “TYPE ” or “ TYPE” to moveforward and backward through the pro-gram list.

Once a program type has been set, “TYPESEEK” will appear on the screen.The program list is in the following order:

• Classical• Country• EasyLis (Easy Listening)• Inform (Information)• Jazz• News• Oldies• Other• Pop Music• Religion• Rock• R&B (Rhythm and Blues)• Sports• Talk• Traffic (Not available when “HD Radio

Settings” are set to analog.)• Alert (Emergency Alert)

3 Select “TYPE SEEK” and the systemwill start to seek for stations in the rele-vant program type.

“Traffic”: Select to seek a traffic programstation. “TRAF SEEK” will appear on thescreen.

INFORMATION

●If no relevant program can be found, “notype” will appear on the screen.

TRAFFIC ANNOUNCEMENT

A station that regularly broadcasts traf-fic information is automatically located.

INFORMATION

●If no traffic program station is found, “NoTraffic” will appear on the screen.

●If a traffic program station is found, thename of the traffic program station will bedisplayed for a while.

Page 224: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

224

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4. HD Radio™ TECHNOLOGY INFORMATION

1 Press the “RADIO” button.

2 Select the “AM” or “FM” tab or pressthe “RADIO” button repeatedly to se-lect the desired tab.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.As a user works through the analog radio

stations, (where applicable) the radioreceiver will automatically tune from ananalog signal to a digital signal within 5 sec-onds. An orange “HD)” logo indicator will be dis-

played on the screen when in digital. The“HD)” logo will first appear in a gray colorindicating the station is indeed (an analogand) a digital station. Once the digital sig-nal is acquired, the logo will change to abright orange color.The song title, artist name and music genre

will appear on the screen when available bythe radio station.

3 This screen will be displayed if“Options” is selected.

HD Radio™ Technology is the digitalevolution of analog AM/FM radio. Yourradio product has a special receiverwhich allows it to receive digital broad-casts (where available) in addition to theanalog broadcasts it already receives.Digital broadcasts have better soundquality than analog broadcasts as digitalbroadcasts provide free, crystal clearaudio with no static or distortion. Formore information, and a guide to avail-able radio stations and programming,refer to www.hdradio.com.

USING HD Radio™ TECHNOLOGY

Page 225: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

225

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

When “Text” is selected, information suchas the artist name, song title, album title andmusic genre of the track being listened toare displayed on the text screen. To displaymessages from the station, select “Addi-tional Information”.When “TYPE ” or “ TYPE” is selected,

a program type will be searched. Once aprogram type has been set, “TYPE SEEK”will appear on the screen. (See “SELECT-ING A DESIRED TYPE” on page 222.)

1 Select “Multicast”.

Each time “Multicast” is selected, the sup-plemental program changes. If “Multicast” is selected when tuned to the

last of the supplemental programs, the mainprogram will be returned to.

1 Select “Tag” to bookmark the music in-formation.

2 Pull up the lever to release the lock, andlift the armrest.

3 Open the cover and connect iPod usingan iPod cable.

AVAILABLE HD Radio™ TECHNOLOGY

MULTICAST

On the FM radio frequency most digitalstations have “multiple” or supplementalprograms on one FM station.

TAG

Page 226: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

226

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Turn on the power of the iPod if it is notturned on.Once an iPod is connected, the music tag

moves from the radio into the iPod.When the iPod is connected to iTunes, the

“tagged” information of the songs whichwere tagged while listening to the radio canbe viewed. Then a user may decide to pur-chase the song or CD/Album which hadbeen listened to on their radio.

4 Close the console box.

INFORMATION

●If tagging the music information fails,“Saving the HD Radio tag failed.” will bedisplayed on the screen. If this occurs, tagthe information again.

●HD Radio™ stations can be preset.

Page 227: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

227

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE

Experience Cause Action

Mismatch of time align-ment- a user may hear ashort period of program-ming replayed or an echo,stutter or skip.

The radio stations analogand digital volume is notproperly aligned or the sta-tion is in ballgame mode.

None, radio broadcast issue. Auser can contact the radio station.

Sound fades, blending inand out.

Radio is shifting betweenanalog and digital audio.

Reception issue, may clear-up asthe vehicle continues to be driven.Selecting “Analog” can force radioin an analog audio.

Audio mute conditionwhen an HD2/HD3 multi-cast channel had been play-ing.

The radio does not have ac-cess to digital signals at themoment.

This is normal behavior, wait untilthe digital signal returns. If out ofthe coverage area, seek a new sta-tion.

Audio mute delay when se-lecting an HD2/HD3 mul-ticast channel preset.

The digital multicast con-tent is not available until HDRadio™ broadcast can bedecoded and make the au-dio available. This takes upto 7 seconds.

This is normal behavior, wait for theaudio to become available.

Text information does notmatch the present song au-dio.

Data service issue by theradio broadcaster.

Broadcaster should be notified.Complete the form; www.ibiquity.com/automotive/report_radio_station_experiences.

No text information shownfor the present selected fre-quency.

Data service issue by theradio broadcaster.

Broadcaster should be notified.Complete the form; www.ibiquity.com/automotive/report_radio_station_experiences.

Page 228: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

228

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity DigitalCorporation. U.S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and the HD, HD Radio, and“Arc” logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp.

Page 229: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

229

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

5. RADIO OPERATION (XM Satellite Radio BROADCAST)

If “CH 000” is selected using the“TUNE·SCROLL” knob, the ID code,which is 8 alphanumeric characters, will bedisplayed. If another channel is selected,the ID code will no longer be displayed.The channel (000) alternates between dis-playing the radio ID and the specific radiocode.

HOW TO SUBSCRIBE TO AN XM Satellite Radio

To listen to a satellite radio broadcast inthe vehicle, a subscription to the XMSatellite Radio service is necessary.An XM Satellite Radio is a tuner de-signed exclusively to receive broadcastsprovided under a separate subscription.Availability is limited to the 48 contigu-ous U.S. states and some Canadianprovinces.

HOW TO SUBSCRIBE

It is necessary to enter into a separateservice agreement with XM SatelliteRadio in order to receive satellite broad-cast programming in the vehicle. Addi-tional activation and servicesubscription fees apply that are not in-cluded in the purchase price of the vehi-cle and digital satellite tuner.

For complete information on subscrip-tion rates and terms, or to subscribe toXM Satellite Radio:

U.S.A.Refer to www.siriusxm.com or call 1-877-515-3987.

CanadaRefer to www.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677.

INFORMATION

●XM Satellite Radio is solely responsiblefor the quality, availability and content ofthe satellite radio services provided,which are subject to the terms and condi-tions of the XM Satellite Radio customerservice agreement.

●Customers should have their radio IDready; the radio ID can be found by tun-ing to “CH 000” on the radio. For details,see “DISPLAYING THE RADIO ID”below.

●All fees and programming are theresponsibility of XM Satellite Radio andare subject to change.

SATELLITE TUNER TECHNOLOGY NOTICE

Lexus’s satellite radio tuners are award-ed Type Approval Certificates from XMSatellite Radio Inc. as proof of compati-bility with the services offered by XMSatellite Radio.

DISPLAYING THE RADIO ID

Each XM tuner is identified with aunique radio ID. The radio ID is requiredwhen activating an XM service or whenreporting a problem.

Page 230: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

230

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “RADIO” button.

2 Select the “SAT” tab or press the“RADIO” button repeatedly until the“SAT” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

3 Turn the “TUNE·SCROLL” knob to se-lect the next or previous channel.

Turning the knob quickly allows rapidscrolling through the channel list.

1 Select either “TYPE ” or “ TYPE” togo to the next or previous category.

1 Tune in the desired channel.

2 Select one of the left side screen buttons(1-6) and hold it until a beep is heard.This sets the frequency to the screenbutton. The channel number will be dis-played in the screen button.

To change the preset channel to a differentone, follow the same procedure.

LISTENING TO SATELLITE RADIO

CHANNEL CATEGORY

PRESETTING A CHANNEL

Page 231: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

231

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Preset tuning: Select the channel selectorscreen button (1-6) or press the “ ” or “ ”button of “PRST·TRACK” to listen to thedesired channel. The selected screen but-ton (1-6) is highlighted and its related infor-mation appears on the right side of thescreen.To select a channel within the current cate-gory: Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” buttonof “PRST·TRACK”. The radio will changeup or down to a channel within the currentchannel category.

To scan the currently selected channel cat-egory: Select “SCAN”. “SCAN” appearson the screen. The radio will find the nextchannel in the same channel category, staythere for a few seconds, and then scanagain. To select a channel, select “SCAN”again.

1 Select “Text” to display the artist nameand song title currently being listeningto.

SELECTING A CHANNEL

Tune in the desired channel using one ofthe following methods.

DISPLAYING THE TITLE AND NAME

INFORMATION

●Up to 64 alphanumeric characters canbe displayed. (Some information will notbe fully displayed.)

Page 232: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

232

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

IF THE SATELLITE RADIO TUNER MALFUNCTIONS

When problems occur with the XM tuner, a message will appear on the screen. Refer-ring to the table below to identify the problem, take the suggested corrective action.

Message Explanation

Ck Antenna

The XM antenna is not connected. Check whether the XM antennacable is attached securely.

A short circuit occurs in the antenna or the surrounding antenna ca-ble. See a Lexus certified dealer for assistance.

Ch Unauth

You have not subscribed to XM Satellite Radio. The radio is beingupdated with the latest encryption code. Contact XM Satellite Radiofor subscription information. When a contract is canceled, you canchoose “CH 000” and all free-to-air channels.

The premium channel you selected is not authorized. Wait for about2 seconds until the radio returns to the previous channel or “CH001”. If it does not change automatically, select another channel. Tolisten to the premium channel, contact XM Satellite Radio.

No Signal The XM signal is too weak at the current location. Wait until your ve-hicle reaches a location with a stronger signal.

Loading The unit is acquiring audio or program information. Wait until the unithas received the information.

Ch Off Air The channel you selected is not broadcasting any programming. Se-lect another channel.

----- There is no song/program title or artist name/feature associated withthe channel at that time. No action is required.

Ch UnavailThe channel you selected is no longer available. Wait for about 2 sec-onds until the radio returns to the previous channel or “CH 001”. If itdoes not change automatically, select another channel.

INFORMATION

●Contact the XM Listener Care Center at 1-877-515-3987 (U.S.A.) or 1-877-438-9677(Canada).

Page 233: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

233

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

NOTICE

●This device complies with IndustryCanada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation of the device.Le présent appareil est conforme auxCNR d’Industrie Canada applicables auxappareils radio exempts de licence.L’exploitation est autorisée aux deuxconditions suivantes : (1) l’appareil ne doitpas produire de brouillage, et (2)l’utilisateur de l’appareil doit acceptertout brouillage radioélectrique subi,même si le brouillage est susceptible d’encompromettre le fonctionnement.

●This device complies with RSS-310 ofIndustry Canada. Operation is subject tothe condition that this device does notcause harmful interference.Cet appareil est conforme au CNR-310d’Industrie Canada. Son exploitation estautorisée sous réserve que l’appareil necause pas de brouillage préjudiciable.

INFORMATION

●This XM tuner supports “Audio Services”(Music and Talk) of only XM SatelliteRadio and “Text Information*” linked tothe respective “Audio Services”.*: Text Information includes, Station

Name, (Artist) Name, (Song) Title andCategory Name.

Page 234: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

234

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6. RADIO OPERATION (INTERNET RADIO BROADCAST)

1 Press the “RADIO” button.

2 Select the “Apps” tab or press the“RADIO” button repeatedly until the“Apps” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

If a compatible phone is already registered,it will be connected automatically. If a compatible phone has not been regis-

tered or the Bluetooth® connection cannotbe completed correctly, select “Connect”to register and/or connect your phone.(See page 197.)When connection is complete, the applica-

tion screen can be displayed.

3 Select “View Application Screen”.The internet radio application screen is dis-

played.Perform operations according to the dis-

played application screen.By pressing the “RADIO” button, the

“Audio” screen can be returned to.

*: For details, refer to http://www.lexus.com/enform/ or call 1-800-255-3987.

LISTENING TO INTERNET RADIO

One of Apps’s features is the ability tolisten to internet radio. In order to usethis service, an Apps compatible phoneand the navigation system needs to beset. For details, refer to “APPS”. (Seepage 380.)

INFORMATION

●Other applications can be activatedwhile listening to internet radio.

●An iPhone cannot be connected viaBluetooth® and USB connection at thesame time. However, it is possible torecharge an iPhone while using Apps byconnecting via USB. The system uses theconnection method that was used last.Therefore, if connected via USB afterBluetooth® connection, it is necessary toreconnect the iPhone via Bluetooth®.

●Services requiring a separate contractcan also be used.*

●Some parts of “Apps” can be adjustedusing the switches on the steering wheel.

●If internet radio has never been listenedto by activating “Apps” from the “Informa-tion” screen, the “Apps” tab will bedimmed.

Page 235: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

235

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

7. DVD PLAYER OPERATION

1 Insert a disc into the disc slot.

After insertion, the disc is automaticallyloaded.

1 Press the “ ” button and remove thedisc.

For safety reasons, the DVD video discscan only be viewed when the followingconditions are met:(a) The vehicle is completely stopped.(b) The “POWER” <“ENGINE START

STOP”> switch is in ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

(c) The parking brake is applied. While driving in DVD video mode, onlythe DVD’s audio can be heard.

INSERTING A DISC

EJECTING A DISC

INFORMATION

●Under extremely cold conditions, thescreen may react slowly or operationsound may become louder.

●If a disc is inserted with the label facingdown, it cannot be played.

Page 236: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

236

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MEDIA” button if a disc hasalready been loaded in the disc slot.

2 Select the “DISC” tab or press the“MEDIA” button repeatedly until the“DISC” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

1 Select the “DISC” tab.

When CD-TEXT information exists, thename and artist of the CD currently beinglistened to will be displayed.

: Select to pause the track. : Select to resume playing the track.

■ ON THE AUDIO TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previoustrack.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” repeatedlyuntil the desired track number appears onthe screen. The player will start playing theselected track from the beginning.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to skip tothe desired track.

PLAYING A DISC PLAYING AN AUDIO DISC

SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK

Page 237: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

237

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ ON THE TRACK LIST SCREEN

1 Select the track name screen button todisplay the CD’s track list.

2 Select the desired track number. Theplayer will start playing the selectedtrack from the beginning.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 track groups. If either of these screen but-tons is selected when the top/bottom pageof the list is displayed, the last/first page isdisplayed.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” to scrollthrough the track list one by one. “TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the track list.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

■ FAST FORWARDING OR RE-WINDING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the disc.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

■ REPEATING A TRACK

1 Select “RPT” while the track is playing.

“RPT” appears on the screen. When thetrack is finished, the player will automati-cally play it again. To cancel this function,select “RPT” again.

REPEATING

The track currently being listened to canbe repeated.

Page 238: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

238

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ PLAYING THE TRACKS ON THEDISC IN RANDOM ORDER

1 Select “RAND” while the disc is playing.

Once “RAND” appears on the screen, thesystem selects a track randomly from thedisc currently being listened to. To cancelthis function, select “RAND” again.

1 Select the “DISC” tab.

The file name, folder name and artist namecurrently being listened to and the disc iconare displayed on the screen.

: Select to pause the file.: Select to resume playing the file.

■ ON THE AUDIO TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previousfolder.

RANDOM ORDER

Tracks or albums can be automaticallyand randomly selected.

INFORMATION

●If a CD-TEXT disc is inserted, the title ofthe disc and track will be displayed. Up to32 characters can be displayed.

PLAYING AN MP3/WMA DISC

SELECTING A DESIRED FOLDER

Page 239: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

239

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ ON THE FOLDER LIST SCREEN

1 Select the folder name screen button todisplay the following folder list screen.

2 Select the desired folder number to dis-play the folder’s file list. From the file list,select the desired file number.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 folder groups. If either of these screenbuttons is selected when the top/bottompage of the list is displayed, the last/firstpage is displayed.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the folder list.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

■ FAST FORWARDING OR RE-WINDING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the file.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

■ ON THE AUDIO TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previousfile.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” repeatedlyuntil the desired file number appears on thescreen. The player will start playing the se-lected file from the beginning.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to skip tothe desired file.

SELECTING A DESIRED FILE

Page 240: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

240

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ ON THE FILE LIST SCREEN

1 Select the file name screen button todisplay the following file list screen.

2 Select the desired file number. The play-er will start playing the selected file fromthe beginning.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 file groups. If either of these screen but-tons is selected when the top/bottom pageof the list is displayed, the last/first page isdisplayed.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” to scrollthrough the file list one by one.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the file list.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

■ FAST FORWARDING OR RE-WINDING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the file.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

■ REPEATING A FILE

1 Select “RPT” while the file is playing.

REPEATING

The file or folder currently being listenedto can be repeated.

Page 241: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

241

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Each time “RPT” is selected, the modechanges as follows:

When “RAND” is off• File Repeat Folder Repeat Off

When “RAND” is on• File RepeatOff “RPT” appears on the screen. When the file

is finished, the player will automatically playit again. To cancel this function, select“RPT” repeatedly until the repeat modeturns off.

■ REPEATING A FOLDER

1 Select “RPT” repeatedly until“FLD.RPT” appears on the screen.

When the folder is finished, the player willautomatically go back to the beginning ofthe folder and play it again. To cancel thisfunction, select “RPT” again.

■ PLAYING FILES FROM ONEFOLDER IN RANDOM ORDER

1 Select “RAND” while the disc is playing.

Each time “RAND” is selected, the modechanges as follows:• Random (1 Folder Random)

Folder Random (1 Disc Random) OffOnce “RAND” appears on the screen, the

system selects a file randomly from thefolder currently being listened to. To cancelthis function, select “RAND” repeatedlyuntil the random mode turns off.

■ PLAYING THE FILES IN ALL THEFOLDERS ON THE DISC IN RAN-DOM ORDER

1 Select “RAND” repeatedly until“FLD.RAND” appears on the screen.

Once “FLD.RAND” appears on the screen,the system selects a file randomly from allof the existing folders. To cancel this func-tion, select “RAND” again.

RANDOM ORDER

Files or folders can be automatically andrandomly selected.

INFORMATION

●When a file is skipped or the system isinoperative, select “RAND” to reset.

OPERATING A DVD DISC

The playback condition of some DVDdiscs may be determined by the DVDsoftware producer. This DVD playerplays a disc as the software producer in-tended. As such some functions may notwork properly. Be sure to read the in-struction manual that comes with the in-dividual DVD disc. For detailedinformation about DVD video discs, see“DVD PLAYER AND DVD VIDEODISC INFORMATION” on page 254.

Page 242: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

242

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MEDIA” button if a disc hasalready been loaded in the disc slot.

2 Select the “DISC” tab or press the“MEDIA” button repeatedly until the“DISC” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.Select “Options” on the “DVD” screen,

then select “Wide” on the “DVD Options”screen. The screen mode can be changed. If “Full Screen” is selected when the vehicle

is completely stopped and the parkingbrake is applied, the video screen returns.

PRECAUTIONS ON DVD VIDEO DISC

When recording with a DVD video, au-dio tracks may not record in some caseswhile the menu is displayed. As audiowill not play in this case, verify that thevideo tracks are playing and then acti-vate playback.When playback of a disc is completed:If an audio CD or MP3/WMA disc isplaying, the first track or file starts.If a DVD video is playing, playback willstop or the menu screen will be dis-played.The title/chapter number and playbacktime display may not appear while play-ing back certain DVD video discs.

CAUTION

●Conversational speech on some DVDs isrecorded at a low volume to emphasizethe impact of sound effects. If you adjustthe volume assuming that the conversa-tions represent the maximum volumelevel that the DVD will play, you may bestartled by louder sound effects or whenyou change to a different audio source.The louder sounds may have a significantimpact on the human body or pose a driv-ing hazard. Keep this in mind when youadjust the volume.

PLAYING A DVD DISC

Page 243: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

243

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

If is selected, while watching a DVD, theDVD controls will appear.

■ CHANGING A CHAPTER

1 Press the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” or turn the“TUNE·SCROLL” knob to change thechapter.

DISPLAYING DVD CONTROLS

INFORMATION

●If appears on the screen when a con-trol is selected, the operation relevant tothe control is not permitted.

DESCRIPTION OF DVD VIDEO CONTROLS

Screen button Function

“Top Menu”, “Menu”

Select to display the menuscreen for DVD video.

The menu control key ap-pears on the screen. (Seepage 243.)

Select to pause the videoscreen.

Select to rewind duringplayback.

Select to stop the videoscreen.

Select to resume normalplay during pause.

Select to fast forward dur-ing playback and forwardframe by frame duringpause.

Page 244: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

244

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select the menu item using , , or and select “Enter”. The

player starts playing the disc from thestart of the selected item.

When is selected, the previousscreen is displayed.

1 Select the “DISC” tab.

2 Select “Options”.

3 This screen is displayed.

SELECTING A MENU ITEM

INFORMATION

●According to the DVD disc, some menuitems can be selected directly. (Fordetails, see the manual that comes withthe DVD disc provided separately.)

DVD OPTIONS

No. Function Page

Select to display the titlesearch screen. 245

Select to display the prede-termined scene on thescreen and start playing.

Select to display the audioselection screen. 245

Select to display the subtitleselection screen. 245

Select to display the angleselection screen. 245

Select to display the screenmode screen. 218

Select to display the imagequality adjustment screen. 246

Select to display the initialsetup screen. 247

Page 245: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

245

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Search” on the “DVD Options”screen.

2 Enter the title number and select “OK”.

The player starts playing video for that titlenumber. If the wrong numbers are entered, select

to delete the numbers.When is selected, the previous

screen is displayed.

1 Select “Audio” on the “DVD Options”screen.

2 Each time “Change” is selected, the au-dio language is changed.

The languages available are restricted tothose available on the DVD disc.When is selected, the previous

screen is displayed.

1 Select “Subtitle” on the “DVD Options”screen.

2 Each time “Change” is selected, the lan-guage the subtitles are displayed in ischanged.

The languages available are restricted tothose available on the DVD disc.When “Hide” is selected, the subtitles can

be hidden.When is selected, the previous

screen is displayed.

1 Select “Angle” on the “DVD Options”screen.

SEARCHING BY TITLE

CHANGING THE AUDIO LANGUAGE

CHANGING THE SUBTITLE LANGUAGE

CHANGING THE ANGLE

The angle can be selected for discs thatare multi-angle compatible when the an-gle mark appears on the screen.

Page 246: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

246

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Each time “Change” is selected, the an-gle is changed.

The angles available are restricted to thoseavailable on the DVD disc.When is selected, the previous

screen is displayed.

■ CONTRAST, BRIGHTNESS, COL-OR AND TONE ADJUSTMENT

1 Select “Display” on the “DVD Options”screen.

2 Select “ ” or “ ” to display the desireditem to be adjusted.

3 After adjusting the screen, select “OK”.The screen goes off when “Screen Off” is

selected. To turn the screen back on, pressany button on the audio panel or on theRemote Touch. The selected screenappears.

AUDIO SCREEN ADJUSTMENT

The brightness, contrast, color and toneof the screen can be adjusted. In addi-tion, the display can be turned off andthe screen can be changed to either dayor night mode.

Screen button Function

“Contrast” “+” Select to strengthen thecontrast of the screen.

“Contrast” “-” Select to weaken thecontrast of the screen.

“Brightness” “+” Select to brighten thescreen.

“Brightness” “-” Select to darken thescreen.

“Color” “R” Select to strengthen thered color of the screen.

“Color” “G”Select to strengthen thegreen color of thescreen.

“Tone” “+” Select to strengthen thetone of the screen.

“Tone” “-” Select to weaken thetone of the screen.

Page 247: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

247

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “DVD Settings” on the “DVDOptions” screen.

2 Select the items to be set.

3 After the initial setting has beenchanged, select “Save”.

This screen will close, and the system willreturn to the previous screen.When “Default” is selected, all menus are

initialized.

■ AUDIO LANGUAGE

1 Select “Audio Language” on the “DVDSettings” screen.

2 Select the desired language to be heardon the “Audio Language” screen.

If the desired language to be heard cannotbe found on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For entry of a lan-guage code, see “ENTER AUDIO/SUBTI-TLE/MENU LANGUAGE CODE” onpage 249.To return to the “DVD Settings” screen,

select .

3 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

■ SUBTITLE LANGUAGE

1 Select “Subtitle Language” on the“DVD Settings” screen.

2 Select the desired language to be readon the “Subtitle Language” screen.

If the desired language to be read cannotbe found on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For entry of a lan-guage code, see “ENTER AUDIO/SUBTI-TLE/MENU LANGUAGE CODE” onpage 249.To return to the “DVD Settings” screen,

select .

3 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

DVD SETTINGS

The audio language can be changed.

The subtitle language can be changed.

Page 248: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

248

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ MENU LANGUAGE

1 Select “Menu Language” on the “DVDSettings” screen.

2 Select the desired language to be readon the “Menu Language” screen.

If the desired language to be read cannotbe found on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For entry of a lan-guage code, see “ENTER AUDIO/SUBTI-TLE/MENU LANGUAGE CODE” onpage 249.To return to the “DVD Settings” screen,

select .

3 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

■ ANGLE MARK

1 Select “Angle Mark” on the “DVD Set-tings” screen.

2 Select “On” or “Off”.

3 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

■ PARENTAL LOCK

1 Select “Parental Lock” on the “DVDSettings” screen.

2 Enter the 4-digit personal code on the“Key Code” screen.

If the wrong numbers are entered, select to delete the numbers.

To return to the “DVD Settings” screen,select .

3 Select a parental level (1-8) on the “Se-lect Restriction Level” screen.

To return to the “DVD Settings” screen,select .

4 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

■ AUTO START PLAYBACK

1 Select “Auto Start Playback” on the“DVD Settings” screen.

2 Select “On” or “Off”.

3 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

The language on the DVD video menucan be changed.

The multi-angle mark can be turned onor off on the screen while discs that aremulti-angle compatible are beingplayed.

The level of viewer restrictions can bechanged.

Discs that are inserted while the vehicleis in motion will automatically start play-ing. Certain discs may not play.

Page 249: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

249

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ SOUND DYNAMIC RANGE

1 Select “Sound Dynamic Range” on the“DVD Settings” screen.

2 Select “MAX”, “STD” or “MIN”.

3 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

1 Enter the 4-digit language code.

If the wrong numbers are entered, select to delete the numbers.

To return to the “DVD Settings” screen,select .

2 Select “OK”.

3 Select “Save” on the “DVD Settings”screen.

The difference between the lowest vol-ume and the highest volume can be ad-justed.

ENTER AUDIO/SUBTITLE/MENU LANGUAGE CODE

If “Other” on the “Audio Language”screen, “Subtitle Language” screen or“Menu Language” screen is selected,the desired language to be heard orread can be selected by entering a lan-guage code.

Page 250: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

250

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Code Language

0514 English

1001 Japanese

0618 French

0405 German

0920 Italian

0519 Spanish

2608 Chinese

1412 Dutch

1620 Portuguese

1922 Swedish

1821 Russian

1115 Korean

0512 Greek

0101 Afar

0102 Abkhazian

0106 Afrikaans

0113 Amharic

0118 Arabic

0119 Assamese

0125 Aymara

0126 Azerbaijani

0201 Bashkir

0205 Byelorussian

0207 Bulgarian

0208 Bihari

0209 Bislama

0214 Bengali, Bangla

0215 Tibetan

0218 Breton

0301 Catalan

0315 Corsican

0319 Czech

0325 Welsh

0401 Danish

0426 Bhutani

0515 Esperanto

0520 Estonian

0521 Basque

0601 Persian

0609 Finnish

0610 Fiji

0615 Faroese

0625 Frisian

0701 Irish

0704 Scottish-Gaelic

0712 Galician

0714 Guarani

0721 Gujarati

0801 Hausa

0809 Hindi

0818 Croatian

0821 Hungarian

Code Language

Page 251: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

251

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

0825 Armenian

0901 Interlingua

0905 Interlingue

0911 Inupiak

0914 Indonesian

0919 Icelandic

0923 Hebrew

1009 Yiddish

1023 Javanese

1101 Georgian

1111 Kazakh

1112 Greenlandic

1113 Cambodian

1114 Kannada

1119 Kashmiri

1121 Kurdish

1125 Kirghiz

1201 Latin

1214 Lingala

1215 Laotian

1220 Lithuanian

1222 Latvian, Lettish

1307 Malagasy

1309 Maori

1311 Macedonian

1312 Malayalam

Code Language

1314 Mongolian

1315 Moldavian

1318 Marathi

1319 Malay

1320 Maltese

1325 Burmese

1401 Nauru

1405 Nepali

1415 Norwegian

1503 Occitan

1513 (Afan) Oromo

1518 Oriya

1601 Panjabi

1612 Polish

1619 Pashto, Pushto

1721 Quechua

1813 Rhaeto-Romance

1814 Kirundi

1815 Romanian

1823 Kinyarwanda

1901 Sanskrit

1904 Sindhi

1907 Sango

1908 Serbo-Croatian

1909 Sinhalese

1911 Slovak

Code Language

Page 252: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

252

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1912 Slovenian

1913 Samoan

1914 Shona

1915 Somali

1917 Albanian

1918 Serbian

1919 Siswati

1920 Sesotho

1921 Sundanese

1923 Swahili

2001 Tamil

2005 Telugu

2007 Tajik

2008 Thai

2009 Tigrinya

2011 Turkmen

2012 Tagalog

2014 Setswana

2015 Tongan

2018 Turkish

2019 Tsonga

2020 Tatar

2023 Twi

2111 Ukrainian

2118 Urdu

2126 Uzbek

Code Language

2209 Vietnamese

2215 Volapük

2315 Wolof

2408 Xhosa

2515 Yoruba

2621 Zulu

Code Language

Page 253: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

253

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Vehicles with rear seat entertainmentsystem

Front passengers can cancel this setupoperation by selecting “Play”. The playerwill resume normal play.Likewise, a rear passenger can cancel a

front passenger’s selection of the setupmenu.To lock the rear seat entertainment system,

see “OPERATION FROM THE FRONTSEATS” on page 284.

If “Check DISC” appears on the screen: Itindicates that the disc is dirty, damaged, or itwas inserted upside down. Clean the disc orinsert it correctly. If a disc which is not play-able is inserted, “Check DISC” will also ap-pear on the screen. For appropriate discsfor the player, see “AUDIO/VIDEO SYS-TEM OPERATING HINTS” on page 302.If “Region code error” appears on thescreen: It indicates that the DVD regioncode is not set properly.If the malfunction is not rectified: Takeyour vehicle to your Lexus dealer.

SETUP OPERATION FROM THE REAR SEAT

This screen appears when a rear pas-senger selects the setup menu.

IF THE PLAYER MALFUNCTIONS

If the player or another unit equippedwith the player malfunctions, the audio/video system will display a message.These are described below.

INFORMATION

●If an MP3/WMA disc contains CD-DAfiles only, the CD-DA files can be played.If an MP3/WMA disc contains CD-DAfiles and files other than CD-DA files,only MP3/WMA files can be played.

Page 254: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

254

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Region codes: Some DVD video discs havea region code indicating which countriesthe DVD video disc can be played in on thisDVD player. If the DVD video disc is not la-beled as “ALL” or “1”, you cannot use it onthis DVD player. If you attempt to play an in-appropriate DVD video disc on this player,“Region code error” appears on the screen.Even if the DVD video disc does not have aregion code, there are cases when it cannotbe used.

■ MARKS SHOWN ON DVD VIDEODISCS

DVD PLAYER AND DVD VIDEO DISC INFORMATION

DVD VIDEO DISCS

This DVD player conforms to NTSC/PAL color TV formats. DVD video discsconforming to another format such asSECAM cannot be used.

NTSC/PAL Indicates NTSC/PALformat of color TV.

Indicates the numberof audio tracks.

Indicates the numberof language subtitles.

Indicates the numberof angles.

Indicates the screen tobe selected.Wide screen: 16:9Standard: 4:3

Indicates a regioncode by which this vid-eo disc can be played.ALL: in all countriesNumber: region code

Page 255: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

255

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

DVD video discs: Digital Versatile Disc thatholds video. DVD video discs have adopted“MPEG2”, one of the world standards ofdigital compression technologies. The pic-ture data is compressed by 1/40 on aver-age and stored. Variable rate encodedtechnology in which the volume of data as-signed to the picture is changed dependingon the picture format has also been adopt-ed. Audio data is stored using PCM andDolby Digital, which enables higher qualityof sound. Furthermore, multi-angle andmulti-language features will also help usersenjoy the more advanced technology ofDVD video.Viewer restrictions: This feature limits whatcan be viewed in conformity with a level ofrestrictions of the country. The level of re-strictions varies depending on the DVD vid-eo disc. Some DVD video discs cannot beplayed at all, or violent scenes are skippedor replaced with other scenes.

• Level 1: DVD video discs for children canbe played.

• Level 2 - 7: DVD video discs for childrenand G-rated movie can be played.

• Level 8: All types of the DVD video discscan be played.

Multi-angle feature: The same scene canbe enjoyed from different angles.Multi-language feature: The subtitle andaudio language can be selected.Region codes: The region codes are pro-vided on DVD players and DVD discs. If theDVD video disc does not have the same re-gion code as the DVD player, you cannotplay the disc on the DVD player. For regioncodes, see page 254.Audio: This DVD player can play linerPCM, Dolby Digital and MPEG audio for-mat DVDs. Other decoded types cannot beplayed.Title and chapter: Video and audio pro-grams stored in DVD video discs are divid-ed into parts by title and chapter.Title: The largest unit of the video and audioprograms stored on DVD video discs. Usu-ally, one movie, one album, or one audioprogram is assigned as a title.Chapter: A unit smaller than that of title. Atitle comprises of several chapters.

DVD VIDEO DISC GLOSSARY

Manufactured under license from DolbyLaboratories. Dolby and the double-Dsymbol are trademarks of DolbyLaboratories.

Page 256: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

256

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8. USB MEMORY OPERATION

1 Pull up the lever to release the lock, andlift the armrest.

2 Open the cover and connect a USBmemory.

Turn on the power of the USB memory if itis not turned on.

3 Close the console box.

Connecting a USB memory enables us-ers to enjoy music from the vehiclespeakers.

CAUTION

●Do not operate the player’s controls orconnect the USB memory while driving.

NOTICE

●Depending on the size and shape of theUSB memory that is connected to thesystem, the armrest may not close fully. Inthis case, do not forcibly close the arm-rest as this may damage the USB mem-ory or the terminal, etc.

●Do not leave your portable player in thecar. In particular, high temperaturesinside the vehicle may damage the porta-ble player.

●Do not push down on or apply unneces-sary pressure to the portable player whileit is connected as this may damage theportable player or its terminal.

●Do not insert foreign objects into the portas this may damage the portable playeror its terminal.

CONNECTING A USB MEMORY

Page 257: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

257

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MEDIA” button if a USBmemory has already been connected.

2 Select the “USB” tab or press the“MEDIA” button repeatedly until the“USB” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

Tag mode

Folder mode

: Select to start playing the music.: Select to pause the music.: Select to start playing the music again.

PLAYING A USB MEMORY

PLAYING AND PAUSING A USB MEMORY

INFORMATION

●If tag information exists, the file/foldernames will be changed to track/albumnames.

INFORMATION

●When the USB memory is connectedand the audio source is changed to USBmemory mode, the USB memory willstart playing the first file in the first folder.If the same device is removed and rein-serted (and the contents have not beenchanged), the USB memory will resumeplaying from the same point it was lastused.

●Depending on the USB memory that isconnected to the system, certain func-tions may not be available.

Page 258: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

258

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ ON THE USB TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previousfolder/album.

1 Select the folder/album name screenbutton.

2 Select the desired tab and select the de-sired folder, artist or album.

Character screen buttons, “ABC”, “DEF”etc., allow a direct jump to list entries thatbegin with the same letter as the characterbutton.Each time the same character screen but-ton is selected, the list starting with the sub-sequent character is displayed.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 folder/artist/album groups. If either ofthese screen buttons is selected when thetop/bottom page of the list is displayed, thelast/first page is displayed.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the folder/artist/albumlist.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

SELECTING A DESIRED FOLDER/ALBUM

SELECTING A DESIRED FOLDER, ARTIST OR ALBUM

Page 259: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

259

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ ON THE USB TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previousfile/track.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” repeatedlyuntil the desired file/track number appearson the screen. The player will start playingthe selected file/track from the beginning.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to skip tothe desired file/track.

■ ON THE FILE/TRACK LISTSCREEN

1 Select the file/track name screen buttonto display the following file/track listscreen.

2 Select the desired file/track number.The player will start playing the selectedfile/track from the beginning.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 file/track groups. If either of these screenbuttons is selected when the top/bottompage of the list is displayed, the last/firstpage is displayed.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” to scrollthrough the file/track list one by one.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the file/track list.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

SELECTING A DESIRED FILE/TRACK

Page 260: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

260

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ FAST FORWARDING OR RE-WINDING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the file/track.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

■ REPEATING A FILE/TRACK

1 Select “RPT” while the file or track isplaying.

Each time “RPT” is selected, the modechanges as follows:

When “RAND” is off• File/Track Repeat Folder/Album

Repeat Off

When “RAND” is on• File/Track Repeat Off “RPT” appears on the screen. When the

file/track is finished, the player will auto-matically play it again. To cancel this func-tion, select “RPT” repeatedly until therepeat mode turns off.

■ REPEATING A FOLDER/ALBUM

1 Select “RPT” repeatedly until“FLD.RPT” appears on the screen.

When the folder/album is finished, theplayer will automatically go back to thebeginning of the folder/album and play itagain. To cancel this function, select “RPT”again.

REPEATING

The file or folder currently being listenedto can be repeated.

Page 261: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

261

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ PLAYING FILES/TRACKS IN RAN-DOM ORDER

1 Select “RAND” while the file or track isplaying.

Each time “RAND” is selected, the modechanges as follows:• Random (1 Folder/Album Random)

Folder/Album Random (All Folder/AlbumRandom) Off

Once “RAND” appears on the screen, thesystem selects a file/track randomly fromthe folder/album currently being listened to.To cancel this function, select “RAND”repeatedly until the random mode turns off.

■ ALL FOLDER/ALBUM RANDOMPLAY

1 Select “RAND” repeatedly until“FLD.RAND” appears on the screen.

Once “FLD.RAND”/“ALB.RAND”appears on the screen, the system selects afile randomly from all of the existing foldersor albums. To cancel this function, select“RAND” again.

RANDOM ORDER

Files or folders can be automatically andrandomly selected.

Page 262: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

262

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

9. iPod OPERATION

1 Pull up the lever to release the lock, andlift the armrest.

2 Open the cover and connect iPod usingan iPod cable.

Turn on the power of the iPod if it is notturned on.

3 Close the console box.

Connecting an iPod enables users toenjoy music from the vehicle speakers.

CAUTION

●Do not operate the player’s controls orconnect the iPod while driving.

NOTICE

●Depending on the size and shape of theiPod that is connected to the system, thearmrest may not close fully. In this case,do not forcibly close the armrest as thismay damage the iPod or the terminal, etc.

●Do not leave your portable player in thecar. In particular, high temperaturesinside the vehicle may damage the porta-ble player.

●Do not push down on or apply unneces-sary pressure to the portable player whileit is connected as this may damage theportable player or its terminal.

●Do not insert foreign objects into the portas this may damage the portable playeror its terminal.

INFORMATION

●When an iPod is connected using a genu-ine iPod cable, the iPod starts charging itsbattery.

CONNECTING iPod

Page 263: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

263

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MEDIA” button if an iPod hasalready been connected.

2 Select the “iPod” tab or press the“MEDIA” button repeatedly until the“iPod” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

: Select to start playing the music.: Select to pause the music.: Select to start playing the music again.

Select “Video” to display the iPod videocontrol screen.

1 Select “Browse”.

PLAYING iPod MUSIC

PLAYING AND PAUSING iPod

INFORMATION

●Depending on the iPod, the video soundmay not be able to be heard.

●Depending on the iPod and the songs inthe iPod, iPod cover art may be displayed.This function can be changed to “On” or“Off”. See “iPod SETTINGS” on page313. It may take time to display iPodcover art, and the iPod may not be oper-ated while the cover art display is in pro-cess. Only the iPod cover art that is savedin JPEG format can be displayed.

●When an iPod is connected and the audiosource is changed to iPod mode, the iPodwill resume playing from the same point itwas last used.

●Depending on the iPod that is connectedto the system, certain functions may notbe available.

SELECTING A PLAY MODE

Page 264: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

264

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Select the desired play mode.

■ ON THE iPod TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previoustrack.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” repeatedlyuntil the desired track number appears onthe screen. The player will start playing theselected track from the beginning.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to skip tothe desired track.

■ ON THE TRACK LIST SCREEN

1 Select the track name screen button todisplay the following track list screen.

2 Select the desired track number. Theplayer will start playing the selectedtrack from the beginning.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 track groups. If either of these screen but-tons is selected when the top/bottom pageof the list is displayed, the last/first page isdisplayed.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” to scrollthrough the track list one by one. “TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the track list.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK

Page 265: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

265

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ FAST FORWARDING OR RE-WINDING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the player.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

1 Select “RPT” while the track is playing.

“RPT” appears on the screen. When thetrack is finished, the player will automati-cally play it again. To cancel this function,select “RPT” again.

■ PLAYING TRACKS IN RANDOMORDER

1 Select “RAND” while the track is play-ing.

Each time “RAND” is selected, the modechanges as follows:• Track Shuffle Album Shuffle OffOnce “RAND” appears on the screen, the

system selects a track randomly from all ofthe existing albums on the iPod. To cancelthis function, select “RAND” twice.

■ PLAYING ALBUMS IN RANDOMORDER

1 Select “RAND” repeatedly until“ALB.RAND” appears on the screen.

Once “ALB.RAND” appears on the screen,the system selects an album randomly fromall of the existing albums on the iPod. Tocancel this function, select “RAND” again.

REPEATING

The track currently being listened to canbe repeated.

RANDOM ORDER

Tracks or albums can be automaticallyand randomly selected.

Page 266: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

266

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MEDIA” button.

2 Select the “iPod” tab or press the“MEDIA” button repeatedly until the“iPod” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

3 Select “Video” on the iPod top screen.

4 This screen is displayed.

Select “Music” to display the iPod topscreen.

1 Select the album name screen button.

2 Select the desired video group.

PLAYING iPod VIDEO

When the iPod connected to the systemincludes iPod video, the system can onlyoutput the sound by selecting “Video”on the “iPod” screen.

DESCRIPTION OF iPod VIDEO CONTROLS

Screen button Function

Select to pause the videoscreen.

Select to rewind duringplayback.

Select to resume normalplay during pause.

Select to fast forward dur-ing playback.

SELECTING A VIDEO GROUP

Page 267: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

267

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ON THE iPod VIDEO CONTROLSSCREEN

“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” repeatedlyuntil the desired file number appears on thescreen. The player will start playing the se-lected file from the beginning.

■ON THE FILE LIST SCREEN

1 Select the file name screen button todisplay the following file list screen.

2 Select the desired file number. The play-er will start playing the selected file fromthe beginning.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 file groups. If either of these screen but-tons is selected when the top/bottom pageof the list is displayed, the last/first page isdisplayed.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” to scrollthrough the file list one by one.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

SELECTING A DESIRED VIDEO

Page 268: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

268

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■FAST FORWARDING OR REWIND-ING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the player.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

Page 269: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

269

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

10. Bluetooth® AUDIO OPERATION

Bluetooth is a trademark owned byBluetooth SIG, Inc.

The Bluetooth® audio system enablesusers to enjoy listening to music that isplayed on a portable player on the vehi-cle speakers via wireless communica-tion.

This audio system supports Bluetooth®,a wireless data system capable of play-ing portable audio music without cables.If your portable player does not supportBluetooth®, the Bluetooth® audio sys-tem will not function.

CAUTION

●Do not operate the player’s controls orconnect to the Bluetooth® audio systemwhile driving.

●An antenna for the Bluetooth® connec-tion is built in the instrument panel. Peo-ple with implanted pacemakers orcardiac defibrillators should maintain areasonable distance between them-selves and the Bluetooth® antennas. Theradio waves may affect the operation ofsuch devices.

●Before using portable players, users ofany electrical medical device other thanimplanted pacemakers and implantedcardiac defibrillators should consult themanufacturer of the device for informa-tion about its operation under the influ-ence of radio waves. Radio waves couldhave unexpected effects on the operationof such medical devices.

NOTICE

●Do not leave your portable player in thevehicle. In particular, high temperaturesinside the vehicle may damage the porta-ble player.

Page 270: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

270

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The quality of the Bluetooth® connectionis indicated as follows:

: An excellent connection toBluetooth®.

: Indicates a bad connection toBluetooth®, resulting in possible deteriora-tion of audio quality.

: No connection to Bluetooth®.

Indicates the amount of battery chargeleft.

INFORMATION

●In the following conditions, the systemmay not function:• The portable player is turned off.• The portable player is not connected.• The portable player has a low battery.

●It may take time to connect the phonewhen Bluetooth® audio is being played.

●Portable players must correspond to thefollowing specifications in order to beconnected to the Bluetooth® audio sys-tem. However, some functions may belimited depending on the type of portableplayer. Also, the different screen is dis-played depending on which portableplayer is connecting.

• Bluetooth® SpecificationVer. 1.1 or higher(Recommended: Ver. 2.1 + EDR orhigher)

• ProfileA2DP (Advanced Audio DistributionProfile) Ver. 1.0 or higher(Recommended: Ver. 1.2 or higher)AVRCP (Audio/Video Remote ControlProfile) Ver. 1.0 or higher(Recommended: Ver. 1.4 or higher)

●Refer to http://www.lexus.com/ to findapproved Bluetooth® devices for thissystem.

Empty Full

Page 271: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

271

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

U.S.A.INFORMATION

●Remaining charge is not displayed whilethe Bluetooth® device is connecting.

●The amount of charge left does notalways correspond correctly with yourportable player.

●This system does not have a chargingfunction.

●An antenna for Bluetooth® connection isbuilt into the instrument panel. The condi-tion of the Bluetooth® connection maynot be good and the system may notfunction when using a Bluetooth® porta-ble player in the following conditions:• The portable player is obstructed by

certain objects (behind a seat or in theglove box or console box).

• The portable player selects or is cov-ered with metal materials.

●Leave the Bluetooth® portable player ina place where the condition ofBluetooth® connection is good.

Portable player information is registeredwhen the portable player is connected tothe Bluetooth® audio system. When sell-ing or disposing of the vehicle, removethe Bluetooth® audio information fromthe system. (See “DELETING ABluetooth® DEVICE” on page 199.)

FCC ID : AJDK041This device complies with part 15 of the

FCC Rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.

CAUTION

●FCC WARNING: Changes ormodifications not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliancecould void the user’s authority to operatethe equipment.

●This equipment complies with FCCradiation exposure limits set forth for anuncontrolled environment and meets theFCC radio frequency (RF) ExposureGuidelines in Supplement C to OET65.This equipment has very low levels of RFenergy that it deemed to comply withoutmaximum permissive exposureevaluation (MPE). But it is desirable thatit should be installed and operatedkeeping the radiator at least 20cm ormore away from person’s body(excluding extremities: hands, wrists, feetand ankles).

●Co-location: This transmitter must not beco-located or operated in conjunctionwith any other antenna or transmitter.

Page 272: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

272

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Canada

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

IC : 775E-K041This device complies with Industry

Canada licence-exempt RSSstandard(s). Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) this devicemay not cause interference, and (2) thisdevice must accept any interference,including interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.Le présent appareil est conforme auxCNR d’Industrie Canada applicablesaux appareils radio exempts de licence.L’exploitation est autorisée aux deuxconditions suivantes : (1) l’appareil ne doitpas produire de brouillage, et (2)l’utilisateur de l’appareil doit acceptertout brouillage radioélectrique subi,même si le brouillage est susceptible d’encompromettre le fonctionnement.

CAUTION

●NOTEOperation is subject to the following twoconditions; (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation of the device.L’utilisation de ce dispositif est autoriséeseulement aux deux conditions suivantes:(1) il ne doit pas produire de brouillage, et(2) l’utilisateur du dispositif doit être prêtà accepter tout brouillageradioélectrique reçu, même si cebrouillage est susceptible decompromettre le fonctionnement dudispositif.

CAUTION

●This equipment complies with ICradiation exposure limits set forth for anuncontrolled environment and meetsRSS-102 of the IC radio frequency (RF)Exposure rules. This equipment has verylow levels of RF energy that it deemed tocomply without maximum permissiveexposure evaluation (MPE). But it isdesirable that it should be installed andoperated keeping the radiator at least20cm or more away from person’s body(excluding extremities: hands, wrists, feetand ankles).Cet équipement est conforme aux limitesd’exposition aux rayonnements énoncéespour un environnement non contrôlé etrespecte les règles d’exposition auxfréquences radioélectriques (RF) CNR-102 de l’IC. Cet équipement émet uneénergie RF très faible qui est considéréeconforme sans évaluation de l’expositionmaximale autorisée. Cependant, cetéquipement doit être installé et utilisé engardant une distance de 20 cm ou plusentre le dispositif rayonnant et le corps (àl’exception des extrémités : mains,poignets, pieds et chevilles).

●The Bluetooth* antenna cannot beremoved (or replaced) by user.L’antenne Bluetooth* ne peut pas êtresupprimé (ou remplacé) par l’utilisateur.

Page 273: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

273

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The portable player will be automaticallyconnected under the following conditions: • The “POWER” <“ENGINE START

STOP”> switch is in either ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

• When “Bluetooth* Power” is switchedfrom off to on.

• When the portable player is discon-nected for some reason.

1 Select “Connect”.

2 Select the desired portable player.

3 When the connection is completed, thisscreen is displayed. It is now possible touse the portable player.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

CONNECTING A Bluetooth® AUDIO PLAYER

To use the Bluetooth® audio system, it isnecessary to register a portable playerwith the system. Once the portable play-er has been registered, it is possible tolisten to the music.Once the portable player has been reg-istered, it is possible to listen to musicthrough the navigation system. (See“REGISTERING A Bluetooth® DE-VICE” on page 198.)

INFORMATION

●For operating the portable player, see theinstruction manual that comes with it.

WHEN “Bluetooth* Power” IS ON

WHEN “Bluetooth* Power” IS OFF

Manually connect the portable player inaccordance with the following proce-dure.

Page 274: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

274

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

If the Bluetooth® device is disconnectedon purpose, such as it was turned off, thisdoes not happen. Reconnect the portableplayer manually.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

1 Press the “MEDIA” button if aBluetooth® audio player has alreadybeen connected.

2 Select the “BT Audio” tab or press the“MEDIA” button repeatedly until the“BT Audio” tab is selected.

For the Remote Touch operation method,see “SWITCHING BETWEEN FUNC-TIONS” on page 216.

: Select to start playing the music.: Select to pause the music.: Select to start playing the music again.

Depending on the portable player that isconnected to the system, the music maystart playing when selecting while it ispaused. Conversely, the music may pausewhen selecting while it is playing.

INFORMATION

●Selecting “Connect Portable Player” onthe “Bluetooth*” screen also connects aBluetooth® audio player. (See page203.)

●When none of the selectable portableplayers have been registered, a screenconfirming registration is displayed. Reg-istration method is the same as phoneregistration. (See page 156.)

●When the currently connected portableplayer is selected, a screen confirmingthe selected player’s disconnection is dis-played. (See page 205.)

●If connection fails once, a changing con-nection method confirmation screen isdisplayed. If connection fails 2 or moretimes, a message will be displayed. Whenthis message is displayed, try again.

RECONNECTING THE PORTABLE PLAYER

If the portable player is disconnecteddue to poor reception from theBluetooth® network when the“POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”>switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode, the system au-tomatically reconnects the portableplayer.

PLAYING Bluetooth® AUDIO

PLAYING AND PAUSING Bluetooth® AUDIO

Page 275: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

275

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ ON THE AUDIO TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previousfolder/album.

■ ON THE PLAYLIST SCREEN

1 Select the album name screen button todisplay the following playlist screen.

2 Select the desired screen button. If the folder name screen button is selected,

the track list screen is displayed.

3 Select the desired track name screenbutton.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 track/folder groups. If either of thesescreen buttons is selected when the top/bottom page of the list is displayed, the last/first page is displayed.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” to scrollthrough the track list one by one.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the track/folder list.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK/FOLDER/ALBUM

Page 276: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

276

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ FAST FORWARDING OR RE-WINDING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the song.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

■ ON THE AUDIO TOP SCREEN

, : Select to skip to the next or previoustrack.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” repeatedlyuntil the desired track number appears onthe screen. The player will start playing theselected track from the beginning.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to skip tothe desired track.

■ ON THE TRACK LIST SCREEN

1 Select the track name screen button todisplay the following track list screen.

INFORMATION

●Depending on the portable player that isconnected to the system, certain func-tions may not be available.

●Some titles may not be displayeddepending on the type of portable player.

SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK

Page 277: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

277

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Select the desired track number. Theplayer will start playing the selectedtrack from the beginning.

, : Select to move the list up or down by5 track groups. If either of these screen but-tons is selected when the top/bottom pageof the list is displayed, the last/first page isdisplayed.“PRST·TRACK” button: Press the “ ” or“ ” button of “PRST·TRACK” to scrollthrough the track list one by one.“TUNE·SCROLL” knob: Turn the knobclockwise or counterclockwise to quicklyscroll up or down the track list.

, : If appears to the right of an itemname, the complete name is too long for thescreen. Select to scroll to the end of thename. Select to move to the beginning ofthe name.

■ FAST FORWARDING OR RE-WINDING

1 Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“PRST·TRACK” to fast forward or re-wind the track.

When the button is released, the playerresumes playing from that position.

■ REPEATING A TRACK

1 Select “RPT” while the track is playing.

Each time “RPT” is selected, the modechanges as follows:• Track Repeat Album Repeat Off “RPT” appears on the screen. When the

track is finished, the player will automati-cally play it again. To cancel this function,select “RPT” repeatedly until the repeatmode turns off.

INFORMATION

●Depending on the portable player that isconnected to the system, certain func-tions may not be available.

REPEATING

The track or album currently being lis-tened to can be repeated.

Page 278: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

278

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ REPEATING AN ALBUM

1 Select “RPT” repeatedly until“ALB.RPT” appears on the screen.

When the album is finished, the player willautomatically go back to the beginning ofthe album and play it again. To cancel thisfunction, select “RPT” again.

■ PLAYING THE TRACKS ON THEALBUM IN RANDOM ORDER

1 Select “RAND” while the track is play-ing.

Each time “RAND” is selected, the modechanges as follows:• Album Random All Track Random

OffOnce “RAND” appears on the screen, the

system selects a track randomly from thealbum currently being listened to. To cancelthis function, select “RAND” repeatedlyuntil the random mode turns off.

■ PLAYING TRACKS FROM ALLTHE ALBUMS IN RANDOM OR-DER

1 Select “RAND” repeatedly until“ALB.RAND” appears on the screen.

Once “ALB.RAND” appears on the screen,the system selects a track randomly from allof the existing albums on the Bluetooth®

device. To cancel this function, select“RAND” again.

RANDOM ORDER

Tracks or albums can be automaticallyand randomly selected. INFORMATION

●Depending on the portable player that isconnected to the system, certain func-tions may not be available.

Page 279: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

279

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

11. REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM FEATURES*

The rear seat entertainment system is designed for the rear passengers to enjoy audioand DVD video separately from the front audio/video system. The rear seat entertain-ment system can be used when the “POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”> switch isin ACCESSORY or ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

No. Name No. Name

Front audio/video system Power outlet

Displays A/V input port

Rear seat entertainment system con-troller

Headphone volume control dials andheadphone jacks

*: If equipped

Page 280: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

280

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Remove the insulating sheet before us-ing the remote controller.

1 Remove the cover.

2 Remove the depleted batteries and in-stall the new ones.

DISPLAY

A display is installed in the back of eachfront seat. When audio-video equip-ment is connected to the A/V input port,rear passengers can enjoy different au-dio sources on each display. See “US-ING THE VIDEO MODE” on page297.

REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM CONTROLLER

BEFORE USING THE CONTROLLER (FOR NEW VEHICLE OWNERS)

INFORMATION

●An insulating sheet is set to prevent thebatteries from being discharged.

REPLACING THE CONTROLLER BATTERIES

Necessary item for replacing two AAbatteries.

Page 281: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

281

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the knob.

2 Turn the knob clockwise to increase thevolume. Turn the knob counterclock-wise to decrease the volume.

3 Press the knob again.

With some headphones generally avail-able in the market, it may be difficult tocatch signals properly. Lexus recommendsthe use of Lexus genuine wireless head-phones.Contact your Lexus dealer for further

details.

This screen appears for a few secondswhen the “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode.

INFORMATION

●If the batteries are discharged, thefollowing symptoms may occur:• The rear seat entertainment system

controller will not function properly.• The operational range is reduced.

●When using AA batteries• Batteries can be purchased at your

Lexus dealer, electric appliance shop,or camera stores.

• Replace only with the same or equiva-lent type recommended by your Lexusdealer.

• Dispose of used batteries according tothe local laws.

HEADPHONE JACKS

No. Function

To use the headphones, connectthem to the jack.

To adjust the volume.

HEADPHONES

To listen to the rear audio, use head-phones.

VOLUME

Adjust the volume when you connectthe headphones to the jack. Loudsounds may have a significant impact onthe human body.

CAUTION SCREEN

Page 282: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

282

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the button.

When the switch is moved to “R”, opera-tions can be performed on the right screen.When switch is moved to “L”, operationscan be performed on the left screen.

1 Press the button.

While the display is off, some remote con-trol buttons can be operated.

1 Press the “SOURCE” button to displaythe audio source selection screen.

TURNING THE REAR DISPLAY ON/OFF

CHANGING THE DISPLAY TO BE OPERATED

TURNING THE REAR DISPLAY OFF USING THE REMOTE CONTROLLER

CHANGING THE SOURCE

No. Function

Turning on the audio source selec-tion screen

Selecting an icon

Inputting the selected icon

Page 283: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

283

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Select an audio source.

1 To play the rear audio over the speakersin the vehicle, turn “Speaker Output”on.

CHANGING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT

CAUTION

●While driving• Do not use headphones. Doing so

may cause an accident, resulting indeath or serious injury.

●To prevent accidents and electric shock• Do not disassemble or modify the

remote control.●When the remote control is not used

• Stow the remote control. Injuries mayresult in the event of sudden braking,sudden swerving or an accident.

●Conversational speech on some DVDs isrecorded at a low volume to emphasizethe impact of sound effects. If you adjustthe volume assuming that the conversa-tions represent the maximum volumelevel that the DVD will play, you may bestartled by louder sound effects or star-tled when you change to a different audiosource. The louder sounds may have asignificant impact on the human body orpose a driving hazard. Keep this in mindwhen you adjust the volume.

●Removed battery and other parts:• Keep away from children. These parts

are small and if swallowed by a childthey can cause choking. Failure to doso could result in death or seriousinjury.

Page 284: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

284

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MEDIA” button.

2 Select the “Rear” tab.

3 Select the desired button. The selectedbutton indicator is highlighted.

NOTICE

●Cleaning the display• Wipe the display with a dry soft cloth.• If the screen is wiped with a rough

cloth, the surface of the screen may bescratched.

●To prevent damage to the remote control• Keep the remote control away from

direct sunlight, temperature heat andhigh humidity.

• Do not drop or knock the remote con-trol against hard objects.

• Do not sit on or place heavy objectson the remote control.

●For normal operation after replacing thebattery, observe the following precau-tions to prevent accidents:• Always work with dry hands. Moisture

may cause the battery to rust.• Do not touch or move any other com-

ponents inside the remote control.• Do not bend either of the battery ter-

minals.

OPERATION FROM THE FRONT SEATS

The rear seat display can be operatedfrom the front seats.

No. Function

Turns the rear screen on or off.

Locks the system so passengers inthe rear seats cannot operate therear entertainment system.

Enables the front speakers to outputthe front audio/video system’s audiosource.

Page 285: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

285

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select radio mode on the source screento display the control screen.

1 Press the “ ” or “ ” button of “FOL/CH” until the desired station/channelband appears on the screen.

Using the “TUNE” button

1 Press the “ ” or “ ” button of “TUNE”until the desired station/channel ap-pears on the screen.

Press and hold the “ ” or “ ” button of“TUNE” and the stations/channels will besearched automatically one after another.

Using the / button

1 Press the or button until thedesired station/channel appears on thescreen.

Press and hold the or buttonuntil a beep is heard. The radio will beginseeking up or down for a station/channel ofthe nearest frequency.Continue to press and hold the or

button after a beep is heard and sta-tions/channels will be sought for automati-cally. When the or button isreleased the radio will seek up or down fora station/channel of the nearest frequency.

USING THE RADIO

When a different audio source is select-ed at the front seats, radio mode cannotbe selected at the rear seats.

SELECTING A PRESET STATION/CHANNEL

TUNING THE STATION/CHANNEL

Page 286: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

286

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select Apps mode on the source screento display the control screen.

1 Connect iPod. (See “CONNECTINGiPod” on page 262.)

2 Select iPod mode on the source screento display the control screen.

USING THE RADIO (INTERNET RADIO BROADCAST)

One of Apps’s features is the ability tolisten to internet radio. In order to usethis service, an Apps compatible phoneand the navigation system needs to beset. For details, refer to “APPS”. (Seepage 380.)

PLAYING iPod

When a different audio source is select-ed at the front seats, iPod mode cannotbe selected at the rear seats.When the iPod connected to the systemincludes iPod video, the system can onlyoutput the sound.

Page 287: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

287

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the button.

1 Press the or button repeatedlyuntil the desired track number appearson the screen.

1 Press the or button, or pressand hold the or button.

1 Connect a USB memory. (See “CON-NECTING A USB MEMORY” onpage 256.)

2 Select USB mode on the source screento display the control screen.

PLAYING AND PAUSING iPod

SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK

FAST FORWARDING OR REWINDING

PLAYING A USB MEMORY

When a different audio source is select-ed at the front seats, USB mode cannotbe selected at the rear seats.

Page 288: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

288

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the button.

1 Press the “ ” or “ ” button of “FOL/CH” until the desired folder/albumnumber appears on the screen.

1 Press the or button repeatedlyuntil the desired file/track number ap-pears on the screen.

1 Press the or button, or pressand hold the or button.

1 Select BT-A mode on the source screento display the control screen.

PLAYING AND PAUSING A USB MEMORY

SELECTING A DESIRED FOLDER OR ALBUM

SELECTING A DESIRED FILE OR TRACK

FAST FORWARDING OR REWINDING

INFORMATION

●Depending on the USB memory that isconnected to the system, certainfunctions may not be available.

PLAYING Bluetooth® AUDIO

When a different audio source is select-ed at the front seats, BT-A mode cannotbe selected at the rear seats.

Page 289: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

289

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the button.

1 Press the “ ” or “ ” button of “FOL/CH” until the desired album number ap-pears on the screen.

1 Press the or button repeatedlyuntil the desired track number appearson the screen.

1 Press the or button, or pressand hold the or button.

1 Select disc mode on the source screento display the control screen.

2 Press the or button until thedesired track number appears on thescreen.

1 Press the or button, or pressand hold the or button.

1 Press the button.

PLAYING AND PAUSING Bluetooth® AUDIO

SELECTING A DESIRED ALBUM

SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK

FAST FORWARDING OR REWINDING

INFORMATION

●Depending on the portable player that isconnected to the system, certainfunctions may not be available.

PLAYING AN AUDIO CD/CD TEXT

SELECTING A TRACK

FAST FORWARDING OR REWINDING A TRACK

PLAYING OR PAUSING A TRACK

Page 290: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

290

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select disc mode on the source screento display the control screen.

2 Press the or button until thedesired file number appears on thescreen.

1 Press the “ ” or “ ” button of “FOL/CH” until the desired folder number ap-pears on the screen.

1 Press the or button, or pressand hold the or button.

1 Press the button.

1 Press the “DISC” button, or select discmode, to display DVD video.

PLAYING MP3/WMA DISCS

SELECTING A FILE

SELECTING A FOLDER

FAST FORWARDING OR REWINDING A FILE

PLAYING OR PAUSING A FILE

PLAYING DVD VIDEO

SELECTING DVD VIDEO MODE

CONTROLLER

No. Function

Selecting an icon

Turning on the DVD mode

Inputting the selected icon

Playing/pausing a disc

Fast forwarding a disc during play-back and forward slowly duringpause.

Stopping a screen

Page 291: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

291

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “OPTION” button if no iconsare shown while watching a DVD videoand this screen appears.

“Settings”: Select to display setting screen.“Hide Buttons”: Select to turn off the iconsfrom the screen.

■DESCRIPTION OF DVD VIDEOCONTROLS

■DESCRIPTION OF DVD VIDEOSETTINGS

1 Select “Settings” on the control iconscreen and this screen appears.

Turning on the menu

Turning on the control icon screen

Turning on the title selection screen

Press to select a chapter.Press and hold to fast forward or re-wind a chapter.

Rewinding a disc during playback

DVD VIDEO

INFORMATION

●If appears on the screen when acontrol is selected, the operation relevantto the control is not permitted.

No. Function

Screen button Function

“Top Menu”, “Menu”

Select to display the menuscreen for DVD video. (Forthe operation, see the manualthat comes with the DVD vid-eo disc provided separately.)

Select to rewind during play-back.

Select to stop the videoscreen.

Select to pause/resume thevideo screen.

Select to fast forward duringplayback and play in slow mo-tion when the player ispaused.

No. Function Page

Select to display the ini-tial setup screen. 293

Select to display the an-gle selection screen. 293

Select to display the sub-title selection screen. 292

Page 292: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

292

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

When is selected, the previousscreen is displayed.

■SEARCHING BY TITLE

1 Select “Search” on the settings screen.

2 Enter the title number and select “OK”.

The player starts playing video for that titlenumber.When the or button is pressed, a

chapter can be selected. If the wrong numbers are entered, select

to delete the numbers.When is selected, the previous

screen is displayed.

■CHANGING THE SUBTITLE LAN-GUAGE

1 Select “Subtitle” on the settings screen.

2 Each time “Subtitle” is selected, the lan-guage the subtitles are displayed in ischanged.

When “Hide” is selected, the subtitles canbe hidden.

When is selected, the previousscreen is displayed.

■CHANGING THE AUDIO LAN-GUAGE

1 Select “Audio” on the settings screen.

2 Each time “Audio” is selected, the audiolanguage is changed.

When is selected, the previousscreen is displayed.

Select to display the au-dio selection screen. 292

Select to display the pre-determined scene on thescreen and start playing.

Select to display the titlesearch screen. 292

No. Function Page

Page 293: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

293

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■CHANGING THE ANGLE

1 Select “Angle” on the settings screen.

2 Each time “Angle” is selected, the angleis changed.

When is selected, and the previousscreen is displayed.

■SETUP MENU

1 Select “Setup” on the settings screen.

2 Select the items to be set.

3 After the initial setting has beenchanged, select “OK”.

This screen will close, and the system willreturn to the previous screen.When “Default” is selected, all menus are

initialized.

The angle can be selected for discs thatare multi-angle compatible when the an-gle mark appears on the screen.

The initial setting can be changed. Thereare initial setting buttons on the “SetupMenu 1” and “Setup Menu 2” screens.

Page 294: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

294

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■AUDIO LANGUAGE

1 Select “Audio Language” on the “SetupMenu 1” screen.

2 Select the desired language to be heardon the “Audio Language” screen.

If the desired language to be heard cannotbe found on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For entry of a lan-guage code, see “ENTER AUDIO/SUBTI-TLE/DVD LANGUAGE CODE” on page295.To return to the “Setup Menu 1” screen,

select .

3 Select “OK” on the “Setup Menu 1”screen.

■SUBTITLE LANGUAGE

1 Select “Subtitle Language” on the “Set-up Menu 1” screen.

2 Select the desired language to be readon the “Subtitle Language” screen.

If the desired language to be read cannotbe found on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For entry of a lan-guage code, see “ENTER AUDIO/SUBTI-TLE/DVD LANGUAGE CODE” on page295.To return to the “Setup Menu 1” screen,

select .

3 Select “OK” on the “Setup Menu 1”screen.

■DVD LANGUAGE

1 Select “DVD Language” on the “SetupMenu 1” screen.

2 Select the desired language to be readon the “DVD Language” screen.

If the desired language to be read cannotbe found on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For entry of a lan-guage code, see “ENTER AUDIO/SUBTI-TLE/DVD LANGUAGE CODE” on page295.To return to the “Setup Menu 1” screen,

select .

3 Select “OK” on the “Setup Menu 1”screen.

■ANGLE MARK

1 Select “Angle Mark” on the “SetupMenu 1” screen.

2 Select “ON” or “OFF”.

3 Select “OK” on the “Setup Menu 1”screen.

The audio language can be changed.

The subtitle language can be changed.

The language on the DVD video menucan be changed.

The multi-angle mark can be turned onor off on the screen while discs that aremulti-angle compatible are beingplayed.

Page 295: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

295

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■PARENTAL LOCK

1 Select “Parental Lock” on the “SetupMenu 1” screen.

2 Enter the 4-digit personal code on the“Enter Key Code” screen.

If the wrong numbers are entered, select to delete the numbers.

To return to the “Setup Menu 1” screen,select .

3 Select a parental level (1-8) on the “Se-lect Restriction Level” screen.

To return to the “Setup Menu 1” screen,select .

4 Select “OK” on the “Setup Menu 1”screen.

■SOUND DYNAMIC RANGE

1 Select “Sound Dynamic Range” on the“Setup Menu 2” screen.

2 Select “MAX”, “STD” or “MIN”.

3 Select “OK” on the “Setup Menu 2”screen.

■ENTER AUDIO/SUBTITLE/DVDLANGUAGE CODE

1 Enter the 4-digit language code.

If the wrong numbers are entered, select to delete the numbers.

To return to the “Setup Menu 1” screen,select .

2 Select “OK”.

3 Select “OK” on the “Setup Menu 1”screen.

The level of viewer restrictions can bechanged.

The difference between the lowest vol-ume and the highest volume can be ad-justed.

If “Other” on the “Audio Language”screen, “Subtitle Language” screen or“DVD Language” screen is selected, thedesired language to be heard or readcan be selected by entering a languagecode. (See page 249.)

Page 296: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

296

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■SETUP OPERATION FROM THEFRONT SEAT

Rear passengers can cancel this setupoperation by selecting “Play”. The playerwill resume normal play.Likewise, a front passenger can cancel a

rear passenger’s selection of the setupmenu.

If “Check DISC” appears on the screen: Itindicates that the disc is dirty, damaged, or itwas inserted upside down. Clean the disc orinsert it correctly. If a disc which is not play-able is inserted, “Check DISC” will also ap-pear on the screen. For appropriate discsfor the player, see “AUDIO/VIDEO SYS-TEM OPERATING HINTS” on page 302.If “Region code error” appears on thescreen: It indicates that the DVD regioncode is not set properly. Insert a disc with aregion code of “ALL” or “1”.If “DISC error” appears on the screen: Thefollowing causes are possible:

• There is a problem inside the system.Eject the disc.

• The inside of the player unit may be toohot due to a very high ambient tempera-ture. Eject the disc and allow the player tocool down.

If “No music files found.” appears on thescreen: It indicates that the iPod or USB hasno playable data.If the malfunction is not rectified: Takeyour vehicle to your Lexus dealer.

This screen appears when a front pas-senger selects the setup menu.

IF THE REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM MALFUNCTIONS

If the rear seat entertainment systemmalfunctions, the system will display amessage.These are described below.

Page 297: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

297

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Open the cover and connect audio/vid-eo device.

The A/V input port is composed of 3 inputports.

1 Press the “VIDEO” button, or select“Rr-A/V” on the source screen tochange to video mode.

In VTR mode, different sound/visual modescan be enjoyed for the left and rightscreens when “Speaker Output” is off.

1 Press the “SETTING” button.

USING THE VIDEO MODE

USING THE PORT

Color Function

Yellow Video input port

White Left channel audio input port

Red Right channel audio input port

The rear seat entertainment system playsvideos and sound when audio-videoequipment is connected to the A/V inputport. For details, refer to the manufac-turer’s instructions.

NOTICE

●When the A/V input port is not in use,keep the A/V input port cover closed.Inserting anything other than an appro-priate plug may cause electrical failure ora short circuit.

SELECTING THE VIDEO MODE

CHANGING SETTINGS

CHANGING TO PAL FORMAT

Page 298: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

298

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Turn “PAL VIDEO” on when PAL for-mat equipment is connected to the A/Vinput port.

The “PAL VIDEO” indicator is highlighted.

1 Press the “SETTING” button.

2 Select “LCD AI”.

The “LCD AI” indicator is highlighted.

1 Press the “SETTING” button on thecontroller.

2 Select the “Screen Size” tab.

3 Select “Normal”, “Wide 1” or “Wide 2”.

1 Press the “SETTING” button.

SETTING LCD AI

Automatically determines the tone ofthe video image and sets the contrast toan optimum level, displaying a sharp im-age.

INFORMATION

●Because the image quality isautomatically adjusted when the “LCDAI” indicator is on, brightness andcontrast adjustment becomes lesseffective.

SETTING THE DISPLAY MODE

ADJUSTING THE SCREEN

Page 299: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

299

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 Select the desired button to adjust color,tone, contrast and brightness. After ad-justing the screen, select “OK”.

The screen goes off when “Screen Off” isselected. To turn the screen back on, pressany remote control button. The selectedscreen appears.

Screen button Function

“Contrast” “+” Select to strengthen thecontrast of the screen.

“Contrast” “-” Select to weaken thecontrast of the screen.

“Brightness” “+” Select to brighten thescreen.

“Brightness” “-” Select to darken thescreen.

“Color” “R” Select to strengthen thered color of the screen.

“Color” “G”Select to strengthen thegreen color of thescreen.

“Tone” “+” Select to strengthen thetone of the screen.

“Tone” “-” Select to weaken thetone of the screen.

Page 300: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

300

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

12. AUDIO/VIDEO REMOTE CONTROLS (STEERING SWITCHES)

Volume control switch Press the “+” side to increase the volume.

The volume continues to increase while theswitch is being pressed.Press the “-” side to decrease the volume.

The volume continues to decrease whilethe switch is being pressed.

“ ” switch

RadioTo select a preset station/channel: Quicklypress and release the “ ” or “ ” switch. Re-peat this to select the next preset station/channel.To seek a station/channel: Press and holdthe “ ” or “ ” switch until a beep is heard.Repeat this to find the next station/channel. Ifeither switch is pressed during seek mode,seeking will be canceled.

DVD playerUse the “ ” or “ ” switch to skip up or

down to a different track, file or chapter ineither direction.

To select a desired track, file or chapter:Quickly press and release the “ ” or “ ”switch until the desired track, file or chapterto play is selected. To return to the begin-ning of the current track, file or chapter,press the “ ” switch once quickly.To select a desired folder: Press and holdthe “ ” or “ ” switch until a beep is heard tochange to the next or the previous folder.Repeat it until the desired folder is selected.

Some parts of the audio/video systemcan be adjusted using the switches onthe steering wheel.

No. Switch

Volume control switch

“ ” switch

“MODE” switch

Page 301: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

301

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Bluetooth® audio playerUse the “ ” or “ ” switch to skip up or

down to a different track or album in eitherdirection.

To select a desired track: Quickly press andrelease the “ ” or “ ” switch until the de-sired track is selected. To return to the be-ginning of the current track, press the “ ”switch once quickly.To select a desired album: Press and holdthe “ ” or “ ” switch until a beep is heard tochange to the next or the previous album.Repeat it until the desired album is selected.

USB memory/iPodUse the “ ” or “ ” switch to skip up or

down to a different file or track in eitherdirection.

To select a desired file or track: Press the“ ” or “ ” switch until the desired file ortrack is selected. To return to the beginningof the current file or track, press the “ ”switch once quickly.To select a desired folder or album (USBmemory only): Press and hold the “ ” or“ ” switch until a beep is heard to change tothe next or the previous folder or album. Re-peat it until the desired folder or album is se-lected.

“MODE” switch Press the “MODE” switch to select an

audio mode. Each press changes the modesequentially if the desired mode is ready touse.To turn the audio/video system on, press

the “MODE” switch.Press and hold the “MODE” switch to

mute/unmute or pause/resume the currentoperation.

Page 302: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

302

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

13. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATING HINTS

Fading and drifting stations: Generally, theeffective range of FM is about 25 miles (40km). Once outside this range, you may no-tice fading and drifting, which increase withthe distance from the radio transmitter.They are often accompanied by distortion.Multi-path: FM signals are reflective, mak-ing it possible for 2 signals to reach the vehi-cle’s antenna at the same time. If thishappens, the signals will cancel each otherout, causing a momentary flutter or loss ofreception.Static and fluttering: These occur when sig-nals are blocked by buildings, trees or otherlarge objects. Increasing the bass level mayreduce static and fluttering.Station swapping: If the FM signal being lis-tened to is interrupted or weakened, andthere is another strong station nearby onthe FM band, the radio may tune in the sec-ond station until the original signal can bepicked up again.

NOTICE

●To avoid damage to the audio/video sys-tem:• Be careful not to spill beverages over

the audio/video system.• Do not put anything other than an

appropriate disc into the disc slot.

INFORMATION

●The use of a cellular phone inside or nearthe vehicle may cause a noise from thespeakers of the audio/video system whichyou are listening to. However, this doesnot indicate a malfunction.

RADIO RECEPTION

Usually, a problem with radio receptiondoes not mean there is a problem withthe radio — it is just the normal result ofconditions outside the vehicle.For example, nearby buildings and ter-rain can interfere with FM reception.Power lines or phone wires can interferewith AM signals. And of course, radiosignals have a limited range. The fartherthe vehicle is from a station, the weakerits signal will be. In addition, receptionconditions change constantly as the ve-hicle moves.Here, some common reception prob-lems that probably do not indicate aproblem with the radio are described.

FM

Page 303: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

303

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Fading: AM broadcasts are reflected by theupper atmosphere — especially at night.These reflected signals can interfere withthose received directly from the radio sta-tion, causing the radio station to sound al-ternately strong and weak.Station interference: When a reflected sig-nal and a signal received directly from a ra-dio station are very nearly the samefrequency, they can interfere with each oth-er, making it difficult to hear the broadcast.Static: AM is easily affected by externalsources of electrical noise, such as high ten-sion power lines, lightening or electricalmotors. This results in static.

Cargo loaded on the roof luggage carrier,especially metal objects, may adverselyaffect the reception of XM Satellite Radio.Alternation or modifications carried out

without appropriate authorization mayinvalidate the user’s right to operate theequipment.

“Made for iPod” and “Made for iPhone”mean that an electronic accessory hasbeen designed to connect specifically toiPod, or iPhone, respectively, and has beencertified by the developer to meet Appleperformance standards.Apple is not responsible for the operation

of this device or its compliance with safetyand regulatory standards. Please note thatthe use of this accessory with iPod oriPhone may affect wireless performance. iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano and

iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc.,registered in the U.S. and other countries.

AM

XM

iPod

Page 304: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

304

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The following iPod®, iPod nano®, iPodclassic®, iPod touch® and iPhone® devic-es can be used with this system.Made for

• iPod touch (4th generation)• iPod touch (3rd generation)• iPod touch (2nd generation)• iPod touch (1st generation)• iPod classic• iPod with video• iPod nano (6th generation)• iPod nano (5th generation)• iPod nano (4th generation)• iPod nano (3rd generation)• iPod nano (2nd generation)• iPod nano (1st generation)• iPhone 4• iPhone 3GS• iPhone 3G• iPhone

Depending on differences between modelsor software versions etc., some modelsmight be incompatible with this system.

USB memory that can be used for MP3and WMA playback:• USB communication formats: USB 2.0

HS (480 Mbps) and FS (12 Mbps)• File formats: FAT 16/32• Correspondence class: Mass storage

class

This DVD player is intended for use with4.7 in. (12 cm) discs only.Extremely high temperatures can keep the

DVD player from working. On hot days,use the air conditioning system to cool theinside of the vehicle before using the player.Bumpy roads or other vibrations may make

the DVD player skip. If moisture gets into the DVD player, the

discs may not be able to be played. Removethe discs from the player and wait until itdries.

COMPATIBLE MODELS USB MEMORY

CARING FOR YOUR DVD PLAYER AND DISC

CAUTION

●DVD players use an invisible laser beamwhich could cause hazardous radiationexposure if directed outside the unit. Besure to operate the player correctly.

Page 305: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

305

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Use only discs marked as shown above.The following products may not be playableon your player:• SACD• dts CD• Copy-protected CD• DVD audio• Video CD• DVD+R• DVD+RW• DVD-RAM

Special shaped discs

Transparent/translucent discs

Low quality discs

Labeled discs

DVD PLAYER

Audio CDs

DVD video discs

Page 306: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

306

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Handle discs carefully, especially wheninserting them. Hold them on the edge anddo not bend them. Avoid getting finger-prints on them, particularly on the shinyside.Dirt, scratches, warping, pin holes or other

disc damage could cause the player to skipor to repeat a section of a track. (To see apin hole, hold the disc up to the light.)Remove discs from the players when not in

use. Store them in their plastic cases awayfrom moisture, heat and direct sunlight.

To clean a disc: Wipe it with a soft, lint-freecloth that has been dampened with water.Wipe in a straight line from the center to theedge of the disc (not in circles). Dry it withanother soft, lint-free cloth. Do not use aconventional record cleaner or anti-staticdevice.

MP3 (MPEG Audio Layer 3) and WMA(Windows Media Audio) are audio com-pression standards.The MP3/WMA player can play MP3 and

WMA files on CD-ROM, CD-R and CD-RW discs.The unit can play disc recordings compati-

ble with ISO 9660 level 1 and level 2 andwith the Romeo and Joliet file system.When naming an MP3 or WMA file, add

the appropriate file extension (.mp3 or.wma). The MP3/WMA player plays back files

with .mp3 or .wma file extensions as MP3or WMA files. To prevent noise and play-back errors, use the appropriate file exten-sions.The MP3/WMA player can play only the

first session when using multi-session com-patible CDs.

NOTICE

●Do not use special shaped, transparent/translucent, low quality or labeled discssuch as those shown in the illustrations.The use of such discs may damage theplayer, or it may be impossible to eject thedisc.

●This system is not designed for use ofDual Discs. Do not use Dual Discsbecause they may cause damage to theplayer.

●Do not use discs with a protection ring.The use of such discs may damage theplayer, or it may be impossible to eject thedisc.

Correct Wrong

MP3/WMA FILES

Page 307: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

307

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

MP3 player: MP3 files are compatible withthe ID3 Tag Ver. 1.0, Ver. 1.1, Ver. 2.2 andVer. 2.3 formats. The unit cannot displaydisc title, track title and artist name in otherformats.USB memory: MP3 files are compatible

with the ID3 Tag Ver. 1.0, Ver. 1.1, Ver. 2.2,Ver. 2.3 and Ver. 2.4 formats. The unit can-not display track title and artist name inother formats.WMA files can contain a WMA tag that is

used in the same way as an ID3 tag. WMAtags carry information such as track titleand artist name.The emphasis function is available only

when playing MP3/WMA files recorded at32, 44.1 and 48 kHz.

MP3 files for MP3 player:MPEG 1 LAYER 3 — 32, 44.1, 48 kHzMPEG 2 LSF LAYER 3 — 16, 22.05, 24kHzMP3 files for USB memory:MPEG 1 AUDIO LAYER 2, 3 — 32, 44.1,48 kHzMPEG 2 AUDIO LAYER 2, 3 — 16, 22.05,24 kHzWMA files for WMA player:Ver. 7, 8, 9 (9.1/9.2) CBR — 32, 44.1, 48kHzWMA files for USB memory:Ver. 7, 8, 9 (9.1/9.2) CBR — 32, 44.1, 48kHzThe sound quality of MP3/WMA files gen-

erally improves with higher bit rates. Inorder to achieve a reasonable level ofsound quality, discs recorded with a bit rateof at least 128 kbps are recommended.

MP3 files for MP3 player:MPEG1 LAYER3 — 32 to 320 kbpsMPEG2 LSF LAYER3 — 8 to 160 kbpsMP3 files for USB memory:MPEG 1 AUDIO LAYER 3 — 32 to 320kbpsMPEG 2 AUDIO LAYER 3 — 8 to 160kbpsWMA files for WMA player:Ver. 7, 8 CBR — 48 to 192 kbpsVer. 9 (9.1/9.2) CBR — 48 to 320 kbps(VBR*)WMA files for USB memory:Ver. 9 (9.1/9.2) CBR — 48 to 320 kbps(VBR*)*: Variable Bit RateThe MP3/WMA player does not play back

MP3/WMA files from discs recordedusing packet write data transfer (UDF for-mat). Discs should be recorded using “pre-mastering” software rather than packet-write software.M3u playlists are not compatible with the

audio player.MP3i (MP3 interactive) and MP3PRO

formats are not compatible with the audioplayer.The player is compatible with VBR (Vari-

able Bit Rate).When playing back files recorded as VBR

(Variable Bit Rate) files, the play time willnot be correctly displayed if the fast for-ward or reverse operations are used. It is not possible to check folders that do not

include MP3/WMA files.MP3/WMA files in folders up to 8 levels

deep can be played. However, the start ofplayback may be delayed when using discscontaining numerous levels of folders. Forthis reason, we recommend creating discswith no more than 2 levels of folders.

SAMPLING FREQUENCY

PLAYABLE BIT RATES

Page 308: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

308

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The play order of the compact disc with thestructure shown above is as follows:

MP3/WMA player: It is possible to play upto 192 folders or 255 files on one disc.USB memory: It is possible to play up to

3000 folders, 255 files per folder or9999 files in the device.The order changes depending on the per-

sonal computer and MP3/WMA encodingsoftware you use.

CD-R/CD-RW discs that have not beensubject to the “finalizing process” (a pro-cess that allows discs to be played on aconventional CD player) cannot be played. It may not be possible to play CD-R/CD-

RW discs recorded on a music CDrecorder or a personal computer becauseof disc characteristics, scratches or dirt onthe disc, or dirt, condensation, etc. on thelens of the unit. It may not be possible to play discs

recorded on a personal computer depend-ing on the application settings and the envi-ronment. Record with the correct format.(For details, contact the appropriate appli-cation manufacturers of the applications.)

CD-R/CD-RW discs may be damaged bydirect exposure to sunlight, high tempera-tures or other storage conditions. The unitmay be unable to play some damageddiscs. If you insert a CD-RW disc into the MP3/

WMA player, playback will begin moreslowly than with a conventional CD or CD-R disc.Recordings on CD-R/CD-RW cannot be

played using the DDCD (Double DensityCD) system.

This is a general term that describes theprocess of writing data on-demand to CD-R, etc., in the same way that data is writtento floppy or hard discs.

This is a method of embedding track-related information in an MP3 file. Thisembedded information can include thetrack title, the artist’s name, the album title,the music genre, the year of production,comments and other data. The contentscan be freely edited using software withID3 tag editing functions. Although thetags are restricted to a number of charac-ters, the information can be viewed whenthe track is played back.

WMA files can contain a WMA tag that isused in the same way as an ID3 tag. WMAtags carry information such as track titleand artist name.

CD-R AND CD-RW DISCS

001.mp3 002.wma

Folder 1003.mp3Folder 2

004.mp3005.wma

Folder 3006.mp3

001.mp3 002.wma . . . 006.mp3 TERMS

PACKET WRITE

ID3 TAG

WMA TAG

Page 309: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

309

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

This is the international standard for the for-matting of CD-ROM folders and files. Forthe ISO 9660 format, there are 2 levels ofregulations.Level 1: The file name is in 8.3 format (8

character file names, with a 3 character fileextension. File names must be composed ofone-byte capital letters and numbers. The“_” symbol may also be included.)Level 2: The file name can have up to 31

characters (including the separation mark“.” and file extension). Each folder mustcontain fewer than 8 hierarchies.

Playlists created using “WINAMP” soft-ware have a playlist file extension (.m3u).

MP3 is an audio compression standarddetermined by a working group (MPEG) ofthe ISO (International Standard Organiza-tion). MP3 compresses audio data to about1/10 the size of that on conventional discs.

WMA (Windows Media Audio) is an audiocompression format developed byMicrosoft®. It compresses files into a sizesmaller than that of MP3 files. The decod-ing formats for WMA files are Ver. 7, 8 and9.

ISO 9660 FORMAT

m3u

MP3

WMA

Music recognition technology andrelated data are provided byGracenote®. Gracenote is the industrystandard in music recognitiontechnology and related content delivery.For more information visitwww.gracenote.com.

CD and music-related data fromGracenote, Inc., copyright © 2000 topresent Gracenote. GracenoteSoftware, copyright © 2000 to presentGracenote. One or more patents ownedby Gracenote apply to this product andservice. See the Gracenote website for anon-exhaustive list of applicableGracenote patents. Gracenote, CDDB,MusicID, MediaVOCS, the Gracenotelogo and logotype, and the “Powered byGracenote” logo are either registeredtrademarks or trademarks of Gracenotein the United States and/or othercountries.

Page 310: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

310

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Gracenote® End User LicenseAgreement

This application or device containssoftware from Gracenote, Inc. ofEmeryville, California (“Gracenote”).The software from Gracenote (the“Gracenote Software”) enables thisapplication to perform disc and/or fileidentification and obtain music-relatedinformation, including name, artist,track, and title information (“GracenoteData”) from online servers orembedded databases (collectively,“Gracenote Servers”) and to performother functions. You may useGracenote Data only by means of theintended End-User functions of thisapplication or device.You agree that you will use GracenoteData, the Gracenote Software, andGracenote Servers for your ownpersonal non-commercial use only.You agree not to assign, copy, transferor transmit the Gracenote Software orany Gracenote Data to any third party.YOU AGREE NOT TO USE OREXPLOIT GRACENOTE DATA, THEGRACENOTE SOFTWARE, ORGRACENOTE SERVERS, EXCEPTAS EXPRESSLY PERMITTEDHEREIN.

You agree that your non-exclusivelicense to use the Gracenote Data, theGracenote Software, and GracenoteServers will terminate if you violatethese restrictions. If your licenseterminates, you agree to cease any andall use of the Gracenote Data, theGracenote Software, and GracenoteServers. Gracenote reserves all rightsin Gracenote Data, the GracenoteSoftware, and the Gracenote Servers,including all ownership rights. Under nocircumstances will Gracenote becomeliable for any payment to you for anyinformation that you provide. Youagree that Gracenote, Inc. may enforceits rights under this Agreement againstyou directly in its own name.The Gracenote service uses a uniqueidentifier to track queries for statisticalpurposes. The purpose of a randomlyassigned numeric identifier is to allowthe Gracenote service to count querieswithout knowing anything about whoyou are. For more information, see theweb page for the Gracenote PrivacyPolicy for the Gracenote service.

Page 311: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

311

1. AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM OPERATION

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The Gracenote Software and each itemof Gracenote Data are licensed to you“AS IS.” Gracenote makes norepresentations or warranties, expressor implied, regarding the accuracy ofany Gracenote Data from in theGracenote Servers. Gracenotereserves the right to delete data fromthe Gracenote Servers or to changedata categories for any cause thatGracenote deems sufficient. Nowarranty is made that the GracenoteSoftware or Gracenote Servers areerror-free or that functioning ofGracenote Software or GracenoteServers will be uninterrupted.Gracenote is not obligated to provideyou with new enhanced or additionaldata types or categories thatGracenote may provide in the futureand is free to discontinue its services atany time.

GRACENOTE DISCLAIMS ALLWARRANTIES EXPRESS ORIMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOTLIMITED TO, IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FORA PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE,AND NON-INFRINGEMENT.GRACENOTE DOES NOTWARRANT THE RESULTS THATWILL BE OBTAINED BY YOUR USEOF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWAREOR ANY GRACENOTE SERVER. INNO CASE WILL GRACENOTE BELIABLE FOR ANYCONSEQUENTIAL ORINCIDENTAL DAMAGES OR FORANY LOST PROFITS OR LOSTREVENUES.copyright © 2000 to presentGracenote

Page 312: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

312

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. SETUP

1. AUDIO SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Audio”.

4 Select “HD Radio Settings”.

5 Select “HD Radio/Analog Setting”.

6 Select the item to be set.

7 Select “Save”.

HD Radio™ SYSTEM SETTINGS

HD Radio™ system can be set using theprocedure outlined below.

Screen button Function

“All” Select to receive both ana-log and digital broadcasts.

“HD Only” Select to receive only digi-tal broadcasts.

“Analog” Select to receive only ana-log broadcasts.

Page 313: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

313

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5

AU

DIO

/VID

EO SY

STEM

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Audio”.

4 Select “iPod Settings”.

5 Select “Display Cover Art”.

6 Select “On” or “Off”.

7 After iPod setting has been changed,select “OK”.

iPod SETTINGS

When the track currently being playedhas cover art data, it can be displayed.

Page 314: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

314

2. SETUP

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Page 315: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

6

315

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. QUICK REFERENCE ............................ 316

2. SOME BASICS ......................................... 318CLIMATE CONTROL .......................................... 318

VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM........................ 318

3. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION.......................................... 319

SWITCHING TO AUTOMATIC OPERATION MODE ........................................ 319

SETTING THE VEHICLE INTERIOR TEMPERATURE.................................................... 319

ADJUSTING THE SETTINGS MANUALLY......................................................... 320

SWITCHING BETWEEN OUTSIDE AIR AND RECIRCULATED AIR MODES.................. 322

DEFOGGING THE WINDSHIELD ............. 323

ADJUSTING THE POSITION OF AND OPENING AND CLOSING THE AIR OUTLETS ........................................... 324

WINDSHIELD WIPER DE-ICER.................... 325

DEFOGGING THE REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR ................................................... 325

OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE DISPLAY ........ 326

AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATING HINTS......................................... 327

1 AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

AIR CONDITIONING

Page 316: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

316

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

1. QUICK REFERENCE

*1: Driver side temperature display*2: Outside temperature display*3: Passenger side temperature display*4: If equipped

Press the “MENU” button on the Remote Touch, then select “Climate” to display theair conditioning control screen.

*1 *2

*4*3

Page 317: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

317

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

6

AIR

CO

ND

ITION

ING

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No. Name Function Page

Driver’s side tempera-ture control buttons

Select/press to control the temperature from thedriver’s side. When the “DUAL” indicator is on,only the driver’s side temperature is adjusted.

319

Fan speed control but-tons Select/press to change fan speed. 320

Air flow control buttons Select/press to change the air outlets. 321

Passenger’s side tem-perature control but-tons

Select/press to control the passenger’s side tem-perature. 319

Windshield wiper de-icer button

Select to prevent ice from building up on the wind-shield and wiper blades. 325

“DUAL” Select to set the temperatures independently forthe driver’s and front passenger’s seats. 320

“A/C” Select to change the air conditioning system be-tween on and off. 327

Air intake control but-ton

Press to change the function between outside airand recirculated air mode. 322

Rear window and out-side rear view mirrordefogger button

Press to defog the rear window and outside rearview mirrors. 325

Windshield air flowbutton Press to defog the windshield. 323

“ OFF” button Press to turn the fan off. 319, 320

“AUTO” button Press to use the automatic air conditioning sys-tem. 319

Page 318: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

318

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. SOME BASICS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Climate” to display the air con-ditioning control screen.

CLIMATE CONTROL

Air outlets and fan speed are automati-cally adjusted according to the temper-ature setting.The “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch must be in ON <IGNI-TION ON> mode.

A function that enables automatic returnto the previous screen from the air condi-tioning control screen can be selected.See page 53 for details.

NOTICE

●To prevent the 12-volt battery from beingdischarged, do not leave the air condi-tioning system on longer than necessarywhen the hybrid system is off <the engineis not running.>

INFORMATION

●During use, various odors from inside andoutside the vehicle may enter into andaccumulate in the air conditioning sys-tem. This may then cause odor to beemitted from the vents.

●To reduce potential odors from occur-ring:• It is recommended that the air condi-

tioning system be set to outside airmode prior to turning the vehicle off.

• The start timing of the blower may bedelayed for a short period of timeimmediately after the air conditioningsystem is started in automatic operationmode.

VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM

The voice command system can be op-erated by pressing the talk switch.

For the operation of the voice commandsystem and the list of commands, seepages 330 and 339.

Page 319: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

319

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6

AIR

CO

ND

ITION

ING

3. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

1 Press the “AUTO” button.

1 Press the “ ” button on “TEMP” to in-crease the temperature and the “ ”button to decrease the temperature.

Using the screen

1 Select “ ” to increase the temperatureand “ ” to decrease the temperature.

SWITCHING TO AUTOMATIC OPERATION MODE

Air outlets and fan speed are automati-cally adjusted according to the temper-ature setting.

Press the “ OFF” button to turn the fanoff.

SETTING THE VEHICLE INTERIOR TEMPERATURE

Page 320: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

320

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “DUAL”.

When the passenger’s side temperaturecontrol buttons are selected/pressed, the“DUAL” indicator turns on, and the modewill change to independent mode.When the “DUAL” indicator is dimmed, the

same temperature is set for both thedriver’s side and front passenger’s side.

1 Press the button on fan speed con-trol button to increase the fan speed and

press the button to decrease the fanspeed.

Using the screen

1 Select “ ” on to increase the fanspeed and “ ” to decrease the fanspeed. (7 levels)

ADJUSTING THE TEMPERATURE SEPARATELY

“DUAL” is used to set the temperaturesindependently for the driver’s side andfront passenger side.

ADJUSTING THE SETTINGS MANUALLY

SETTING THE FAN SPEED

Press the “ OFF” button to turn the fanoff.

Page 321: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

321

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

6

AIR

CO

ND

ITION

ING

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the air flow control button.

Using the screen

1 Select any mode on the screen.

Air flows to the upper body (Panel)

Air flows to the upper body and feet (Bi-level)

SWITCHING THE AIR OUTLETS AND AIR FLOW

The outlets from which air is deliveredcan be selected manually.

No. Function

Floor/windshield

Bi-level

Panel

Floor

Page 322: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

322

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Air flows to the feet (Floor)

Air flows to the feet and the windshielddefogger operates (Floor/windshield)

Type A

1 Press the air intake control button.

The air conditioning system automaticallyswitches between outside air and recircu-lated air modes.

SWITCHING BETWEEN OUTSIDE AIR AND RECIRCULATED AIR MODES

The mode switches between outside airmode (introduces air from outside thevehicle), “AUTO” mode and recirculat-ed air mode (recycles air inside the vehi-cle) each time the button is pressed.

No. Function

Recirculated air mode

“AUTO” mode

Outside air mode

INFORMATION

●The setting in automatic mode can beadjusted. (See page 142 and “Owner’sManual”.)

Page 323: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

323

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

6

AIR

CO

ND

ITION

ING

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Type B

1 Press the air intake control button.

1 Press the windshield air flow button.

The air conditioning system control oper-ates automatically.Recirculated air mode will automatically

switch to outside air mode.

The mode switches between outside airmode (introduces air from outside thevehicle) and recirculated air mode (re-cycles air inside the vehicle) each timethe button is pressed.

No. Function

Recirculated air mode

Outside air mode

DEFOGGING THE WINDSHIELD

CAUTION

●To prevent the windshield from foggingup • Do not use the windshield air flow but-

ton during cool air operation inextremely humid weather. The differ-ence between the temperature of theoutside air and that of the windshieldcan cause the outer surface of the wind-shield to fog up, blocking your vision.

Page 324: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

324

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Front center outlets

Front side outlets

Rear center outletsADJUSTING THE POSITION OF AND OPENING AND CLOSING THE AIR OUTLETS

No. Function

Direct air flow to the left or right, upor down

Turn the knob to open or close thevent

No. Function

Direct air flow to the left or right, upor down

Turn the knob to open or close thevent

No. Function

Direct air flow to the left or right, upor down

Turn the knob to open or close thevent

Page 325: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

325

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

6

AIR

CO

ND

ITION

ING

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select the windshield wiper de-icer but-ton.

The windshield wiper de-icer will automati-cally turn off after approximately 15 min-utes.

1 Press the rear window and outside rearview mirror defogger button.

The thin heater wires on the inside of therear window and the heater panels in theoutside rear view mirrors will quickly clearthe surface.The indicator is on when the defogger is

operating.

WINDSHIELD WIPER DE-ICER

This feature is used to prevent ice frombuilding up on the windshield and wiperblades. The windshield wiper de-icercan be operated when the “POWER”<“ENGINE START STOP”> switch is inON <IGNITION ON> mode.

CAUTION

●When the windshield wiper de-icer is on,do not touch the lower part of the wind-shield or the side of the front pillars, as thesurfaces can become very hot and burnyou.

DEFOGGING THE REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDE REAR VIEW MIRROR

This feature is used to defog the rearwindow and outside rear view mirror.The “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch must be in ON<IGNITION ON> mode.

Page 326: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

326

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The displayed temperature ranges from-40F (-40C) up to 122F (50C).

CAUTION

●When the outside rear view mirrordefoggers are on, do not touch the out-side surface of the rear view mirror as itcan become very hot and burn you.

NOTICE

●When cleaning the inside of the rear win-dow, be careful not to scratch or damagethe heater wires or connectors.

●To prevent the 12-volt battery from beingdischarged, turn the switch off when thehybrid system is off <the engine is not run-ning>.

INFORMATION

●The defoggers will automatically turn offafter 15 to 60 minutes. The operationtime changes according to the ambienttemperature and vehicle speed.

●If further defrosting or defogging isdesired, simply actuate the switch again.When the surface has cleared, press thebutton once again to turn the defoggeroff. Continuous use may cause the 12-voltbattery to discharge, especially duringstop-and-go driving. The defogger is notdesigned to dry rain water or to meltsnow.

●If the outside rear view mirrors areheavily coated with ice, use a spray de-icer before operating the system.

OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE DISPLAY

Outside temperature is displayed on thescreen.

INFORMATION

●In the following situations, the correctoutside temperature may not be dis-played, or the display may take longerthan normal to change.• When stopped, or driving at low speeds

(less than 15.5 mph [25 km/h])• When the outside temperature has

changed suddenly (at the entrance/exitof a garage, tunnel, etc.)

●If the temperature shows “--” or “E”, takeyour vehicle to your Lexus dealer.

Page 327: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

327

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

6

AIR

CO

ND

ITION

ING

RX450h/350_Navi_U

AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATING HINTS

INFORMATION

●Operation of the air conditioning systemin Eco drive mode (vehicles with hybridsystem)In Eco drive mode, the air conditioningsystem is controlled as follows to priori-tize fuel efficiency:• Engine speed and compressor opera-

tion controlled to restrict heating/cool-ing capacity

• Fan speed restricted when automaticmode is selected

To improve air conditioning performance,perform the following operations:• Adjust the fan speed• Turn off Eco drive mode

●Customization (vehicles with hybrid sys-tem)The air conditioning control restriction ofEco drive mode can be changed to thesame setting as that used in normal drivemode. For details, refer to “Owner’s Man-ual”.Changing the air conditioning restrictionwill slightly reduce the Eco drive mode’sfuel efficiency when compared to beforethe change was made.

INFORMATION

●Registering air conditioning settings toelectronic keys• Unlocking the vehicle using an elec-

tronic key and turning the “POWER”<“ENGINE START STOP”> switch toON <IGNITION ON> mode will recallthat key’s registered air conditioningsettings.

• When the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is turned off, thecurrent air conditioning settings willautomatically be registered to the elec-tronic key that was used to unlock thevehicle.The system may not operate correctly ifmore than 1 electronic key is in the vicin-ity or if the smart access system withpush-button start is used to unlock apassenger door.Settings for the electronic key and thecorresponding door can be changed.Contact your Lexus dealer.

●Using the automatic mode• Fan speed is adjusted automatically in

accordance with the temperature set-ting and ambient conditions. As a result,the following may occur:

• Immediately after the “AUTO” button ispressed, the fan may stop for a whileuntil warm or cool air is ready to flow.

• Cool air may flow to the area aroundthe upper body when the heater is on.

●Using the system in recirculated air mode• The windows will fog up more easily if

the recirculated air mode is used for anextended period.

●Switching between outside air and recir-culated air modes• Recirculated air mode or outside air

mode may be automatically switched toin accordance with the temperaturesetting and the inside temperature.

Page 328: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

328

1. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

INFORMATION

●When the outside temperature exceeds75F (24C) and the air conditioningsystem is on• In order to reduce the air conditioning

power consumption, the air condition-ing system may switch to recirculatedair mode automatically. This may alsoreduce fuel consumption.

• Recirculated air mode is selected as adefault mode when the “POWER”<“ENGINE START STOP”> switch isturned to ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

• It is possible to switch to outside airmode at any time by pressing the airintake control button.

●Window defogger feature• Recirculated air mode may automati-

cally switch to outside air mode in situa-tions where the windows need to bedefogged.

●When outside temperature approaches32F (0C)• The air conditioning system may not

operate even when “A/C” is selected.●Automatic air intake change mode

In automatic mode, the system automati-cally switches between recirculated airand outside air modes according towhether the system detects harmful sub-stances such as exhaust gas in the air out-side.If automatic mode is selected when onlythe fans are operating, the air condition-ing system will turn on automatically.

●Air conditioning filter• The air conditioning filter may clog after

long use. The filter may need to bereplaced if the air flow of the air condi-tioner and heater experiences extremereductions in operating efficiency, or ifthe windows become to fog up easily.(For details, refer to “Owner’s Manual”.)

●Customization• Settings can be changed. (For details,

refer to “Owner’s Manual”.)

Page 329: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

7

329

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM ......... 330

STEERING SWITCHES FOR THE VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM .................. 330

VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION ....................................................... 330

2. NATURAL SPEECH INFORMATION (ENGLISH ONLY) ............................... 336

3. EXPANDED VOICE COMMANDS....................................... 338

4. COMMAND LIST................................... 339

1 VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM

Page 330: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

330

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM

Talk switchPress the talk switch to start the voice com-

mand system.To cancel voice recognition, press and hold

the talk switch.

1 Press the talk switch.After the “Shortcut Menu” screen has been

displayed, voice guidance will commence.

2 After a beep sounds, say the commandof your choice.

Voice commands are marked with .Some commonly used commands are dis-played on the screen.By saying “Next page” or “Previous page”,

or by selecting “Next Pg.”/“Prev. Pg.”, thescreen will display the commands dis-played on the page in the background.Saying “Main menu” or selecting “Main

Menu” when the “Shortcut Menu” screenis displayed will display the “Main Menu”screen.Registered POIs, registered names in the

phonebook etc., can be said in the place ofthe “<>” next to the commands. (See page339.)For example: Say “Find nearby dining”,“Call John” etc.

The voice command system enables thenavigation, audio/video, hands-free andair conditioning systems to be operatedusing voice commands.The operating procedures of voicecommands from the “Shortcut Menu”screen are explained here.

INFORMATION

●Commands that are not displayed in the“Shortcut Menu” screen can be operatedfrom the “Main Menu” screen.

STEERING SWITCHES FOR THE VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM

VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

Voice guidance for the voice commandsystem can be skipped by pressing thetalk switch.

Page 331: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

331

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

7

VO

ICE C

OM

MA

ND

SYSTEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3 Say the command displayed on thescreen.

If a desired outcome is not shown, or if noselections are available, perform one of thefollowing to return to the previous screen:• Say “Go back”.• Select “Go Back”.To cancel voice recognition, select

“Cancel”, or press and hold the talk switch.

Saying “Help” prompts voice guidance tooffer examples of commands and opera-tion methods.

INFORMATION

●If the navigation system does not respondor the confirmation screen does not dis-appear, press the talk switch and tryagain.

●If a voice command cannot be recog-nized within 6 seconds, voice guidancewill say “Pardon?” (“Command not rec-ognized.” will be displayed on the screen)and voice command reception willrestart.

●If a voice command cannot be recog-nized 2 consecutive times, the voicecommand guidance system will say“Paused. To restart voice recognition,push the talk switch. To cancel voice rec-ognition, push and hold the talk switch.”Voice recognition will then be sus-pended. Select “Cancel” or “Go Back”.

●The voice recognition prompt can be setto on or off when “Voice Prompts” isselected. This setting can also bechanged on the “Voice Settings” screen.(See page 66.)

●When “Voice Prompts” is selected, voicerecognition will be temporarily sus-pended. Press the talk switch again.

●Voice guidance can be canceled by set-ting voice prompts to off. Use this settingwhen it is desirable to say a commandimmediately after pressing the talk switchand hearing a beep.

Page 332: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

332

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the talk switch.

2 Say “Go home”.A confirmation screen will be displayed

showing the recognition results.

3 Say “Yes” or select “Yes”.The system starts searching for a route to

your home.

When the voice command is recognized,the map of the area around the homeaddress will be displayed and route guid-ance to the home address will begin.

MICROPHONE

It is unnecessary to speak directly intothe microphone when giving a com-mand.

INFORMATION

●Wait for the confirmation beep beforespeaking a command.

●Voice commands may not be recognizedif:• Spoken too quickly.• Spoken at a low or high volume.• The roof or windows are open.• Passengers are talking while voice com-

mands are spoken.• The air conditioning speed is set high.• The air conditioning vents are turned

towards the microphone.●In the following conditions, the system

may not recognize the command prop-erly and using voice commands may notbe possible:• The command is incorrect or unclear.

Note that certain words, accents orspeech patterns may be difficult for thesystem to recognize.

• There is excessive background noise,such as wind noise.

VOICE COMMAND EXAMPLE: SEARCHING FOR A ROUTE TO YOUR HOME

If a home address is not registered, voiceguidance will say “Your home is not set.Please try again after setting a homelocation.” and you will be prompted toenter a home address. (See page 112.)

Page 333: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

333

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

7

VO

ICE C

OM

MA

ND

SYSTEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the talk switch.

2 Say “Enter an address”. If the destination’s state/province has not

been set or is not contained in the voicecommand recognition list, the screen toinput a state/province will be displayed.

Some areas cannot be recognized by thevoice recognition system.

3 Say “<city name>”.Say the desired city name that belongs to

the set state in the place of the “<>”.Say “Change State” to change the set voice

recognition state.

4 Say “<street name>”.Say the desired full street name, or main

body of the street name that belongs to theset state in the place of the “<>”.The voice command recognition is

designed to recognize the main body of theofficial street name.

For example, if the official street name is“East Main Street”, the voice command rec-ognition will recognize “Main”.

5 Say “<house number>”.Say the desired number, cardinal/intercar-

dinal direction etc. in the place of the “<>”.For example: Say “West 555”. Inputting the house number can be

skipped.

6 Say “Start guidance” or “Show map”. Al-ternatively, select “Start Guidance” or“Show Map”.

After this, follow the voice guidance andsearch for a destination route by voicecommand operation.

VOICE COMMAND EXAMPLE: PERFORMING A DESTINATION SEARCH BY ADDRESS

For information regarding the state/province setting to perform a destinationsearch by address, see “SELECTINGTHE SEARCH AREA” on page 70.

Page 334: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

334

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the talk switch. “Play Artist <name>” and “Play Album

<name>” are displayed in the “ShortcutMenu” screen.

2 Say “Play artist <name>” or “Play album<name>”.

Say the desired artist name or album namein the place of the “<>”.A confirmation screen will be displayed

showing the recognition results. If multiplematching items are found, a selectionscreen will be displayed.

3 Say “Yes” or select “Yes”.

The system starts playing music.

INFORMATION

●Even if the state set using voice recogni-tion is different from the set state in the“Address” screen (which was set when adestination was set manually), the setstate in the “Address” screen will notchange. (For more information on the“Address” screen, see “SELECTING THESEARCH AREA” on page 70.)

●The house number voice recognitionconditions are outlined below:• Numerals: 10 digits or less• Numerals and cardinal/intercardinal

direction or a hyphen and numerals: Atotal of 9 digits or less (Do not say“and”.)

• Cardinal/Intercardinal direction or ahyphen and numerals: A total of 9 dig-its or less (Do not say “and”.)

• Numerals are recognized as singledigits only.

• The cardinal/intercardinal directionand hyphens are only recognizedonce.

• The following cardinal/intercardinaldirections can be recognized: North,East, West, South, North East, NorthWest, South East and South West.

●When inputting the house number isskipped and the recognized candidate listhas multiple entries and so forth, the fullstreet name may need to be recognized.If this occurs, say the full street name. For example, say “East Main Street” and“East Main Street” will be recognized.

VOICE COMMAND EXAMPLE: SEARCH FOR A TRACK USING ARTIST NAME OR ALBUM NAME

When “Play Artist <name>” is used toplay music, the first track is selected ran-domly. For operations beyond playingmusic, refer to the “AUDIO/VIDEOSYSTEM” section of this manual.

Page 335: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

335

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

7

VO

ICE C

OM

MA

ND

SYSTEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Music recognition technology andrelated data are provided byGracenote®. Gracenote is the industrystandard in music recognitiontechnology and related content delivery.For more information visitwww.gracenote.com.

INFORMATION

●A USB memory or iPod must be con-nected to enable track searching andplayback. (See “USB MEMORY OPER-ATION” on page 256 and “iPod OPER-ATION” on page 262.)

●When a USB memory or iPod is con-nected, recognition data is created sotracks can be searched using voice com-mands.

●Recognition data is updated under thefollowing conditions:• When the USB memory or iPod data

has changed.• When the voice recognition language is

changed. (See page 56.)●While the recognition data is being cre-

ated or being updated, a track searchcannot be performed using a voice com-mand.

●While “Play Music” is displayed in the“Shortcut menu” screen, say “Play music”to display the music screen from whichsearching for a track using a voice com-mand can be performed.

●When “Play Music” is dimmed in the“Shortcut Menu” screen, it is not possibleto search for a track using a voice com-mand. In this situation, reduce the amountof music data in the USB memory or iPodand update the recognition data toenable searching by voice command.

Page 336: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

336

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. NATURAL SPEECH INFORMATION (ENGLISH ONLY)

*: Say the desired artist name or albumname in the place of the “<>”.

Due to natural language speech recog-nition technology, this system enablesrecognition of a command when spokennaturally. However, the system cannotrecognize every variation of each com-mand. In some situations, it is possible toomit the command for the procedureand directly state the desired operation.Not all voice commands are displayed inthe short cut menu.

INFORMATION

●The “Set a Destination”, “Use the Phone”,“Play Music” and “Get Information” com-mands displayed on the “Shortcut Menu”screen can be operated using natural lan-guage speech recognition technology.

●If the command cannot be recognizedcompletely, the command input screenwill be displayed. (Search results will beshown based on the part of the commandthat was recognized.)

EXPRESSION EXAMPLES FOR EACH FUNCTION

Command Expression examples

“Go Home” Let’s go home.Take me home.

“Enter an Address”

I wanna enter an ad-dress, please. Put in an address.

“Find Nearby <POI category>”

Find nearby <Restau-rants> for me. I need to see the nearby<Restaurants>.

“Call <name><type>”

Get me <RobertBrown>.I need to call <RobertBrown> at <Work> rightaway.

“Dial <number>”Please dial the number<3334445555>.Ring <3334445555>.

“Play Artist <name>”

Play the artist<XXXXX>. I’d like to hear the band<XXXXX>.*

“Play Album <name>”

Play album <XXXXX>. Music from album<XXXXX>.*

Page 337: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

337

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

7

VO

ICE C

OM

MA

ND

SYSTEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Command Expression examples

“Traffic” How’s the traffic? Check the traffic.

“Weather”What’s the weatherlike? Let’s get a forecast.

“Sports Scores”Team scores.How are my favoriteteams doing?

“Stock Quotes”Stock quotes.How are my stocks do-ing?

“Fuel Prices”Let’s check fuel prices.Find the cheapest gasprices.

INFORMATION

●Commands that are not displayed in the“Shortcut Menu” screen can be accessedfrom the main menu.

●For example, to make an “InternationalCall”, say “Main menu” while the “Short-cut Menu” screen is being displayed.Then say “Use the phone” followed bysaying the desired number, e.g.“123456789”.

Page 338: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

338

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. EXPANDED VOICE COMMANDS

1 Press the talk switch.

2 Say “Audio on”.

Selecting “On” next to “ExpandedVoice Commands” on the “Voice Set-tings” screen enables voice commandoperation of the audio/video and airconditioning system. (See page 66.) Formore information on operations that canbe controlled using expanded voicecommands, refer to “COMMANDLIST”. (See page 339.)

VOICE COMMAND EXAMPLE: TURN THE AUDIO SYSTEM ON

INFORMATION

●Commands relating to operation of theaudio/video and air conditioning systemscan only be performed when the audioand air conditioning systems are turnedon.

●Expanded voice commands can be rec-ognized when the “Shortcut Menu”screen is displayed.

Page 339: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

339

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

7

VO

ICE C

OM

MA

ND

SYSTEM

4. COMMAND LIST

All commands are listed in the table. For devices that are not installed in the vehicle, the related commands will not be dis-

played in the “Shortcut Menu” screen. Also, according to conditions, other commandsmay not be displayed in the “Shortcut Menu” screen.

The functions available may vary according to the navigation system installed.

“Set a Destination”

*1: For example; Gas stations, Restaurants, etc.*2: To use this function, say “Main menu” and then “Set a destination” while the “Shortcut

Menu” screen is being displayed.

Recognizable voice commands and their actions are shown below.

Voice recognition language can be changed. (See “SELECTING A LANGUAGE”on page 56.)

Command Action Shortcut Menu

“Find Nearby <POI category>” Displays a list of <POI category*1> near the cur-rent position. O

“Enter an Address” Enables setting a destination by saying the ad-dress. O

“Go Home” Displays the route to home. O

“Call Destination Assist” Connects Lexus Enform with Safety Connectresponse center. —

“Destination by Phone Number”*2

Enables setting a destination by saying thephone number. —

Page 340: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

340

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

“Use the Phone” (See “BY VOICE RECOGNITION” on page 165.)

*1: To use this function, say “Main menu” and then “Use the phone” while the “ShortcutMenu” screen is being displayed.

“Play Music”

*1: Say the desired artist name or album name in the place of the “<>”.*2: To use this function, say “Main menu” and then “Play music” while the “Shortcut menu”

screen is being displayed.

Command Action Shortcut Menu

“Call <name> <type>”

Calls made by saying a name from the phone-book.For example: Say “Call John Smith”, “Call JohnSmith, mobile” etc.

O

“Dial <number>”Calls made by saying the phone number.For example: Say “Dial 911”, “Dial5556667777” etc.

O

“International Call”*1 Calls international numbers by saying thephone number. —

Command Action Shortcut Menu

“Play Artist <name>” Plays tracks by the selected artist.For example: Say “Play artist <XXXXX>”*1 O

“Play Album <name>” Plays tracks from the selected album.For example: Say “Play album <XXXXX>”*1 O

“Play Song <name>”*2Plays the selected track.For example: Say “Play song Summertime”,“Play song Concerto in A Major” etc.

“Play Playlist <name>”*2Plays tracks from the selected playlist.For example: Say “Play playlist My FavoriteSongs”, “Play Playlist Classic Hits” etc.

Page 341: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

341

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

7

VO

ICE C

OM

MA

ND

SYSTEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

“Get Information”

Select audio modeWhen Expanded Voice Commands are turned “On”. (See page 338.)

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

Command Action Shortcut Menu

“Traffic” Displays the traffic incident list. O

“Weather” Displays weather information. O

“Sports Scores” Displays the sports list. O

“Stock Quotes” Displays the stocks list. O

“Fuel Prices” Displays the fuel prices list. O

“Lexus Insider” Displays the Lexus insider list. —

Command Action Shortcut Menu

“Radio” Sets the audio mode to radio. O

“AM” Selects the AM band. O

“FM” Selects the FM band. O

“Satellite radio” Selects the satellite radio mode. O

“Disc” Selects the disc audio mode. O

“Auxiliary” Selects the auxiliary audio mode. O

“Bluetooth* audio” Selects the Bluetooth® audio mode. O

“iPod” Selects the iPod audio mode. O

“USB audio” Selects the USB audio mode. O

“Audio on” Turns the audio system on. O

“Audio off” Turns the audio system off. O

Page 342: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

342

1. VOICE COMMAND SYSTEM OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Climate commandWhen Expanded Voice Commands are turned “On”. (See page 338.)

Command Action Shortcut Menu

“Automatic climate control” Turns air conditioning system on and off. O

“Warmer” Turns temperature up. O

“Cooler” Turns temperature down. O

INFORMATION

●Commands that have a “O” in the Shortcut Menu column can be recognized from the“Shortcut Menu” screen.

●Commands that have a “” in the Shortcut Menu column can only be recognized from thescreen that they are displayed in.

Page 343: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

8

343

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. FUEL CONSUMPTION....................... 344

FUEL CONSUMPTION(VEHICLES WITH HYBRID SYSTEM)............................................. 344

FUEL CONSUMPTION(VEHICLES WITH GASOLINE ENGINE) .................................... 344

2. MAP DATABASE VERSION AND COVERAGE AREA............................ 346

MAP INFORMATION ........................................ 346

CERTIFICATION.................................................... 347

1. XM SERVICES ......................................... 348

1. XM Sports ................................................... 351

RECEIVE SPORTS INFORMATION .......... 352

XM Sports SETTINGS — ADD OR DELETE TEAMS ................................................. 352

2. XM Stocks .................................................. 354

RECEIVE STOCK DATA................................... 355

XM Stocks SETTINGS — ADD OR DELETE STOCKS .............................................. 355

3. XM Fuel Prices ......................................... 357

SHOW XM Fuel Prices INFORMATION................................................. 357

VIEW DETAILED FUEL PRICE INFORMATION................................................. 357

XM Fuel Prices SETTINGS ................................ 358

4. XM NavWeather™ .................................. 361

SHOW XM NavWeather™ INFORMATION................................................... 361

WEATHER INFORMATION........................... 363

WEATHER WARNINGS................................... 364

XM NavWeather™ INDICATOR .................. 364

5. XM NavTraffic®....................................... 365

SHOW TRAFFIC EVENT .................................. 365

SHOW XM NavTraffic® INFORMATION................................................. 366

1. XM SETTINGS ......................................... 368

1 INFORMATION DISPLAY

2 XM FUNCTION-OVERVIEW

3 XM FUNCTION OPERATION4 SETUP

INFORMATION

Page 344: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

344

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. INFORMATION DISPLAY

1. FUEL CONSUMPTION

Energy monitorTrip information Past record

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “Fuel Consumption”.

4 This screen will be displayed.

If the “Past Record” screen does notappear, select “Past Record” on the “TripInformation” screen.The average fuel consumption history is

divided by color into past averages and theaverage fuel consumption since the lastupdate. Use the displayed average fuelconsumption as a reference.Update the average fuel consumption by

selecting “Update” to measure the currentfuel consumption again.Past record data can be deleted by select-

ing “Clear”.

FUEL CONSUMPTION(VEHICLES WITH HYBRID SYSTEM)

Fuel consumption information, such asthat shown below, can be displayed onthe screen. For details see Section 1-1 of“Owner’s Manual”.

FUEL CONSUMPTION(VEHICLES WITH GASOLINE ENGINE)

PAST RECORD

Fuel consumption information from re-cent resets can be displayed.

No. Function

Best recorded fuel economy

Average

Previous fuel economy record

Current fuel economy

Page 345: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

345

1. INFORMATION DISPLAY

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Info/Apps”.

2 Select “Fuel Consumption” on the “In-formation” screen.

3 This screen will be displayed.

If the “Trip Information” screen does notappear, select “Trip Information” on the“Past Record” screen.Consumption data can be deleted by

selecting “Clear”.Average fuel consumption for the past 15

minutes is divided by color into past aver-ages and averages attained since the“ENGINE START STOP” switch was lastturned to IGNITION ON mode. Use thedisplayed average fuel consumption as areference.

TRIP INFORMATION

The average fuel consumption of the last15 minutes can be displayed in one-minute blocks.

No. Function

Average speed

Elapsed time

Cruising range

Previous fuel consumption perminute

Current fuel consumption perminute

Page 346: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

346

1. INFORMATION DISPLAY

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. MAP DATABASE VERSION AND COVERAGE AREA

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “Map Data”.

The “Map Information” screen will be dis-played.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Info/Apps”.

2 Select “Map Data” on the “Information”screen.

3 Select “Legal Info.”.

The “Legal Information” screen will be dis-played.

MAP INFORMATION

Coverage areas and legal informationcan be displayed and map data can beupdated.

INFORMATION

●Map data updates are available for a fee.Contact your Lexus dealer for furtherinformation.

●The “Map Information” screen displays

“Map Version” and “Map UpdateID”. This data is needed to perform a mapdata update.

LEGAL INFORMATION

Legal information related to the mapdata can be displayed.

Page 347: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

347

1. INFORMATION DISPLAY

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Info/Apps”.

2 Select “Map Data” on the “Information”screen.

3 Select “Map Coverage”.

The “Map Data Coverage” screen will bedisplayed.

For vehicles sold in Canada

MAP COVERAGE

Map data coverage areas can be dis-played.

CERTIFICATION

This device complies with IndustryCanada licence-exempt RSSstandard(s). Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) this devicemay not cause interference, and (2) thisdevice must accept any interference,including interference that may causeundesired operation of this device.Le présent appareil est conforme aux

CNR d’Industrie Canada applicablesaux appareils radio exempts de licence.L’exploitation est autorisée aux deuxconditions suivantes: (1) l’appareil ne doitpas produire de brouillage, et (2)l’utilisateur de l’appareil doit acceptertout brouillage radioélectrique subi,même si le brouillage est susceptible d’encompromettre le fonctionnement.This device complies with RSS-310 of

Industry Canada. Operation is subject tothe condition that this device does notcause harmful interference.Cet appareil est conforme au CNR-310

d’Industrie Canada. Son exploitation estautorisée sous réserve que l’appareil necause pas de brouillage préjudiciable.

Page 348: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

348

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. XM FUNCTION-OVERVIEW

1. XM SERVICES

With an active XM subscription, the follow-ing features are available:

• XM Sports*1 (See page 351.)• XM Stocks*1 (See page 354.)• XM Fuel Prices*2 (See page 357.)• XM NavWeather™*2 (See page 361.)• XM NavTraffic®*2 (See page 365.)

*1: Available at no extra charge with an ac-tive XM Satellite Radio subscription.

*2: Available via separate XM subscrip-tion(s).

XM NavTraffic®, XM NavWeather™ andXM TravelLink require separate XM sub-scription(s). XM Sports*, XM Stocks* andXM Fuel Prices are available with an XMTravelLink subscription. After a 90-daytrial, you must contact XM and set up theappropriate XM subscription(s) to con-tinue receiving these services.

*: XM Sports and XM Stocks are includedwith an XM Satellite Radio subscription.

The XM NavTraffic® service is available inthe contiguous 48 U.S. states and Canada.The XM NavWeather™, XM Sports, XM

Stocks and XM Fuel Prices services areavailable in the contiguous 48 U.S. states.

To receive XM NavTraffic®, XMNavWeather™, XM Sports, XM Stocksand XM Fuel Prices services, the XM ser-vice must be activated. To activate the ser-vice, call the XM Listener Care Center at 1-877-515-3987 (U.S.A.) or 1-877-438-9677 (Canada).Customers should have their radio ID

ready. The radio ID can be found by select-ing “CH 000” on the radio. For details, see“DISPLAYING THE RADIO ID” on page229.

■ RADIO AND ENTERTAINMENTXM offers more than 170 satellite radiochannels of commercial-free music andpremier sports, news, talk, andentertainment. XM is broadcast viasatellites to millions of listeners across thecontinental United States. XM subscriberslisten to XM on satellite radio receivers forthe car, home, and portable use. Moreinformation about XM is available online atwww.siriusxm.com (U.S.A.) orwww.xmradio.ca (Canada).

■ INFOTAINMENT AND DATA SER-VICES

XM offers a variety of advanced infotain-ment and data services.

XM services are subscription-basedXM Satellite Radio services to provideconvenient features to subscribers.

SUBSCRIPTION(S)

AVAILABILITY OF SERVICE(S)

ACTIVATION OF SERVICE(S)

INFORMATION

●For further details about the service, con-tact your Lexus dealer.

●XM Satellite Radio is responsible for allfees and services, which are subject tochange.

XM RADIO SERVICES —DESCRIPTIONS

Page 349: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

349

2. XM FUNCTION-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

For XM Services requiring a subscription(such as XM Radio, and some Infotainment& data services), the following paragraphshall be included.Required XM Radio and some Infotainment& data services monthly subscriptions soldseparately after trial period. Subscriptionfee is consumer only. All fees and program-ming subject to change. Subscriptions aresubject to the Customer Agreement avail-able at www.siriusxm.com (U.S.A.) orwww.xmradio.ca (Canada). XM serviceonly available in the 48 contiguous UnitedStates and 10 Canadian provinces. ©2011Sirius XM Radio Inc. Sirius, XM and all re-lated marks and logos are trademarks ofSirius XM Radio Inc. All other marks, chan-nel names and logos are the property oftheir respective owners.For more information, program schedules,and to subscribe or extend subscription af-ter complimentary trial period; more infor-mation is available at:

U.S.A. CustomersVisit www.siriusxm.com or call 1-877-515-3987

Canadian CustomersVisit www.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677

Fees and Taxes — Subscription fee, taxes,one time activation fee, and other fees mayapply. Subscription fee is consumer only. Allfees and programming subject to change.Subscriptions subject to Customer Agree-ment available at www.siriusxm.com(U.S.A.) or www.xmradio.ca (Canada). XMservice only available in the 48 contiguousUnited States and Canada*.*: Canada — some deterioration of service

may occur in extreme northern latitudes.This is beyond the control of XM SatelliteRadio.

Explicit Language Notice — Channels withfrequent explicit language are indicatedwith an “XL” preceding the channel name.Channel blocking is available for XM Satel-lite Radio receivers by notifying XM at;

U.S.A. CustomersVisit www.siriusxm.com or calling 1-877-515-3987

Canadian CustomersVisit www.xmradio.ca or calling 1-877-438-9677

XM RADIO SERVICES —SUBSCRIPTION INSTRUCTIONS

XM RADIO SERVICES —LEGAL DISCLAIMERS AND WARNINGS

Page 350: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

350

2. XM FUNCTION-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

It is prohibited to copy, decompile, disas-semble, reverse engineer, hack, manipu-late, or otherwise make available anytechnology or software incorporated in re-ceivers compatible with the XM SatelliteRadio System or that support the XM web-site, the Online Service or any of its content.Furthermore, the AMBE® voice compres-sion software included in this product is pro-tected by intellectual property rightsincluding patent rights, copyrights, andtrade secrets of Digital Voice Systems, Inc.Note: this applies to XM receivers only andnot XM Ready devices.

Page 351: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

351

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

1. XM Sports

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “XM Sports”.

The “XM Sports” screen is displayed.The following operations can be per-

formed:• Sports information can be received. (See

page 352.)• XM Sports settings can be set. (See page

352.)

XM Sports is a service included with anXM Satellite Radio subscription. Thisservice is also available with an XMTravelLink subscription. With this ser-vice, you can receive updates via thenavigation system on your personallyselected sports teams.

Page 352: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

352

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Info/Apps” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “XM Sports” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

4 Select the desired team to receive infor-mation.

Teams for which there is no current dataavailable will be dimmed and you will not beable to select them.

5 Select the individual information item tohear it, or select “Read All” to hear allavailable information for that team.

The selected information will be read out inits entirety.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Info/Apps” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “XM Sports” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

4 Select “Options”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

RECEIVE SPORTS INFORMATION

The desired teams must be added in or-der to receive information. (See page352.)

XM Sports SETTINGS —ADD OR DELETE TEAMS

To input your personalized XM Sportsteam.

Personalized XM Sports teams can alsobe input from the “Setup” screen. (See“XM SETTINGS” on page 368.)

Page 353: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

353

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

1 Select “Add Sports Team”.

Up to 5 teams can be added and saved inthe system for which information will bereceived. The desired teams can bechanged at any time. Teams must be addedone at a time.

2 Select the desired sporting league of theteam.

3 Select the name of the desired team tobe added from the list that appears.

4 Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” to can-cel.

1 Select “Delete Sports Teams”.

2 Select the individual sports team to bedeleted or select “Select All” to deleteall the teams, and select “Delete”.

3 Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” to can-cel.

ADD SPORTS TEAM DELETE SPORTS TEAMS

Page 354: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

354

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. XM Stocks

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “XM Stocks”.

The “XM Stocks” screen is displayed.The following operations can be per-

formed:• Stock data can be received. (See page

355.)• XM Stocks setting can be set. (See page

355.)

XM Stocks is a service included with anXM Satellite Radio subscription. Thisservice is also available with an XMTravelLink subscription. With this ser-vice, you can receive updates via thenavigation system on your personallyselected stocks.

Page 355: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

355

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Info/Apps” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “XM Stocks” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

4 Select an individual stock to hear its re-lated data, or select “Read All” to hearthe data for all the stocks saved in thesystem.

The selected data will be read out in itsentirety.Stock data may be delayed by approxi-

mately 20 minutes.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Info/Apps” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “XM Stocks” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

4 Select “Options”.

5 Perform each setting according to theprocedures outlined on the followingpages.

RECEIVE STOCK DATA

You must first add your desired stocksprior to receiving data. (See page 355.)

XM Stocks SETTINGS —ADD OR DELETE STOCKS

To input your personalized XM Stockssettings.

Personalized XM Stocks settings canalso be input from the “Setup” screen.(See “XM SETTINGS” on page 368.)

Page 356: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

356

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Add Stock”.

2 Input the desired stock symbol.

3 When finished, select “OK”.Up to 10 individual stock symbols can be

added and saved in the system for whichinformation will be received. Stocks mustbe input one at a time. To enter a stock, thesymbol of the desired stock must be known.

1 Select “Delete Stocks”.

2 Select the individual stock to be deletedor select “Select All” to delete all thestocks, and select “Delete”.

3 Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” to can-cel.

ADD STOCK DELETE STOCKS

Page 357: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

357

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

3. XM Fuel Prices

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “XM Fuel Prices”.

The “Fuel Price” screen is displayed.

Gas station name

Sort

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Info/Apps” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “XM Fuel Prices” on the “Infor-mation” screen.

4 Select the desired gas station from thelist.

The location of the selected gas station willbe displayed on the map screen.

XM Fuel Prices is a service includedwith an XM TravelLink subscription. Itenables the navigation system to displaycurrent fuel prices and gas station loca-tions, which can be set as a destination ifdesired.

SHOW XM Fuel Prices INFORMATION

XM Fuel Prices SCREEN

VIEW DETAILED FUEL PRICE INFORMATION

Page 358: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

358

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

5 Select “Info”.

When the map scale is at the maximumrange of 0.5 miles (800 m), is notshown. When the map scale is at the mini-mum range of 150 ft. (50 m), is notshown.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Other”.

“Mark”: Select to mark the selected gasstation on the map screen.“Go to ”: Select to set the selected gasstation as a destination with route direc-tions.“Add to Route”: Select to add the select-ed gas station as a destination.“Detail”: Select to read the selected gasstation’s information.

If is selected, the registeredphone number can be called.

INFORMATION

●The information displayed is received viasatellite radio. Depending on the time theinformation is received, the displayedinformation may not be up to date.

XM Fuel Prices SETTINGS

The desired fuel type, preferred brand,and show prices reported can be regis-tered.

REGISTER FUEL TYPE

Page 359: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

359

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

4 Select “XM Fuel Prices”.

5 Select “Fuel Type”.

6 Select the desired fuel type. “Premium”, “Midgrade”, “Regular” or

“Diesel” can be selected.

7 Select “Save”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Other” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “XM Fuel Prices” on the “OtherSettings” screen.

4 Select “Preferred Brand”.

5 Select the preferred brand.

6 Select “Save”.

REGISTER PREFERRED BRAND

Page 360: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

360

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Other” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “XM Fuel Prices” on the “OtherSettings” screen.

4 Select “Show Prices Reported”.

5 Select the desired period. “Last 24 Hours”, “Last 2 Days” or “Show

All” can be selected. If “Show All” is selected, information about

gas stations which fuel prices are not pro-vided is also displayed on the list.

6 Select “Save”.

REGISTER SHOW PRICES REPORTED

Page 361: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

361

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

4. XM NavWeather™

The following operations can be per-formed:• Show XM NavWeather™ information:

Weather forecast information is displayedon the map screen. (See page 361.)

• Weather information: Weather informa-tion for the selected city is displayed. (Seepage 363.)

• Weather warnings: Weather warningsissued within a radius of approximately 15miles (25 km) or 7.8 miles (12.5 km)around the vehicle are displayed on thewarning screen. (See page 364.)

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “XM NavWeather”.

The XM NavWeather screen is displayed.

“Info.”When the city icon is selected, “Info.” is dis-

played on the map screen. Selecting thisscreen button displays the “Forecast”screen. (See page 363.)

The subscription-based XMNavWeather™ service allows the navi-gation system to display weather infor-mation on the map screen.

SHOW XM NavWeather™ INFORMATION

XM NavWeather™ SCREEN

Page 362: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

362

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

City icon When this screen button is selected, city

names and “Info.” are displayed on theupper part of the screen.

“Forecast”When this screen button is selected, the

city selection screen is displayed.

• Select a city to display weather informa-tion. Weather information of the selectedcity will be displayed. (See page 363.)

“Current Location”When “Current Location” is selected, the

current position is displayed.

Zoom in/out screen buttonThe scale of the map can be changed.

Three zoom levels can be selected; 16 miles(26 km), 30 miles (48 km) and 60 miles(97 km).

Weather icons and grids Inclement weather information is displayed

on the map using weather icons and grids.Selecting an icon shows the related infor-mation at the top of the screen.

Icon Weather

Tornado

Hurricane

Storm

Flood

Winter

Wind

Extremes

Other

Hail storm

Severe thunderstorm

Heavy fog

Heavy freezing rain/ice

Heavy snow

Heavy rain

Page 363: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

363

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

When the specified day’s weather screenbutton is selected, weather information fora specified day is displayed.

WEATHER INFORMATION

No. Function

Received time

City name

Today’s date

Current weather

Current temperature

Today’s weather

Tomorrow’s weather

Day after tomorrow’s weather

Observed time (Time elapsed sincelast update)

Specified day’s weather

No. Function

Daytime weather

Nighttime weather

Maximum temperature

Minimum temperature

Precipitation probability

Page 364: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

364

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

“Weather Map”: When this screen button isselected, the “XM NavWeather” screen isdisplayed.“OK”: When this screen button is selected,the screen returns to the map of the currentposition.

When an XM NavWeather™ warning isissued within the vicinity, the XMNavWeather™ indicator will appear on themap screen.

WEATHER WARNINGS

Weather warnings issued within a radiusof approximately 15 miles (25 km) or7.8 miles (12.5 km) around the vehicleare displayed on the warning screen.

XM NavWeather™ INDICATOR

Page 365: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

365

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

5. XM NavTraffic®

The following operations can be performed:

Show XM NavTraffic® Information: Trafficinformation is displayed on the map screen.(See page 366.)Auto Avoid Traffic: If any heavy congestion

or moderate traffic has been detected onthe guidance route, it may be possible foryou to select another route offered by thesystem. (See page 130.)Traffic Incident Warning: Traffic congestion

information is provided using voice guid-ance. (See page 67.)Show Free Flowing Traffic: Freely flowing

traffic is shown by the arrow on the map.(See page 131.)

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “Traffic Incidents”.

A list of current traffic incidents is displayedalong with information on the incident’s dis-tance and position relative to the vehicle.

The subscription-based XM NavTraffic®

service allows the navigation system todisplay traffic information on the mapscreen.

INFORMATION

●When the “Traffic Information” indicatoris dimmed, “Avoid Traffic”, “Traffic IncidentWarning” and “Show Free Flowing Traffic”will not operate. (See page 366.)

SHOW TRAFFIC EVENT

Page 366: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

366

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4 Select the desired traffic event.

“On Current Route”: Select to display thetraffic congestion information for the select-ed route, or the road which the current ve-hicle is on. If a route has not been set, “OnCurrent Road” will be displayed.

5 This screen is displayed.

Guidance route traffic information is dis-played on the screen. Select “Detail” todisplay detailed traffic event information.

1 Select “Show on Map”.

2 Select “Traffic Information”.

The “Traffic Information” indicator is high-lighted.

3 XM NavTraffic® information is dis-played on the map screen.

On the map screen

On the freeway information screen

SHOW XM NavTraffic® INFORMATION

Page 367: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

367

3. XM FUNCTION OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

8

INFO

RM

ATIO

N

XM NavTraffic® iconWhen any traffic information is received,

the XM NavTraffic® icon will appear onthe map screen. Selecting the XMNavTraffic® icon on the screen will startvoice guidance for the traffic information.(See page 46.)

When the XM NavTraffic® icon isselected, voice guidance for the trafficinformation will start even if “Off” for “Traf-fic Incident Warning” is selected.

XM NavTraffic® information arrow

When any XM NavTraffic® information isreceived, the XM NavTraffic® informationarrow will appear on the map screen. Thecolor of the arrow changes depending onthe traffic information received.

XM NavTraffic® indicator

When any XM NavTraffic® information isreceived, the XM NavTraffic® indicator willappear on the screen. The color of the indi-cator changes depending on the trafficinformation received.

*: Selecting the XM NavTraffic® indicatorwill start voice guidance.

Color Function

Red Heavy congestion

Yellow Moderate traffic

Green Freely flowing traffic

Color Function

White Traffic information has beenreceived.

Yellow

Traffic restriction informa-tion on the guidance routehas been received (screenbutton*).

RedCongestion information onthe guidance route has beenreceived (screen button*).

Page 368: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

368

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4. SETUP

1. XM SETTINGS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Other”.

4 Select the item to be set.

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed:

Used for changing settings for XMSports, XM Stocks and XM Fuel Prices.

No. Function Page

Select to set XM Sports. 351

Select to set XM Stocks. 354

Select to set XM Fuel Pric-es. 357

Page 369: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

9

369

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. FUNCTIONAL OVERVIEW............... 370

2. TYPE A: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY USING A CELLULAR PHONE............................ 371

BEFORE USING THE FUNCTION .............. 373

PREPARATION BEFORE USING APPS ........................................................ 374

3. TYPE B: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY USING DCM AND THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM ................... 376

BEFORE USING THE FUNCTION .............. 377

4. TYPE C: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY USING DCM ......... 379

1. APPS ............................................................ 380ACTIVATING “APPS”......................................... 380

LINKING “APPS” AND NAVIGATION LOCAL FUNCTION ....................................... 383

INPUTTING KEYWORD OPERATION ....................................................... 385

2. Destination Assist..................................... 387

MAKE A CALL WITH Destination Assist ................................................ 387

3. eDestination............................................... 389

DOWNLOAD eDestinations ........................... 389

RETRIEVE AN eDestination .............................. 390

SHOW eDestination ICONS.............................. 391

4. Lexus Insider .............................................. 392

VIEW AND PLAY RECEIVED Lexus Insider MESSAGES.............................. 392

NEW MESSAGE NOTIFICATION.............. 394

Lexus Insider SETTINGS ..................................... 395

1 LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW 2 LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY

CONNECT OPERATION

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

Page 370: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

370

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

1. FUNCTIONAL OVERVIEW

The functions included in Lexus Enform with Safety Connect are classified into the fol-lowing three types.Type A: Function achieved by using a cellular phoneType B: Function achieved by using an embedded cellular device in the vehicle

(DCM: Data Communication Module) and the navigation systemType C: Function achieved by using DCM

Each function is available in the following areas:• Apps is available in the 48 states, D.C. and Alaska.• Destination Assist and eDestination are available in the contiguous United States.• Lexus Insider is available in the contiguous 48 states and Canada.• Safety Connect includes four features.

Automatic Collision Notification, Emergency Assistance and Stolen Vehicle Locationare available in the United States, including Hawaii and Alaska, and in Canada, andEnhanced Roadside Assistance is available in the United States (except Hawaii) and inCanada.

Lexus Enform with Safety Connect is a feature that includes Apps, Destination Assist,eDestination, Lexus Insider, and Safety Connect.

Function Type

Apps Type A

Destination Assist Type B

eDestination Type B

Lexus Insider Type B

Safety Connect Type C

INFORMATION

●The actual service availability is dependent on the network condition.

Page 371: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

371

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

2. TYPE A: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY USING A CELLULAR PHONE

Of the functions included with Lexus Enform with Safety Connect, only Apps can beachieved by using a cellular phone.Apps is a service that enables the usable contents of a cellular phone to be displayedon and operated from the navigation screen. Before Apps can be used, a few settingsneed to be performed. (See page 374.)

Page 372: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

372

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

*: For known compatible phones, refer to http://www.lexus.com/bluetooth/.

No. Name Function

Contents provider Provides contents to the navigation system via a cellular phone.

Application server Provides applications to the navigation system via a cellularphone.

Cellular phone*

Using the Apps application, communication is relayed betweenthe navigation system, the application server and the contentsprovider.A cellular phone cannot be operated while communicating.

Application player Runs applications on the navigation system. The navigation sys-tem is equipped with an application player.

Applications(“Apps”)

Displays and sounds the usable contents from the contents pro-viders via a cellular phone on the application player.

Navigation system Contents received, via a cellular phone, from the contents pro-vider servers are displayed on the navigation screen.

Page 373: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

373

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Apps will be available on a trial periodincluded upon purchase of a new vehicle.User registration is required to start usingthe service. (See page 375.)When a trial period has elapsed after pur-

chasing a new vehicle, a fee will be chargedto renew the contract.*Services requiring a separate contract can

also be used.**: For details, refer to http://www.lexus.com/

enform/ or call 1-800-255-3987.

Apps is available in the 48 states, D.C. andAlaska.

The following personal data can be deletedand returned to their default settings:• Downloaded contents• Radio stations that were listened to• Input history

BEFORE USING THE FUNCTION

SUBSCRIPTION

AVAILABILITY OF SERVICE

INFORMATION

●When using Apps, depending on thedetails of your cellular phone contract,data usage fees may apply. Confirm datausage fees before using this service.

●In this section, the required operations toactivate “Apps”, connect a cellular phoneto the navigation system and registrationsteps for Apps are explained. For detailsregarding Apps operations and each ofthe “Apps”, refer to http://www.lexus.com/enform/.

INITIALIZING PERSONAL DATA

The personal data used in “Apps” can bereset. (See “DELETING PERSONALDATA” on page 63.)

INFORMATION

●Once initialized, data will be erased. Payclose attention when initializing the data.

Page 374: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

374

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Perform the settings in the following order.

In order to use Apps, the following settingsmust first be performed:User registration with the service contract

(See page 374.)Download the Apps application onto your

cellular phone, and login to the application.(See page 375.)Register the cellular phone that the Apps

application was downloaded to with thenavigation system. (See page 375.)

Register a Bluetooth® phone with thehands-free system. (For detailed informa-tion about registration and settings, see“Bluetooth® SETTINGS” on page 197.)

1 Perform user registration from the des-ignated web address.

PREPARATION BEFORE USING APPS

SETTINGS REQUIRED TO USE APPS

1 User registration

2 Download the Apps application toyour cellular phone.

3 Register the cellular phone with thenavigation system.

USER REGISTRATION

When purchasing the vehicle, an emailaddress is registered at your Lexus deal-er. If your email address was not regis-tered at your Lexus dealer, your emailaddress can be registered at the Lexusdrivers website. A user registrationguidance email containing a web ad-dress will be sent.

INFORMATION

●If your email address was not registeredat your Lexus dealer when the vehiclewas purchased, an email address can beregistered at http://www.lexus.com/enform/.

Page 375: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

375

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Download the Apps application usingyour cellular phone.

2 Run the Apps application on your cellu-lar phone.

3 Enter a user name and password intothe Apps application. Login to the appli-cation.

REGISTERING THE APPS APPLICATION

INFORMATION

●“Apps” can only be used when the Appsapplication has been downloaded to yourcellular phone and the application is run-ning.

●Apps operational procedures can also beconfirmed by visiting http://www.lexus.com/enform/.

●In order to use “Apps”, it is necessary torun the Apps application, enter your username and password and display the mainmenu on the cellular phone.

●An iPhone cannot be connected viaBluetooth® and USB connection at thesame time. However, it is possible torecharge an iPhone while using Apps byconnecting via USB. The system uses theconnection method that was used last.Therefore, if connected via USB afterBluetooth® connection, it is necessary toreconnect the iPhone via Bluetooth®.

Page 376: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

376

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. TYPE B: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY USING DCM AND THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM

Of the functions included with Lexus Enform with Safety Connect, Destination Assist,eDestination, and Lexus Insider can be achieved by making DCM cooperate with thenavigation system.These are subscription-based telematics services that use Global Positioning System(GPS) data, embedded cellular technology to provide safety and security as well asconvenience features to subscribers.The services are supported by Lexus’ designated response center, which operates 24hours per day, 7 days per week. The services are available by subscription on select, telematics hardware-equippedvehicles.

No. Name No. Name

Lexus’ designated response center DCM

TEL, GPS antenna Navigation system

Page 377: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

377

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

After you have signed the Telematics Sub-scription Service Agreement and areenrolled, you can begin receiving services.A variety of subscription terms is availablefor purchase. Contact your Lexus dealer,call 1-800-25-LEXUS (1-800-255-3987), or select “Destination Assist” inyour vehicle for further subscription details.(See page 387.)

Destination Assist and eDestination areavailable in the contiguous United States.Lexus Insider is available in the contiguous

48 states and Canada.

Enrollment in Lexus Enform with SafetyConnect (via your dealership) is requiredto activate all services.

BEFORE USING THE FUNCTION

SUBSCRIPTION

AVAILABILITY OF SERVICE(S)

ACTIVATION OF SERVICE(S)

Certification for Lexus Enform withSafety Connect

NOTEThis device complies with part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference,and (2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.FCC WARNINGChanges or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

FCC ID: O9EGTM1FCC ID: O6Y-CDMRF101

Page 378: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

378

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

INFORMATION

●Exposure to radio frequency signals:The Lexus Enform with Safety Connectsystem installed in your vehicle is a lowpower radio transmitter and receiver. Thesystem receives and also sends out radiofrequency (RF) signals.

●In August 1996, the Federal Communi-cations Commission (FCC) adopted RFexposure guidelines with safety levels formobile wireless phones. Those guidelinesare consistent with the safety standardspreviously set by both U.S. and interna-tional standards bodies.• ANSI (American National Standards

Institute) C95.1 [1992]• NCRP (National Council on Radiation

Protection and Measurement) Report86 [1986]

• ICNIRP (International Commission onNon-Ionizing Radiation Protection)[1996]

●Those standards were based on compre-hensive and periodic evaluations of therelevant scientific literature. Over 120scientists, engineers, and physicians fromuniversities, government health agen-cies, and industry reviewed the availablebody of research to develop the ANSIStandard (C95.1).

●The design of Lexus Enform with SafetyConnect complies with the FCC guide-lines in addition to those standards.

INFORMATION

●Available beginning Fall 2009 on selectLexus models. Contact with the LexusEnform with Safety Connect responsecenter is dependent upon the telematicsdevice being in operative condition, cel-lular connection availability, navigationmap data, and GPS satellite signal recep-tion, which can limit the ability to reachthe response center or receive support.Enrollment and Telematics SubscriptionService Agreement required. A variety ofsubscription terms is available; chargesvary by subscription term selected.

●The Lexus Enform with Safety Connectresponse center will offer support in mul-tiple languages.

●Select Lexus Enform with Safety Con-nect-subscribed vehicles are capable ofcommunicating vehicle information, trig-gering owner reminder notifications.Owners who do not wish to have theirvehicle transmit this information can optout of the service at the time of enroll-ment or by calling 1-800-255-3987 andfollow the prompt for Lexus Enform withSafety Connect.

●For further details about the service, con-tact your Lexus dealer.

●Lexus Enform with Safety Connect ser-vices are not subject to section 255 ofthe Telecommunications Act and thedevice is not TTY compatible.

Page 379: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

379

1. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT-OVERVIEW

RX450h/350_Navi_U

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

4. TYPE C: FUNCTION ACHIEVED BY USING DCM

Of the functions included with Lexus Enform with Safety Connect, Safety Connectcan be achieved by using DCM.For details, refer to “Owner’s Manual”.

Page 380: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

380

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

1. APPS

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “Apps”.

4 A screen indicating that updates are be-ing checked for will be displayed.

5 Select “OK”.

To cancel updating, select “Cancel”.After selecting “Cancel”, the “Information”

screen will be displayed.The “Information” screen will also be dis-

played if updating fails.

ACTIVATING “APPS”

Each time “Apps” is activated, the sys-tem checks for updates. When there areno updates available, the main menuscreen will be displayed right after ascreen indicating that updates are beingchecked for has been displayed.

ACTIVATING “APPS”

Page 381: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

381

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 A screen indicating that an update is inprogress will be displayed.

To stop updating, select “Cancel”.After selecting “Cancel”, the “Information”

screen will be displayed.The “Information” screen will also be dis-

played if updating fails.

7 Select “OK”.

8 When updating is complete, the mainmenu screen will be displayed.

The screen shown above is only an exam-ple. The actual screen may be different.For details about the function and service

of each application displayed in the mainmenu, refer to http://www.lexus.com/enform/.

Page 382: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

382

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

IF A MESSAGE APPEARS ON THE SCREEN

When problems occur starting up the application player, a message will appear on thescreen. Referring to the table below to identify the problem, take the suggested cor-rective action.

Message Display conditions Corrective action

“This feature is unavailableduring an emergency call.”

Safety Connect is being im-plemented.

After Safety Connect is fin-ished, perform the operationagain.

“This feature is unavailablewhile transferring contacts.”

Contacts are being trans-ferred manually from thephonebook.

When the transfer of contactsis complete, perform the op-eration.

“There is a problem with theBluetooth* connection.For troubleshooting assis-tance, please visit lexus.comor call 1-800-255-3987.”

The cellular phone cannot beconnected.

Refer to http://www.lexus.com/enform/ to confirm if thephone is compatible or not.

“This feature is unavailableduring a handsfree call.”

A hands-free call is inprogress.

After the hands-free call is fin-ished, perform the operation.

“To use the services, an activeapplication needs to be run-ning on your phone. For moreinformation, please visitlexus.com.”

The Apps application cannotbe connected to Bluetooth*SPP.

Refer to http://www.lexus.com/enform/ to confirm if thephone is Bluetooth* SPPcompatible or not, and thenactivate the Apps application.

“Communication error. Please try again.”

Communication was discon-nected.

After a few moments, retry theoperation.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc.

Page 383: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

383

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “Apps”.

4 A screen indicating that updates are be-ing checked for will be displayed.

5 When updating is complete, the mainmenu screen will be displayed.

The screen shown above is only an exam-ple. The actual screen may be different.For details about the function and service

of each application displayed in the mainmenu, refer to http://www.lexus.com/enform/.

LINKING “APPS” AND NAVIGATION LOCAL FUNCTION

The navigation system’s setting a desti-nation and making a hands-free call canbe performed via “Apps”.

INFORMATION

●Some parts of “Apps” can be adjustedusing the switches on the steering wheel.

Page 384: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

384

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Map”.

2 Select “Go to ”.

3 To start guidance, select “OK”.

1 Select “Call”.

2 Select “Yes”.

To cancel making a phone call, select“Cancel”.

3 A screen indicating that a call is inprogress will be displayed.

SETTING A DESTINATION USING “APPS”

Locations that were searched using“Apps” can be set as a destination.

For the operation of the route guidancescreen and the function of each screenbutton, see “STARTING ROUTE GUID-ANCE” on page 89.

MAKING A PHONE CALL USING “APPS”

Phone calls can be made to locationswhich were searched using “Apps”.

For phone operation and the function ofeach screen button, see “TALK ON THEBluetooth® PHONE” on page 169.

Page 385: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

385

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select the character input space.

2 Select the screen buttons to input the de-sired characters, and then select “OK”.

3 Input characters will be reflected on thecharacter input space.

1 Select the microphone screen button.

INPUTTING KEYWORD OPERATION

A keyword can be input to “Apps” by thesoftware keyboard or voice recognitionfunction.

The keyboard layout can be changed.(See page 58.)

INPUTTING A KEYWORD USING THE SOFTWARE KEYBOARD

For details on operating the keyboard,see “INPUTTING LETTERS ANDNUMBERS/LIST SCREEN OPERA-TION” on page 36.

INPUTTING A KEYWORD USING THE VOICE RECOGNITION FUNCTION

Voice recognition is a function that usesthe center’s database to enable the useof the voice recognition function.

Page 386: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

386

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2 When this screen is displayed, say thedesired keyword.

Completion of saying the keyword will bedetected automatically.

3 Search results will be displayed on thescreen.

The screen shown above is only an exam-ple. The actual screen may be different.

Page 387: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

387

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

2. Destination Assist

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Destination”.

3 Select “Destination Assist”.

The “Destination Assist” screen is dis-played.

Destination Assist provides you with liveassistance for finding destinations via theLexus Enform with Safety Connect re-sponse center. You can request either aspecific business, address, or ask forhelp locating your desired destinationby category, such as restaurants, gasstations, shopping centers or otherPoints of Interest (POI).After you tell the agent your choice ofdestination, its coordinates are sentwirelessly to your vehicle’s navigationsystem.

MAKE A CALL WITH Destination Assist

Page 388: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

388

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4 When an agent comes on the line, tellthe agent the address, business name,or the type of POI or service you wouldlike to locate.

To adjust the call volume, select “–” or “+”on the “Destination Assist” screen, or usethe volume switch on the steering wheelduring the call.To hang up the phone, select “Disconnect”

on the “Destination Assist” screen or pressthe switch on the steering wheel.

5 After the agent helps you determineyour location of choice, this screen isdisplayed. Select the button of the screen for theappropriate action.

“Mark”: Select to mark the POI on thenavigation map.“Map”: Select to display the POI on thenavigation map.“Go”: Select to set the POI as a destina-tion with route directions.“Detail”: Select to read the POI notes youentered online, if any. If is selected, the registered

phone number can be called.

Page 389: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

389

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

3. eDestination

Locations can be organized into up to 20personalized folders.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Destination”.

3 Select “Point of Interest”.

With the eDestination feature, you cango online, via the Lexus.com owner’sWeb site, to select and organize desti-nations of your choice and then wire-lessly send them to your vehicle’snavigation system. Up to 200 locationscan be stored online and accessed orupdated at any time.

INFORMATION

●You must first go online atwww.lexus.com/drivers/ to view theOwners site where you will need to regis-ter and log in. After this, personalizedfolders that contains the locations to besent to your vehicle can be created. (SeeLexus Enform with Safety ConnectGuide for more information.)

DOWNLOAD eDestinations

After updating eDestination folders on-line, the information to update the data inthe vehicle will be needed to download.

Page 390: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

390

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4 Select “eDestination”.

The “eDestination” screen is displayed.

5 Select “Download”.

6 Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” to can-cel download.

When “Yes” is selected, your most recentonline eDestination data will be loaded tothe navigation system.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch. (See “Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2 Select “Destination” on the “Menu”screen.

3 Select “Point of Interest” on the “Desti-nation” screen.

4 Select “eDestination” on the “Point ofInterest” screen.

5 Select the desired eDestination folder.

RETRIEVE AN eDestination

Page 391: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

391

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

6 Select the desired location.

7 Select the button of the screen for theappropriate action.

1 Select “Show on Map”.

2 Select “eDestination Icons”.

The “eDestination Icons” indicator is high-lighted.

“Mark”: Select to mark the POI on thenavigation map.“Map”: Select to display the POI on thenavigation map.“Go”: Select to set the POI as a destina-tion with route directions.“Detail”: Select to read the POI notes youentered online, if any. If is selected, the registered

phone number can be called.

SHOW eDestination ICONS

Page 392: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

392

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4. Lexus Insider

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Info/Apps”.

3 Select “LEXUS Insider”.

The “LEXUS Insider” screen is displayed.

4 Select the desired article title from theLexus Insider menu to play that broad-cast or select “Read All” to listen to allstored Lexus Insider broadcasts.

When “Read All” is selected, “Stop” is dis-played. To stop listening to the broadcast,select “Stop”.To disrupt the audio read of Lexus Insider,

press the “MODE” switch on the steeringwheel, or press the “RADIO” or “MEDIA”button on the audio system.

Lexus Insider is an optional service thatcan send audio messages, or articles, toparticipating owners’ vehicles via thenavigation system. Potential Lexus Insid-er subjects might include, for example,Lexus vehicle technology tips, updateson regional Lexus events, or audio ex-cerpts from Lexus Magazine articles.Up to 20 articles can be stored at a time.You may opt out of receiving Lexus In-sider messages at any time. (See page394.)

VIEW AND PLAY RECEIVED Lexus Insider MESSAGES

Page 393: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

393

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Icons appear at the left of the Lexus Insiderstory titles and indicate the following:

1 After selecting an individual article, se-lect “Next” or “Previous” to listen to an-other article.

The “ ” or “ ” switch on the steering wheelcan be used to move to the previous or nextarticle.To stop listening to the broadcast, select

“Stop” or press the “PWR·VOL” knob onthe audio system.

1 If it contains a POI, “Enter ” can be se-lected to download it to the navigationsystem.

2 Select “Go to ” to set the POI as adestination with route directions.

ABOUT ICONS

Icon Article

Unread article

Previously read article

Unread article withdownloadable Point ofInterest (POI)

Previously read articlewith downloadable Pointof Interest (POI)

LISTEN TO ANOTHER ARTICLE

DOWNLOAD A POI

Some Lexus Insider stories will contain adownloadable POI relevant to the con-tent.

Page 394: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

394

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Delete”.

2 Select the individual article title to bedeleted or “Select All” to delete all thearticle titles, and select “Delete”.

3 Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” to can-cel.

1 When the new message notification ap-pears, any of the following options canbe selected.

DELETE Lexus Insider ARTICLE NEW MESSAGE NOTIFICATION

When the vehicle is first powered on anda new Lexus Insider article is available, anotification will appear on the navigationscreen.The notice will appear for only approxi-mately 6 seconds unless one of the op-tions listed is selected.

“Listen Now”: Select to play newly re-ceived Lexus Insider article(s).“Listen Later”: Select to remove notifica-tion screen without playing articles. Noti-fication will be displayed again when thevehicle is next powered on.

Page 395: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

395

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

9

LEXU

S ENFO

RM

WITH

SAFETY

CO

NN

ECT

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Other”.

4 Select “LEXUS Insider”.

5 This screen is displayed.

Perform each setting according to the pro-cedures outlined on the following pages.

Lexus Insider SETTINGS

To change Lexus Insider settings, notifi-cation, and opt in or out of article re-ceipt.

Page 396: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

396

2. LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT OPERATION

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Select “Receive LEXUS Insider”.

2 Select “Yes” to receive Lexus Insider ar-ticles or “No” to opt out of receiving ar-ticles.

3 Select “Save”.

1 Select “New Message Notification”.

2 Select “On” or “Off”.

3 Select “Save”.

1 Select “Default”.

2 Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” to can-cel.

RECEIVE/OPT OUT OF Lexus Insider

NEW MESSAGE NOTIFICATION

Automatic notification of new Lexus In-sider articles is available and is the de-fault setting.

RESTORE THE DEFAULT Lexus Insider SETTINGS

Page 397: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

10

397

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM................................................... 398

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM ............... 398

DRIVING PRECAUTIONS .............................. 398

SCREEN DISPLAY ............................................... 399

2. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM PRECAUTIONS ................................... 400

AREA DISPLAYED ON SCREEN................ 400

THE CAMERA .......................................................... 401

3. THINGS YOU SHOULD KNOW ..................................................... 402

IF YOU THINK SOMETHING IS WRONG................................................................ 402

1. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST ........... 404

TYPES OF SENSORS.......................................... 404

SETTING THE INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST MODE .................................................... 404

DISPLAY .................................................................... 405

THE DISTANCE DISPLAY AND BUZZER ................................................................. 406

DETECTION RANGE OF THE SENSORS .............................................................. 407

SENSOR DETECTION INFORMATION................................................. 407

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST-SENSOR FAILURE WARNING ...................................... 409

CERTIFICATION................................................... 409

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST SETTING................................... 410

SETTING AN ALERT VOLUME...................... 410

SETTING A PARKING SONAR DISPLAY.................................................................... 411

SETTING A DISPLAY AND TONE INDICATION.......................................................... 411

1 REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM 2 INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

PERIPHERAL MONITORING SYSTEM

Page 398: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

398

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

The rear view monitor system assists thedriver by displaying an image of the viewbehind the vehicle while backing up, forexample while parking.

INFORMATION

●The screen illustrations used in this textare intended as examples, and may differfrom the image that is actually displayedon the screen.

DRIVING PRECAUTIONS

When backing up, be sure to visuallycheck all around the vehicle both direct-ly and using the mirrors before proceed-ing. If you do not, you may hit anothervehicle, and could possibly cause an ac-cident.Pay attention to the following precau-tions when using the rear view monitorsystem.

CAUTION

●The rear view monitor system is a supple-mental device intended to assist thedriver when backing up. Never dependon the rear view monitor system entirelywhen backing up. Always make sure yourintended path is clear.Use caution, just as you would whenbacking up any vehicle.

●Never back up while looking only at thescreen.The image shown on the screen may dif-fer from the actual state, and you couldcollide with another vehicle or obstaclesif backing up looking only at the screen,possibly causing an accident. Whenbacking up, be sure to check in front ofand behind the vehicle, both directly andwith mirrors.

●Be sure to back up slowly, depressing thebrake pedal to control vehicle speed.

●When parking, be sure to check that theparking space will accommodate yourvehicle before maneuvering into it.

●In low temperatures, the screen maydarken or the image may become faint.The image could distort when the vehicleis moving, or you may become unable tosee the image on the screen. Be sure tovisually check all around the vehicle bothdirectly and using the mirrors before pro-ceeding.

●The camera uses a special lens. The dis-tances between objects and pedestriansthat appear in the image displayed on thescreen will differ from the actual dis-tances. (See page 401.)

Page 399: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

399

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

10

PERIPH

ERA

L MO

NITO

RIN

G SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Intuitive parking assistIf an obstacle is detected while the intuitive parking assist is on, a display is shown in thetop right corner of the screen.

When the shift lever is shifted to the “R” position and any mode button (such as the“MAP/VOICE” button on the Remote Touch) is pressedThe rear view monitor system is canceled, and the screen is switched to the mode of

the button that was pressed.

SCREEN DISPLAY

The rear view monitor system screen will be displayed if the shift lever is shifted to the“R” position while the “POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”> switch is in ON <IGNI-TION ON> mode.

CANCELING REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

The rear view monitor system is canceled when the shift lever is shifted into any posi-tion other than the “R” position.

Page 400: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

400

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM PRECAUTIONS

The image adjustment procedure for therear view monitor system screen is thesame as the procedure for adjusting thenavigation screen. (See page 39.)

AREA DISPLAYED ON SCREEN

The rear view monitor system displaysan image of the view from the bumper ofthe rear area of the vehicle.

Screen

Displayed area

Corners of bumper

INFORMATION

●The area displayed on the screen mayvary according to vehicle orientationconditions.

●Objects which are close to either cornerof the bumper or under the bumper can-not be displayed.

●The camera uses a special lens. The dis-tance of the image that appears on thescreen differs from the actual distance.

●Items which are located higher than thecamera may not be displayed on themonitor.

Page 401: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

401

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

10

PERIPH

ERA

L MO

NITO

RIN

G SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

THE CAMERA

The camera for the rear view monitorsystem is located as shown in the illustra-tion.

USING THE CAMERA

If the camera lens becomes dirty, it can-not transmit a clear image. If water drop-lets, snow or mud adhere to the lens,rinse with water and wipe with a softcloth. If the lens is extremely dirty, washit with a mild cleanser and rinse.

NOTICE

●The rear view monitor system may notoperate properly in the following cases,or if the precautions described below arenot followed.• If the back of the vehicle is hit, the posi-

tion and mounting angle of the cameramay change.

• As the camera has a water proof con-struction, do not detach, disassemble ormodify it. This may cause incorrectoperation.

• Do not strongly rub the camera lens. Ifthe camera lens is scratched, it cannottransmit a clear image.

• Do not allow organic solvent, car wax,window cleaner or glass coat to adhereto the camera. If this happens, wipe it offas soon as possible.

• If the temperature changes rapidly, suchas when hot water is poured on thevehicle in cold weather, the system maynot operate normally.

• When washing the vehicle, do not applyintensive bursts of water to the cameraor camera area. Doing so may result inthe camera malfunctioning.

●Do not expose the camera to strongimpact as this could cause a malfunction.If this happens, have the vehicleinspected by your Lexus dealer as soonas possible.

Page 402: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

402

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

3. THINGS YOU SHOULD KNOW

If you notice any of the following symptoms, refer to the likely cause and the solution,and re-check.If the symptom is not resolved by the solution, have the vehicle inspected by your Lexusdealer.

IF YOU THINK SOMETHING IS WRONG

Symptom Likely cause Solution

The image is difficult to see The vehicle is in a dark area The temperature around

the lens is either high or low The outside temperature is

low There are water droplets on

the camera It is raining or humid Foreign matter (mud etc.) is

adhering to the camera Sunlight or headlights are

shining directly into thecamera

The vehicle is under fluo-rescent lights, sodium lights,mercury lights etc.

Back up while visually check-ing the vehicle’s surroundings.(Use the monitor again onceconditions have been im-proved.)The procedure for adjustingthe picture quality of the rearview monitor system is thesame as the procedure for ad-justing the navigation screen.(See page 39.)

The image is blurry Dirt or foreign matter (such aswater droplets, snow, mudetc.) is adhering to the cam-era.

Rinse the camera lens withwater and wipe it clean with asoft cloth.Wash with a mild soap if thedirt is stubborn.

Page 403: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

403

1. REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

10

PERIPH

ERA

L MO

NITO

RIN

G SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

A vertical white streak is onthe screen

When a bright spot (such assunlight reflecting off the bodyof another vehicle) is receivedby the camera, a verticalstreak may be left above andbelow the bright spot (smeareffect).

Back up while visually check-ing the vehicle’s surroundings.(Use the monitor again onceconditions have been im-proved.)

The image is out of alignment The camera or surroundingarea has received a strong im-pact.

Have the vehicle inspected byyour Lexus dealer.

Symptom Likely cause Solution

Bright spot

Page 404: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

404

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

1. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

Front corner sensors

Front center sensors

Rear corner sensors

Rear center sensors

1 Press the menu switch.The multi-information display will change

modes to electronic features control mode.

2 Press the “ ” or “ ” switch above andbelow the “ENTER” switch until the in-tuitive parking assist-sensor mark ap-pears in the multi-information display.

3 Press the “ENTER” switch to select“ON”.

The intuitive parking assist-sensor indicatorwill be displayed.

The distance to obstacles measured bythe sensors is communicated via the dis-play and a buzzer when parallel parkingor maneuvering into a garage. Alwayscheck the surrounding area when usingthis system.

TYPES OF SENSORS

SETTING THE INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST MODE

Pressing the switch turns the intuitiveparking assist-sensor on or off.

To turn on: Press the switch. The buzzersounds to inform the driverthat the system is operational.

To turn off: Press the switch again.Press the menu switch to change to the

normal display.

Page 405: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

405

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

10

PERIPH

ERA

L MO

NITO

RIN

G SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ MULTI-INFORMATION DISPLAY

Front corner sensors operation

Front center sensors operation

Rear corner sensors operation

Rear center sensors operation

■ NAVIGATION DISPLAY

When the vehicle is moving forwardThe graphic is automatically displayed

when an obstacle is detected. The screencan be set so that the graphic is not dis-played. (See page 410.)

When the vehicle is moving backwardA simplified image is displayed on the right

upper corner of the screen when an obsta-cle is detected.

DISPLAY

When the sensors detect an obstacle,the graphic is shown on the multi-infor-mation display and navigation displayaccording to position and distance tothe obstacle.

Page 406: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

406

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

RX450h/350_Navi_U

■ CORNER SENSORS

■ CENTER SENSORS

■ DETECTION LEVEL AND APPROXIMATE DISTANCE TO AN OBSTA-CLE

THE DISTANCE DISPLAY AND BUZZER

When a sensor detects an obstacle, the direction of and the approximate distance tothe obstacle are displayed and the buzzer sounds.

Level 1 2 3 4

Display example

Buzzer Medium Fast Continuous

Level 1 2 3 4

Display example

Buzzer Slow Medium Fast Continuous

Level 1 2 3 4

Front corner sensors 1.6 to 1.2 ft.

(50 to 37.5 cm)1.2 to 0.8 ft.

(37.5 to 25 cm)0.8 ft. (25 cm)

or less

Front center sensors

3.3 to 1.6 ft. (100 to 50 cm)

1.6 to 1.3 ft. (50 to 40 cm)

1.3 to 1.0 ft. (40 to 30 cm)

1.0 ft. (30 cm) or less

Rear corner sensors 1.6 to 1.2 ft.

(50 to 37.5 cm)1.2 to 0.8 ft.

(37.5 to 25 cm)0.8 ft. (25 cm)

or less

Rear center sensors

4.9 to 2.0 ft. (150 to 60 cm)

2.0 to 1.5 ft. (60 to 45 cm)

1.5 to 1.2 ft. (45 to 35 cm)

1.2 ft. (35 cm) or less

INFORMATION

●Settings (e.g. buzzer volume) can be changed. (See page 410.)

Page 407: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

407

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

10

PERIPH

ERA

L MO

NITO

RIN

G SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Approximately 1.6 ft. (50 cm)

Approximately 3.3 ft. (100 cm)

Approximately 4.9 ft. (150 cm)The diagram shows the detection range of

the sensors. Note that the sensors cannotdetect obstacles that are extremely close tothe vehicle.The range of the sensors may change

depending on the shape of the object etc.

There is dirt, snow or ice on a sensor.A sensor is frozen.A sensor is covered in any way.The vehicle is leaning considerably to one

side.On an extremely bumpy road, on an

incline, on gravel, or on grassThe vicinity of the vehicle is noisy due to

vehicle horns, motorcycle engines, airbrakes of large vehicles, or other loudnoises producing ultrasonic waves.There is another vehicle equipped with

parking assist-sensors in the vicinity.A sensor is coated with a sheet of spray or

heavy rain.The vehicle is equipped with a fender pole

or radio antenna.Towing eyelets are installed.A bumper or sensor receives a strong

impact.The vehicle is approaching a tall or right-

angled curb. In harsh sunlight or intense cold weather.A non-genuine Lexus suspension (lowered

suspension etc.) is installed.

DETECTION RANGE OF THE SENSORS

SENSOR DETECTION INFORMATION

Certain vehicle conditions and the sur-rounding environment may affect theability of a sensor to correctly detect anobstacle. Particular instances where thismay occur are listed below.

In addition to the examples above, thereare instances in which, because of theirshapes, signs and other objects may bejudged by a sensor to be closer than theyare.

Page 408: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

408

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

RX450h/350_Navi_U

The shape of the obstacle may prevent asensor from detecting it. Pay particularattention to the following obstacles:• Wires, fences, ropes, etc.• Cotton, snow and other materials that

absorb sound waves• Sharply-angled objects• Low obstacles• Tall obstacles with upper sections project-

ing outwards in the direction of your vehi-cle

CAUTION

●Caution when using the intuitive parkingassist-sensorObserve the following precautions.Failing to do so may result in the vehiclebeing unable to be driven safely and pos-sibly cause an accident.• Do not use the sensor at speeds in

excess of 6 mph (10 km/h).• Do not attach any accessories within

the sensor range.●Even though sensors which are function-

ing properly continue to detect obstacles,never use the intuitive parking assist ifone more sensor(s) may be malfunction-ing.

NOTICE

●Notes when washing the vehicle●Do not apply intensive bursts of water or

steam to the sensor area.●Doing so may result in the sensor mal-

functioning.●As the intuitive parking assist-sensor

might be malfunctioning in the followingcases, have it checked by your Lexusdealer.• The graphic which indicates that an

obstacle has been detected does notcome on and a beep does not soundeven when the intuitive parking assistmode is turned on.

• The graphic which indicates that anobstacle has been detected comes ondespite no obstacle around the vehicle.

• If your vehicle has been involved in anaccident.

• If the graphic which indicates that anobstacles has been detected remainson without a beeping sound.

Page 409: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

409

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

10

PERIPH

ERA

L MO

NITO

RIN

G SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Multi-information display

Multi-information display

If this message appears, have the intuitiveparking assist-sensor checked by yourLexus dealer.

For vehicles sold in Canada.

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST-SENSOR FAILURE WARNING

If an error is detected when the intuitiveparking assist-sensor is turned on, thevehicle symbol comes on or flashes withbeeping sounds.

INFORMATION

●The intuitive parking assist-sensor failurewarning display is not given in either ofthe following operations:• Changing to another screen• Turning off the main switch for the intui-

tive parking assist-sensor

WHEN SNOWFLAKES OR MUD GETS ON THE SENSORS

INFORMATION

●If this message appears, remove the for-eign matter from the sensor.

●If the failure warning does not go off evenafter the foreign matter is removed, theintuitive parking assist-sensor may bemalfunctioning. Have it checked by yourLexus dealer.

WHEN THE SENSOR IS MALFUNCTIONING

CERTIFICATION

This ISM device complies with CanadianICES-001.Cet appareil ISM est conforme a la

norme NMB-001 du Canada.

Page 410: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

410

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

RX450h/350_Navi_U

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST SETTING

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Setup”.

3 Select “Vehicle”.

4 Select “LEXUS Park Assist”.

5 Select the desired button.

6 Select “Save”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “LEXUS Park Assist” on the“Vehicle Settings” screen.

4 Select the desired screen button.

The volume has 5 levels, increasing withhigher value.

5 Select “Save”.

The volume of the beeps, turning on oroff of the display, etc. can be set.

SETTING AN ALERT VOLUME

The alert volume can be adjusted.

Page 411: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

411

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

10

PERIPH

ERA

L MO

NITO

RIN

G SY

STEM

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “LEXUS Park Assist” on the“Vehicle Settings” screen.

4 Select “Display Off” to turn off theparking sonar display.

5 Select “Save”.

1 Press the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2 Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup” screen.

3 Select “LEXUS Park Assist” on the“Vehicle Settings” screen.

4 Select “Front” or “Rear”.

Selecting “Front” or “Rear” to switch thedistance for the front or back sensors dis-play and tone indication, from long distanceto short distance, or from short distance tolong distance.

5 Select “Save”.

SETTING A PARKING SONAR DISPLAY

Parking sonar display can be set to on oroff.

INFORMATION

●Although “Display Off” is selected, if theobstacle is detected during the intuitiveparking assist monitoring, the warningappears on the right top of the screen.

SETTING A DISPLAY AND TONE INDICATION

Front and back sensors display and toneindication can be set.

Page 412: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

412

2. INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Page 413: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

413

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

RX450h/350_Navi_U

10

INDEX

Page 414: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

414

ALPHABETICAL INDEX

RX450h/350_Navi_U

A

A/C .................................................................... 316, 327Adding destinations............................................... 100Air conditioning system ........................................ 319Air flow control buttons .............................. 316, 321Air intake control button ........................... 316, 322AM................................................................................. 221Apps............................................................................ 380

Activating “Apps”............................................. 380Inputting keyword operation....................... 385Linking “Apps” and navigation

local function ................................................. 383Audio ............................................................................ 212Audio language code ........................................... 249Audio settings ........................................................... 312

HD Radio™ system settings .......................... 312iPod settings ......................................................... 313

Audio split screen display .................................... 215Audio/video remote controls

(steering switches) ........................................... 300Audio/video system ............................................... 212AUTO button.................................................. 316, 319Automatic Sound Levelizer (ASL)................... 217AUX port.................................................................... 219

B

Basic function.............................................................. 32Bluetooth® ................................................................ 148Bluetooth® audio................................................... 269

Connecting a Bluetooth® audio player.................................................... 273

Playing Bluetooth® audio ............................. 274Bluetooth® phone .................................................. 148Bluetooth® phone message function.............. 172

Checking messages........................................... 172New message notification............................... 174Replying (quick reply) ....................................... 173

Bluetooth® settings ................................................ 197Detailed Bluetooth® settings....................... 205Registered devices............................................. 197Selecting a Bluetooth® phone .................... 202Selecting portable player .............................. 203

Brightness......................................................... 40, 246

C

Call on the Bluetooth® phone ............................ 161By call history ....................................................... 163By dial........................................................................ 161By phonebook ....................................................... 161By POI call ............................................................. 167By speed dial ........................................................ 163By voice recognition......................................... 165Calling using an SMS/MMS message....... 167

CD................................................................................ 235Changing the screen off image............................ 61Changing the startup image................................. 59Climate control ........................................................ 318Clock.............................................................................. 54Color ................................................................... 57, 246Command list .......................................................... 339Contrast ............................................................ 40, 246Covered area .......................................................... 346Current position calibration ............................... 134Current position display........................................... 41

Page 415: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

415

RX450h/350_Navi_U

D

Deleting destinations............................................... 101Deleting personal data ........................................... 63Deleting previous destinations........................... 125Deleting set destinations........................................ 88Destination Assist .................................................. 387

Make a call with Destination Assist........... 387“Destination” screen................................................ 24Destination search.................................................... 70

By “Address”........................................................... 72By “Address Book” ............................................. 83By “Coordinates” ................................................. 87By “Destination Assist” ...................................... 82By “Emergency” ................................................... 83By home..................................................................... 71By “Intersection & Freeway” ........................... 84By “Map”.................................................................. 87By “Point of Interest”........................................... 75By preset destinations.......................................... 71By “Previous Destinations” .............................. 82Selecting the search area................................. 70

Detailed navigation settings ................................ 127Detour setting .......................................................... 102Dial ................................................................................. 165Disc slot........................................................................ 212Distance and time to destination........................ 99Driver’s side temperature

control buttons........................................... 316, 319DSP control................................................................ 217Dual ................................................................... 316, 320DVD .............................................................................. 219

DVD player.............................................................. 235DVD options ....................................................... 244DVD player and DVD video disc

information ...................................................... 254Ejecting a disc .................................................... 235If the player malfunctions .............................. 253Inserting a disc................................................... 235Operating a DVD disc..................................... 241Playing a disc....................................................... 236Playing a DVD disc........................................... 242Playing an MP3/WMA disc........................ 238

E

eDestination............................................................. 389Download eDestinations............................... 389Retrieve an eDestination............................... 390Show eDestination icons................................. 391

Eject button................................................................ 212Expanded voice commands ............................. 338

F

Fan off button...................................... 316, 319, 320Fan speed control buttons ....................... 316, 320FM.................................................................................. 221Foot print map............................................................ 50Fuel consumption ................................................... 344Function index ............................................................ 20

Page 416: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

416

ALPHABETICAL INDEX

RX450h/350_Navi_U

G

General settings ........................................................ 52GPS (Global Positioning System)............. 12, 144

H

HD Radio™............................................................... 224Heading-up screen.................................................... 51Home................................................................ 14, 19, 112

I

Information............................................................... 344“Information” screen ............................................... 28Initial screen................................................................. 32Inputting letters and numbers .............................. 36Internet radio broadcast...................................... 234Intuitive parking assist.......................................... 404iPod .............................................................................. 262

Connecting iPod ............................................... 262Playing iPod music........................................... 263Playing iPod video............................................. 266

K

Keyboard layout ........................................................ 58

L

Language...................................................................... 56Lexus Enform with Safety Connect................ 370

Preparation before using Apps................... 374Lexus Insider ............................................................ 392

Lexus Insider settings ...................................... 395New message notification............................. 394View and play received

Lexus Insider messages............................. 392Limitations of the navigation system ............... 144List screen operation............................................... 36

Page 417: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

417

RX450h/350_Navi_U

M

Map................................................................................... 41Map database information and updates ........ 421Map database version and

coverage area .................................................... 346Map icons....................................................................... 51Map scale..................................................................... 49Map screen ................................................................... 12Map scroll button........................................................ 10MAP/VOICE button................................................ 10MEDIA button .......................................................... 212MENU button .............................................................. 10“Menu” screen ........................................................... 22MP3.......................................... 238, 290, 306, 309

N

Natural speech information .............................. 336Navigation settings .................................................... 111Navigation system.................................................... 70North-up screen ......................................................... 51

O

Operation flow: guiding the route ....................... 18Orientation of the map............................................. 51

P

Passenger’s side temperature control buttons .......................................... 316, 319

Pausing guidance .................................................... 106Phone (hands-free system for

cellular phone)..................................................... 150Using the phone switch..................................... 151Using the steering switches ........................... 152When selling or disposing

of the vehicle ................................................... 153Phone settings .......................................................... 175

Message settings................................................ 190Phone display settings...................................... 194Phone sound settings........................................ 175Phonebook............................................................. 177

Phonebook......................................................... 161, 177POI call ........................................................................ 167POI icons .................................................................... 107Point of Interest .......................................................... 75Preset destinations............................................... 16, 71PRST·TRACK button............................................. 212PWR·VOL knob ...................................................... 212

Q

Quick guide .................................................................. 10

Page 418: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

418

ALPHABETICAL INDEX

RX450h/350_Navi_U

R

Radio............................................................................. 221Listening to the radio ........................................ 221Presetting a station ............................................ 221Radio broadcast data system ....................... 222Selecting a station ............................................. 222Traffic announcement...................................... 223

RADIO button.......................................................... 212Rear seat entertainment system....................... 279

Changing the source ...................................... 282Headphone jacks................................................ 281Headphones ......................................................... 281Playing a USB memory................................... 287Playing an audio CD/CD text .................... 289Playing Bluetooth® audio............................. 288Playing DVD video .......................................... 290Playing iPod ........................................................ 286Playing MP3/WMA discs............................ 290Rear seat entertainment

system controller ......................................... 280Volume ................................................................... 281

Rear view monitor system.................................. 398Rear window and outside rear view

mirror defogger button........................ 316, 325Receive on the Bluetooth® phone................... 168Register a Bluetooth® phone ............................ 156

Connecting a Bluetooth® phone................ 158Reconnecting the Bluetooth® phone........ 160

Registering home ....................................................... 14Registering preset destinations ............................ 16Remote Touch ............................................................. 10

Reordering destinations....................................... 100Resuming guidance ............................................... 106Route guidance.......................................................... 89Route guidance screen........................................... 93Route overview ........................................................ 103Route preference.................................................... 104Route trace .................................................................. 110

S

Satellite radio (SAT).................................... 216, 229Screen adjustment.................................................... 39Screen Off............................................. 40, 246, 298Screen scroll operation .......................................... 42Screen settings adjustment................................... 39Selecting POI icons to be displayed............... 107Selecting screen size............................................. 218Setting and deleting destinations ..................... 100Setting home as the destination ........................... 19Setting route.............................................................. 102Setting up the “Address Book”............................ 116Setting up the “Areas to Avoid” .......................... 121Setting up the “Home” ............................................ 112Setting up the “Preset Destinations” ................. 114“Setup” screen............................................................ 26Show on map ............................................................ 107SMS/MMS message.................................... 167, 172Speed dial................................................................... 163Standard map icons .................................................. 51Starting route guidance.......................................... 89Steering switches ............................ 152, 300, 330Surround...................................................................... 217

Page 419: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

419

RX450h/350_Navi_U

T

Talk on the Bluetooth® phone ........................... 169Incoming call waiting.......................................... 171

Tire change calibration.......................................... 134Tone............................................................................. 246Tone and balance .................................................... 217Traffic incidents....................................................... 365TUNE·SCROLL knob ........................................... 212Typical voice guidance prompts ........................ 96

U

USB memory ........................................................... 256Connecting a USB memory......................... 256Playing a USB memory .................................. 257

USB port.................................................................... 220

V

Vehicle settings ........................................................ 137Maintenance......................................................... 137Vehicle customization ...................................... 142

Voice command system ................ 215, 318, 330Voice recognition.................................................... 165Voice settings............................................................. 65Voice volume ............................................................. 65

W

Windshield air flow button....................... 316, 323WMA ...................................... 238, 290, 306, 309

X

XM Fuel Prices........................................................ 357Show XM Fuel Prices information............. 357View detailed fuel price information ......... 357XM Fuel Prices settings................................. 358

XM NavTraffic®.................................................... 365Show traffic event............................................. 365Show XM NavTraffic® information ......... 366

XM NavWeather™ ............................................... 361Show XM NavWeather™ information..... 361Weather information ...................................... 363Weather warnings ............................................ 364XM NavWeather™ indicator...................... 364

XM Satellite Radio broadcast........................... 229Channel category ............................................ 230Displaying the radio ID ................................... 229Displaying the title and name ........................ 231How to subscribe to an

XM Satellite Radio....................................... 229If the satellite radio tuner

malfunctions.................................................... 232Listening to satellite radio ............................. 230Presetting a channel........................................ 230Selecting a channel............................................ 231

XM services............................................................. 348XM settings.............................................................. 368XM Sports .................................................................. 351

Receive sports information .......................... 352XM Sports settings — add or

delete teams .................................................. 352

Page 420: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

420

ALPHABETICAL INDEX

RX450h/350_Navi_U

XM Stocks................................................................ 354Receive stock data........................................... 355XM Stocks settings — add or

delete stocks.................................................. 355

Z

Zoom in button............................................................ 12Zoom out button......................................................... 12

Page 421: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

421

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Map database information and updates

This system uses the maps of DENSO.

END USER LICENSE AGREEMENTPLEASE READ THIS AGREEMENTCAREFULLY BEFORE USING THENAVIGATION SYSTEMTHIS IS A LICENSE AGREEMENTFOR YOUR COPY OF THESPATIAL MAP DATABASE,INCLUDING LOCATION CODESAND RELATED PRODUCTS(COLLECTIVELY, THE“DATABASE”), USED IN THENAVIGATION SYSTEM. BY USINGTHE NAVIGATION SYSTEM ANDTHE DATABASE, YOU ACCEPTAND AGREE TO BE BOUND BYALL TERMS AND CONDITIONSSET FORTH BELOW.LICENSE GRANTDENSO CORPORATION(“DENSO”), as a licensed distributor ofthe DATABASE, grants to you anon-exclusive, non-perpetual license touse your copy of the DATABASE foryour personal use or for your use in yourbusiness’ internal operations and not forany other purpose. This license does notinclude the right to grant sub-licenses.

OWNERSHIPThe DATABASE and the copyrightsand intellectual property andneighboring rights therein are ownedby Tele Atlas North America, Inc.(“TANA”) and its licensors. ThisAgreement does not transfer any title orinterest in the DATABASE, except forthe license to use the DATABASEaccording and subject to the terms andconditions of this Agreement. You shallnot alter, obscure or remove anycopyright notices, trademark notices orother restrictive legends relating to theDATABASE.The DATABASE comprisesconfidential and proprietaryinformation and materials of TANA.Accordingly, you shall hold theDATABASE in confidence and trust.You shall take reasonable steps toprotect the DATABASE frommisappropriation or misuse. You shallnot extract stand-alone data from orpublish any part of the DATABASEwithout the prior written consent ofTANA and its licensors.

Page 422: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

422

RX450h/350_Navi_U

LIMITATIONS ON USEThe DATABASE is restricted for use inthe specific system for which it wascreated. Except to the extent explicitlypermitted by mandatory laws, you maynot extract or reutilize any portion of thecontents of the DATABASE, norreproduce, copy, duplicate, modify,adapt, translate, disassemble,decompile, or reverse engineer anyportion of the DATABASE.TRANSFERYou may not transfer the DATABASEto third parties, except together with thesystem for which it was created,provided that you do not retain anycopy of the DATABASE, and providedthat the transferee agrees to all termsand conditions of this AGREEMENT.

DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTYTHE DATABASE IS PROVIDED ONAN “AS IS” AND “WITH ALL FAULTSBASIS” AND DENSO AND TANA(AND THEIR LICENSORS ANDSUPPLIERS) EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMALL OTHER WARRANTIES,EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO,THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OFNON-INFRINGEMENT,MERCHANTABILITY,SATISFACTORY QUALITY,ACCURACY, TITLE AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.NO ORAL OR WRITTEN ADVICEOR INFORMATION PROVIDED BYDENSO OR TANA (OR ANY OFTHEIR LICENSORS, AGENTS,EMPLOYEES OR THIRD PARTYPROVIDERS) SHALL CREATE AWARRANTY, AND YOU ARE NOTENTITLED TO RELY ON ANYSUCH ADVICE ORINFORMATION. THIS DISCLAIMEROF WARRANTIES IS AN ESSENTIALCONDITION OF THISAGREEMENT.

Page 423: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

423

RX450h/350_Navi_U

LIMITATION OF LIABILITYIN NO EVENT SHALL DENSO ORTANA (OR THEIR LICENSORS ORSUPPLIERS) BE LIABLE FOR ANYINCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL,SPECIAL, INDIRECT OREXEMPLARY DAMAGES ARISINGOUT OF THIS AGREEMENT ORYOUR USE OF THE DATABASE,INCLUDING, WITHOUTLIMITATION, LOST PROFITS ORCOSTS OF COVER, LOSS OF USEOR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION ORTHE LIKE, REGARDLESS OFWHETHER THE PARTY WASADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OFSUCH DAMAGES.IN NO EVENT WILL THE TOTALLIABILITY OF DENSO OR TANA(OR THEIR LICENSORS ORSUPPLIERS) EXCEED THEAMOUNTS PAID BY YOU FOR THEDATABASE.

WARNINGSThe DATABASE comprises facts andinformation from government and othersources reflecting circumstances inexistence before you received theDATABASE, which may contain errorsand omissions. Accordingly, theDATABASE may contain inaccurate orincomplete information due to thepassage of time, changingcircumstances, and due to the nature ofthe sources used. The DATABASEdoes not include or reflect informationrelating to, among other things,neighborhood safety; law enforcement;emergency assistance; constructionwork; road or lane closures; vehicle orspeed restrictions; road slope or grade;bridge height, weight or other limits;road or traffic conditions; specialevents; traffic congestion; or travel time.

Page 424: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

424

RX450h/350_Navi_U

U.S. GOVERNMENT RIGHTSIf you are an agency, department, orother entity of the United StatesGovernment, or funded in whole or inpart by the United States Government,then use, duplication, reproduction,release, modification, disclosure ortransfer of this commercial product andaccompanying documentation, isrestricted in accordance with theLIMITED or RESTRICTED rights asdescribed in DFARS252.227-7014(a)(1) (JUN 1995)(DOD commercial computer softwaredefinition), DFARS 227.7202-1 (DODpolicy on commercial computersoftware), FAR 52.227-19 (JUN 1987)(commercial computer software clausefor civilian agencies), DFARS252.227-7015 (NOV 1995) (DODtechnical data - commercial itemsclause); FAR 52.227-14 Alternates I, II,and III (JUN 1987) (civilian agencytechnical data and noncommercialcomputer software clause); and/orFAR 12.211 and FAR 12.212(commercial item acquisitions), asapplicable. In case of conflict betweenany of the FAR and DFARS provisionslisted herein and this Agreement, theconstruction that provides greaterlimitations on the Government’s rightsshall control.

Contractor/manufacturer is Tele AtlasNorth America, Inc., 11 Lafayette Street,Lebanon, NH 03766-1445. Phone:603.643. 0330. The DATABASE ismade by Tele Atlas North America, Inc.ALL RIGHTS RESERVED. Forpurpose of any public disclosureprovision under any federal, state orlocal law, it is agreed that theDATABASE is a trade secret and aproprietary commercial product andnot subject to disclosure.If you are an agency, department, orother entity of any State government,the United States Government or anyother public entity or funded in whole orin part by the United StatesGovernment, then you hereby agree toprotect the DATABASE from publicdisclosure and to consider theDATABASE exempt from any statute,law, regulation, or code, including anySunshine Act, Public Records Act,Freedom of Information Act, orequivalent, which permits public accessand/or reproduction or use of theLicensed Products. In the event thatsuch exemption is challenged underany such laws, this Agreement shall beconsidered breached and any and allright to retain any copies or to use of theDATABASE shall be terminated andconsidered immediately null and void.Any copies of the DATABASE held byyou shall immediately be destroyed.

Page 425: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

425

RX450h/350_Navi_U

If any court of competent jurisdictionconsiders this clause void andunenforceable, in whole or in part, forany reason, this Agreement shall beconsidered terminated and null andvoid, in its entirety, and any and allcopies of the DATABASE shallimmediately be destroyed.END-USER TERMSThe data (“Data”) is provided for yourpersonal, internal use only and not forresale. It is protected by copyright, andis subject to the following terms andconditions which are agreed to by you,on the one hand, and DENSOCORPORATION (“DENSO”) and itslicensors (including their licensors andsuppliers) on the other hand.© 2009* NAVTEQ. All rightsreserved.* original publication dateNAVTEQ holds a non-exclusivelicense from the United States PostalService® to publish and sell ZIP+4®

information.

©United States Postal Service®

2009*. Prices are not established,controlled or approved by the UnitedStates Postal Service®. The followingtrademarks and registrations areowned by the USPS: United StatesPostal Service, USPS, and ZIP+4.*original publication date

TERMS AND CONDITIONSPersonal Use Only. You agree to usethis Data together with vehiclenavigation system for the solelypersonal, non-commercial purposes forwhich you were licensed, and not forservice bureau, time-sharing or othersimilar purposes. Accordingly, butsubject to the restrictions set forth in thefollowing paragraphs, you may copythis Data only as necessary for yourpersonal use to (i) view it, and (ii) save it,provided that you do not remove anycopyright notices that appear and donot modify the Data in any way. Youagree not to otherwise reproduce,copy, modify, decompile, disassembleor reverse engineer any portion of thisData, and may not transfer or distributeit in any form, for any purpose, except tothe extent permitted by mandatorylaws. Multi-disc sets may only betransferred or sold as a complete set asprovided by DENSO and not as asubset thereof.

Page 426: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

426

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Restrictions. Except where you havebeen specifically licensed to do so byDENSO, and without limiting thepreceding paragraph, you may not (a)use this Data with any products,systems, or applications installed orotherwise connected to or incommunication with vehicles, capableof vehicle navigation, positioning,dispatch, real time route guidance, fleetmanagement or similar applications; or(b) with or in communication with anypositioning devices or any mobile orwireless-connected electronic orcomputer devices, including withoutlimitation cellular phones, palmtop andhandheld computers, pagers, andpersonal digital assistants or PDAs.Warning. The Data may containinaccurate or incomplete informationdue to the passage of time, changingcircumstances, sources used and thenature of collecting comprehensivegeographic data, any of which may leadto incorrect results.

No Warranty. This Data is provided toyou “as is,” and you agree to use it atyour own risk. DENSO and its licensors(and their licensors and suppliers) makeno guarantees, representations orwarranties of any kind, express orimplied, arising by law or otherwise,including but not limited to, content,quality, accuracy, completeness,effectiveness, reliability, fitness for aparticular purpose, usefulness, use orresults to be obtained from this Data, orthat the Data or server will beuninterrupted or error-free.Disclaimer of Warranty: DENSO ANDITS LICENSORS (INCLUDINGTHEIR LICENSORS ANDSUPPLIERS) DISCLAIM ANYWARRANTIES, EXPRESS ORIMPLIED, OF QUALITY,PERFORMANCE,MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FORA PARTICULAR PURPOSE ORNON-INFRINGEMENT. Some States,Territories and Countries do not allowcertain warranty exclusions, so to thatextent the above exclusion may notapply to you.

Page 427: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

427

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Disclaimer of Liability: DENSO ANDITS LICENSORS (INCLUDINGTHEIR LICENSORS ANDSUPPLIERS) SHALL NOT BE LIABLETO YOU: IN RESPECT OF ANYCLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION,IRRESPECTIVE OF THE NATUREOF THE CAUSE OF THE CLAIM,DEMAND OR ACTION ALLEGINGANY LOSS, INJURY OR DAMAGES,DIRECT OR INDIRECT, WHICHMAY RESULT FROM THE USE ORPOSSESSION OF THEINFORMATION; OR FOR ANYLOSS OF PROFIT, REVENUE,CONTRACTS OR SAVINGS, ORANY OTHER DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGESARISING OUT OF YOUR USE OFOR INABILITY TO USE THISINFORMATION, ANY DEFECT INTHE INFORMATION, OR THEBREACH OF THESE TERMS ORCONDITIONS, WHETHER IN ANACTION IN CONTRACT OR TORTOR BASED ON A WARRANTY,EVEN IF DENSO OR ITSLICENSORS HAVE BEEN ADVISEDOF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGES. Some States, Territoriesand Countries do not allow certainliability exclusions or damageslimitations, so to that extent the abovemay not apply to you.

Export Control. You agree not toexport from anywhere any part of theData provided to you or any directproduct thereof except in compliancewith, and with all licenses and approvalsrequired under, applicable export laws,rules and regulations.Entire Agreement. These terms andconditions constitute the entireagreement between DENSO (and itslicensors, including their licensors andsuppliers) and you pertaining to thesubject matter hereof, and supersedesin their entirety any and all written ororal agreements previously existingbetween us with respect to such subjectmatter.Governing Law. The above terms andconditions shall be governed by thelaws of the State of Illinois, withoutgiving effect to (i) its conflict of lawsprovisions, or (ii) the United NationsConvention for Contracts for theInternational Sale of Goods, which isexplicitly excluded. You agree tosubmit to the jurisdiction of the State ofIllinois for any and all disputes, claimsand actions arising from or inconnection with the Data provided toyou hereunder.

Page 428: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

428

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Government End Users. If the Data isbeing acquired by or on behalf of theUnited States government or any otherentity seeking or applying rights similarto those customarily claimed by theUnited States government, this Data is a“commercial item” as that term isdefined at 48 C.F.R. (“FAR”) 2.101, islicensed in accordance with theseEnd-User Terms, and each copy ofData delivered or otherwise furnishedshall be marked and embedded asappropriate with the following “Noticeof Use,” and shall be treated inaccordance with such Notice:

If the Contracting Officer, federalgovernment agency, or any federalofficial refuses to use the legendprovided herein, the ContractingOfficer, federal government agency, orany federal official must notifyNAVTEQ prior to seeking additional oralternative rights in the Data.

NOTICE OF USECONTRACTOR

(MANUFACTURER/ SUPPLIER) NAME: NAVTEQCONTRACTOR

(MANUFACTURER/SUPPLIER) ADDRESS: 425 West Randolph Street, Chicago, Illinois 60606

This Data is a commercial item as defined in FAR 2.101 and is subject to these End-User Terms under which

this data was provided.© 2009* NAVTEQ - All rights

reserved. *original publication date

END USER NOTICEPLEASE READ THIS NOTICECAREFULLY BEFORE USING THISNAVIGATION SYSTEMThe Point Of Interest Data (“POI” Data)in the navigation system is in partprovided by Infogroup Inc.(“Infogroup”). By using the POI Data,you accept and agree to all terms andconditions set forth below.1. OwnershipAll rights, title and interest to theInfogroup POI Data shall be retained byInfogroup.2. Limitations on useExcept to the extent explicitly permittedby mandatory laws, you may not extractor re-utilize any portion of the contentsof the POI Data, nor reproduce, copy,modify, adapt, translate, disassemble,decompile, or reverse engineer anyportion of the POI Data.3. TransferYou may not transfer the POI Data tothird parties, except together with thesystem for which it was created,provided that you do not retain anycopy of the POI Data.

Page 429: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

429

RX450h/350_Navi_U

4. Disclaimer of warrantyEXCEPT AS STATED HEREIN,INFOGROUP MAKES NOEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING,WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTYOF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULARPURPOSE OR WARRANTY OFMERCHANTABILITY.5. Limitation of LiabilityEITHER INFOGROUP ORSUPPLIER OF POI DATA SHALLNOT BE LIABLE FOR ANYINDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL ORINCIDENTAL DAMAGES MADEOR ALLEGED IN CONNECTIONWITH YOUR USE OF THE POIDATA.

END USER LICENSE AGREEMENTPersonal Use Only. You agree to usethis information for solely personal,non-commercial purposes, and not forservice bureau, time-sharing or othersimilar purposes. You may not modifythe information or remove anycopyright notices that appear on theinformation in any way. You may notdecompile, disassemble or reverseengineer any portion of this information,and may not transfer or distribute it inany form, for any purpose. Withoutlimiting the foregoing, you may not usethis information with any products,systems, or applications installed orotherwise connected to or incommunication with vehicles, capableof vehicle navigation, positioning,dispatch, real time route guidance, fleetmanagement or similar applications.

Page 430: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

430

RX450h/350_Navi_U

No Warranty. This information isprovided to you “as is,” and you agree touse it at your own risk. DENSO and itslicensors (and their licensors andsuppliers, collectively “DENSO”) makeno guarantees, representations orwarranties of any kind, express orimplied, arising by law or otherwise,including but not limited to, andDENSO expressly disclaims anywarranties regarding content, quality,accuracy, completeness, effectiveness,reliability, fitness for a particularpurpose, non-infringement, usefulness,use or results to be obtained from thisinformation, or that the information orserver will be uninterrupted orerror-free. Some states, territories andcountries do not allow certain warrantyexclusions, so to that extent, the aboveexclusion may not apply to you.

Disclaimer of Liability: DENSO SHALLNOT BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ANYCLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION,IRRESPECTIVE OF ITS NATURE,ALLEGING ANY LOSS, INJURY ORDAMAGES, WHETHER DIRECT,INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIALOR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES,INCLUDING ANY LOSS OFPROFIT, REVENUE ORCONTRACTS ARISING OUT OFYOUR POSSESSION, USE OF ORINABILITY TO USE THISINFORMATION, ANY DEFECT INTHE INFORMATION, OR THEBREACH OF THESE TERMS ORCONDITIONS, WHETHER IN ANACTION IN CONTRACT OR TORTOR BASED ON A WARRANTY,EVEN IF DENSO OR ITSLICENSORS HAVE BEEN ADVISEDOF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGES. Some states, territoriesand countries do not allow certainliability exclusions or damageslimitations, so to that extent the abovemay not apply to you.

Page 431: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

431

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Indemnity. You agree to indemnify,defend and hold DENSO and itslicensors (including their respectivelicensors, suppliers, assignees,subsidiaries, affiliated companies, andthe respective officers, directors,employees, shareholders, agents andrepresentatives of each of them) freeand harmless from and against anyliability, loss, injury (including injuriesresulting in death), demand, action,cost, expense, or claim of any kind orcharacter, including but not limited toattorney’s fees, arising out of or inconnection with any use or possessionby you of this information.END USER NOTICEThe marks of companies displayed bythis product to indicate businesslocations are the marks of theirrespective owners. The use of suchmarks in this product does not imply anysponsorship, approval, or endorsementby such companies of this product.

Page 432: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

432

RX450h/350_Navi_U

This product uses the following opensource software.

· T-KernelThis Product uses the Source Code ofT-Kernel under T-License granted bythe T-Engine Forum (www.t-engine.org).· C LibraryThis product includes softwaredeveloped by the University ofCalifornia, Berkeley and itscontributors. This product includessoftware developed by the University ofCalifornia, Lawrence BerkeleyLaboratory.Copyright © 1982, 1985, 1993 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.Copyright © 1982, 1986, 1993 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.Copyright © 1982, 1986, 1989, 1993The Regents of the University ofCalifornia. All rights reserved.© UNIX System Laboratories, Inc. Allor some portions of this file are derivedfrom material licensed to the Universityof California by American Telephoneand Telegraph Co. or Unix SystemLaboratories, Inc. and are reproducedherein with the permission of UNIXSystem Laboratories, Inc.Copyright © 1982, 1986, 1991, 1993,1994 The Regents of the University ofCalifornia. All rights reserved.

© UNIX System Laboratories, Inc. Allor some portions of this file are derivedfrom material licensed to the Universityof California by American Telephoneand Telegraph Co. or Unix SystemLaboratories, Inc. and are reproducedherein with the permission of UNIXSystem Laboratories, Inc.Copyright © 1983, 1990, 1993 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.© UNIX System Laboratories, Inc. Allor some portions of this file are derivedfrom material licensed to the Universityof California by American Telephoneand Telegraph Co. or Unix SystemLaboratories, Inc. and are reproducedherein with the permission of UNIXSystem Laboratories, Inc.Copyright © 1983, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1987, 1991, 1993 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.Copyright © 1987, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1988 Regents of theUniversity of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1988 University of Utah.Copyright © 1992, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved. This code is derived fromsoftware contributed to Berkeley by theSystems Programming Group of theUniversity of Utah Computer ScienceDepartment and Ralph Campbell.

Open source license

Page 433: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

433

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Copyright © 1988, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1988, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved. This code is derived fromsoftware contributed to Berkeley byArthur David Olson of the NationalCancer Institute.Copyright © 1989 The Regents of theUniversity of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1989 The Regents of theUniversity of California. All rightsreserved.© UNIX System Laboratories, Inc. Allor some portions of this file are derivedfrom material licensed to the Universityof California by American Telephoneand Telegraph Co. or Unix SystemLaboratories, Inc. and are reproducedherein with the permission of UNIXSystem Laboratories, Inc.Copyright © 1989, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1989, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.© UNIX System Laboratories, Inc. Allor some portions of this file are derivedfrom material licensed to the Universityof California by American Telephoneand Telegraph Co. or Unix SystemLaboratories, Inc. and are reproducedherein with the permission of UNIXSystem Laboratories, Inc.Copyright © 1990, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.

This code is derived from softwarecontributed to Berkeley by Chris Torek.Copyright © 1991, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1991, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to Berkeley by BerkeleySoftware Design, Inc.Copyright © 1992, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved. Copyright © 1992, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to Berkeley by RalphCampbell.Copyright © 1992, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.© UNIX System Laboratories, Inc. Allor some portions of this file are derivedfrom material licensed to the Universityof California by American Telephoneand Telegraph Co. or Unix SystemLaboratories, Inc. and are reproducedherein with the permission of UNIXSystem Laboratories, Inc.Copyright © 1992, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.

Page 434: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

434

RX450h/350_Navi_U

This software was developed by theComputer Systems Engineering groupat Lawrence Berkeley Laboratoryunder DARPA contract BG 91-66 andcontributed to Berkeley. All advertisingmaterials mentioning features or use ofthis software must display the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed by theUniversity of California, LawrenceBerkeley Laboratory.Copyright © 1992, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to Berkeley by RalphCampbell. This file is derived from theMIPS RISC Architecture book byGerry Kane.Copyright © 1993 The Regents of theUniversity of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1994 The Regents of theUniversity of California. All rightsreserved.

This code is derived from softwarecontributed to Berkeley by AndrewHume of AT&T Bell Laboratories.Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed by theUniversity of California, Berkeley andits contributors.4. Neither the name of the Universitynor the names of its contributors may beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

Page 435: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

435

RX450h/350_Navi_U

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE REGENTS ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE REGENTS ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.

Copyright © 1982, 1986 Regents ofthe University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1983, 1990, 1993 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed by theUniversity of California, Berkeley andits contributors.4. Neither the name of the Universitynor the names of its contributors may beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

Page 436: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

436

RX450h/350_Navi_U

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE REGENTS ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE REGENTS ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.

Portions Copyright © 1993 by DigitalEquipment Corporation.Permission to use, copy, modify, anddistribute this software for any purposewith or without fee is hereby granted,provided that the above copyrightnotice and this permission noticeappear in all copies, and that the nameof Digital Equipment Corporation notbe used in advertising or publicitypertaining to distribution of thedocument or software without specific,written prior permission.THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ““ASIS”” AND DIGITAL EQUIPMENTCORP. DISCLAIMS ALLWARRANTIES WITH REGARD TOTHIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALLIMPLIED WARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS.IN NO EVENT SHALL DIGITALEQUIPMENT CORPORATION BELIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL,DIRECT, INDIRECT, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ORANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVERRESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE,DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER INAN ACTION OF CONTRACT,NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERTORTIOUS ACTION, ARISINGOUT OF OR IN CONNECTIONWITH THE USE ORPERFORMANCE OF THISSOFTWARE.

Page 437: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

437

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Copyright © 1982, 1986, 1990, 1993The Regents of the University ofCalifornia. All rights reserved.Copyright © 1983, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1990, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. Neither the name of the Universitynor the names of its contributors may beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE REGENTS ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE REGENTS ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.

Page 438: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

438

RX450h/350_Navi_U

This product includes softwaredeveloped by the NetBSD Foundation,Inc. and its contributors.Copyright © 1996 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby J.T. Conklin.Copyright © 1997 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby Klaus Klein.Copyright © 1997, 1998 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.Copyright © 1997,98 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby J.T. Conklin.Copyright © 1997, 1998 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code was contributed to TheNetBSD Foundation by Klaus Klein.Copyright © 1998 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby Klaus Klein.Copyright © 1998, 2000 TheNetBSD Foundation, Inc. All rightsreserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby Klaus J. Klein.

Copyright © 1999, 2000 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby Julian Coleman.Copyright © 2000 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby Dieter Baron and Thomas Klausner.Copyright © 2000, 2001 TheNetBSD Foundation, Inc. All rightsreserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby Jun-ichiro itojun Hagino and byKlaus Klein.Copyright © 2001 The NetBSDFoundation, Inc. All rights reserved.This code is derived from softwarecontributed to The NetBSD Foundationby Klaus Klein.

Page 439: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

439

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed by theNetBSD Foundation, Inc. and itscontributors.4. Neither the name of The NetBSDFoundation nor the names of itscontributors may be used to endorse orpromote products derived from thissoftware without specific prior writtenpermission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC.AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” ANDANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE FOUNDATION ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.This product includes softwaredeveloped by Christos Zoulas.Copyright © 1997 Christos Zoulas. Allrights reserved.

Page 440: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

440

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed byChristos Zoulas.4. The name of the author may not beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE AUTHOR “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLEFOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.This product includes softwaredeveloped by Winning Strategies, Inc.Copyright © 1994 Winning Strategies,Inc. All rights reserved.

Page 441: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

441

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed byWinning Strategies, Inc.4. The name of the author may not beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE AUTHOR “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLEFOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.

Page 442: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

442

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Copyright © 1995, 1996, 1997, and1998 WIDE Project. All rightsreserved.Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. Neither the name of the project northe names of its contributors may beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE PROJECT ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE PROJECT ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.

Page 443: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

443

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Copyright ©1999 Citrus Project, Allrights reserved.Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE AUTHOR ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE AUTHOR ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.Copyright © 1995 Carnegie-MellonUniversity. All rights reserved. Author:Chris G. DemetriouCopyright © 1995, 1996Carnegie-Mellon University. All rightsreserved. Author: Chris G. Demetriou

Page 444: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

444

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Permission to use, copy, modify anddistribute this software and itsdocumentation is hereby granted,provided that both the copyright noticeand this permission notice appear in allcopies of the software, derivative worksor modified versions, and any portionsthereof, and that both notices appear insupporting documentation.CARNEGIE MELLON ALLOWSFREE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE INITS ““AS IS”” CONDITION.CARNEGIE MELLON DISCLAIMSANY LIABILITY OF ANY KIND FORANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVERRESULTING FROM THE USE OFTHIS SOFTWARE.Carnegie Mellon requests users of thissoftware to return to SoftwareDistribution Coordinator [email protected] of Computer Science CarnegieMellon University Pittsburgh PA15213-3890 any improvements orextensions that they make and grantCarnegie the rights to redistributethese changes.· TCP/IP, Socket LibraryThis product includes softwaredeveloped by the University ofCalifornia, Berkeley and itscontributors.

Copyright © 1980, 1983, 1988, 1993The Regents of the University ofCalifornia. All rights reserved.Copyright © 1983, 1987, 1989 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.Copyright © 1983, 1989, 1993 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.Copyright © 1985, 1988, 1993 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.Copyright © 1985, 1993 The Regentsof the University of California. All rightsreserved.Copyright © 1989, 1993, 1995 TheRegents of the University of California.All rights reserved.

Page 445: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

445

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed by theUniversity of California, Berkeley andits contributors.4. Neither the name of the Universitynor the names of its contributors may beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE REGENTS ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE REGENTS ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.Copyright © 2004 by InternetSystems Consortium, Inc. (““ISC””)Portions Copyright © 1996-1999 byInternet Software Consortium.Permission to use, copy, modify, anddistribute this software for any purposewith or without fee is hereby granted,provided that the above copyrightnotice and this permission noticeappear in all copies.

Page 446: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

446

RX450h/350_Navi_U

THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ““ASIS”” AND ISC DISCLAIMS ALLWARRANTIES WITH REGARD TOTHIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALLIMPLIED WARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS.IN NO EVENT SHALL ISC BELIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL,DIRECT, INDIRECT, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ORANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVERRESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE,DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER INAN ACTION OF CONTRACT,NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERTORTIOUS ACTION, ARISINGOUT OF OR IN CONNECTIONWITH THE USE ORPERFORMANCE OF THISSOFTWARE.Portions Copyright © 1993 by DigitalEquipment Corporation.Permission to use, copy, modify, anddistribute this software for any purposewith or without fee is hereby granted,provided that the above copyrightnotice and this permission noticeappear in all copies, and that the nameof Digital Equipment Corporation notbe used in advertising or publicitypertaining to distribution of thedocument or software without specific,written prior permission.

THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ““ASIS”” AND DIGITAL EQUIPMENTCORP. DISCLAIMS ALLWARRANTIES WITH REGARD TOTHIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALLIMPLIED WARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS.IN NO EVENT SHALL DIGITALEQUIPMENT CORPORATION BELIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL,DIRECT, INDIRECT, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ORANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVERRESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE,DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER INAN ACTION OF CONTRACT,NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERTORTIOUS ACTION, ARISINGOUT OF OR IN CONNECTIONWITH THE USE ORPERFORMANCE OF THISSOFTWARE.This product includes softwaredeveloped by WIDE Project and itscontributors.Portions Copyright © 1995, 1996,1997, and 1998 WIDE Project. Allrights reserved.

Page 447: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

447

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: This productincludes software developed by WIDEProject and its contributors.4. Neither the name of the project northe names of its contributors may beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE PROJECT ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE PROJECT ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.Copyright © 1988 Stephen Deering.Copyright © 1982, 1986 Regents ofthe University of California. All rightsreserved.

Page 448: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

448

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. [rescinded 22 July 1999]4. Neither the name of the Universitynor the names of its contributors may beused to endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE REGENTS ANDCONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE REGENTS ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.Copyright © 1982, 1986, 1988Regents of the University of California.All rights reserved.

Page 449: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

449

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms are permitted providedthat the above copyright notice and thisparagraph are duplicated in all suchforms and that any documentation andother materials related to suchdistribution and use acknowledge thatthe software was developed by theUniversity of California, Berkeley. Thename of the University may not be usedto endorse or promote productsderived from this software withoutspecific prior written permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED““AS IS”” AND WITHOUT ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING,WITHOUT LIMITATION, THEIMPLIED WARRANTIES OFMERCHANTIBILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.Rights, responsibilities and use of thissoftware are controlled by theagreement found in the ““LICENSE.H””file distributed with this source code.““LICENSE.H”” may not be removedfrom this distribution, modified,enhanced nor references to it omitted.

Copyright 1983 by the MassachusettsInstitute of Technology Copyright 1984 by the MassachusettsInstitute of TechnologyCopyright 1984, 1985 by theMassachusetts Institute of Technology Copyright 1990 by NetPort Software Copyright 1990-1993 by NetPortSoftware. Copyright 1990-1994 by NetPortSoftware.Copyright 1990-1996 by NetPortSoftware.Copyright 1990-1997 by NetPortSoftware.Copyright 1993 by NetPort Software Copyright 1986 by Carnegie MellonAll Rights Reserved

Page 450: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

450

RX450h/350_Navi_U

Permission to use, copy, modify, anddistribute this software and itsdocumentation for any purpose andwithout fee is hereby granted, providedthat the above copyright notice appearin all copies and that both that copyrightnotice and this permission noticeappear in supporting documentation,and that the name of CMU not be usedin advertising or publicity pertaining todistribution of the software withoutspecific, written prior permission.· OpenSSLThis product includes softwaredeveloped by the OpenSSL Project foruse in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/) This productincludes cryptographic softwarewritten by Eric Young([email protected]). This productincludes software written by TimHudson ([email protected]).OpenSSL LicenseCopyright © 1998-2008 TheOpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the above copyright notice, thislist of conditions and the followingdisclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the following acknowledgment:“This product includes softwaredeveloped by the OpenSSL Project foruse in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)”4. The names “OpenSSL Toolkit” and“OpenSSL Project” must not be used toendorse or promote products derivedfrom this software without prior writtenpermission. For written permission,please contact [email protected]. Products derived from this softwaremay not be called “OpenSSL” nor may“OpenSSL” appear in their nameswithout prior written permission of theOpenSSL Project.6. Redistributions of any formwhatsoever must retain the followingacknowledgment: “This productincludes software developed by theOpenSSL Project for use in theOpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)”

Page 451: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

451

RX450h/350_Navi_U

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYTHE OpenSSL PROJECT “AS IS”AND ANY EXPRESSED ORIMPLIED WARRANTIES,INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT ORITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLEFOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.This product includes cryptographicsoftware written by Eric Young([email protected]). This productincludes software written by TimHudson ([email protected]).Original SSLeay LicenseCopyright © 1995-1998 Eric Young([email protected]) All rightsreserved.

This package is an SSL implementationwritten by Eric Young([email protected]). Theimplementation was written so as toconform with Netscapes SSL. Thislibrary is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the followingconditions are aheared to. Thefollowing conditions apply to all codefound in this distribution, be it the RC4,RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just theSSL code. The SSL documentationincluded with this distribution is coveredby the same copyright terms except thatthe holder is Tim Hudson([email protected]). Copyrightremains Eric Young’s, and as such anyCopyright notices in the code are not tobe removed. If this package is used in aproduct, Eric Young should be givenattribution as the author of the parts ofthe library used. This can be in the formof a textual message at program startupor in documentation (online or textual)provided with the package.Redistribution and use in source andbinary forms, with or withoutmodification, are permitted providedthat the following conditions are met:

Page 452: TABLE OF CONTENTS · 2016-02-05 · TABLE OF CONTENTS. 2 RX450h/350_Navi_U Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. ... The screen shots in this document

452

RX450h/350_Navi_U

1. Redistributions of source code mustretain the copyright notice, this list ofconditions and the following disclaimer.2. Redistributions in binary form mustreproduce the above copyright notice,this list of conditions and the followingdisclaimer in the documentation and/orother materials provided with thedistribution.3. All advertising materials mentioningfeatures or use of this software mustdisplay the followingacknowledgement: “This productincludes cryptographic softwarewritten by Eric Young([email protected])” The word‘cryptographic’ can be left out if therouines from the library being used arenot cryptographic related :-).4. If you include any Windows specificcode (or a derivative thereof) from theapps directory (application code) youmust include an acknowledgement:“This product includes software writtenby Tim Hudson ([email protected])”

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BYERIC YOUNG “AS IS” AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUTNOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OFMERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESSFOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSEARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENTSHALL THE AUTHOR ORCONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FORANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,EXEMPLARY, ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITEDTO, PROCUREMENT OFSUBSTITUTE GOODS ORSERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESSINTERRUPTION) HOWEVERCAUSED AND ON ANY THEORYOF LIABILITY, WHETHER INCONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, ORTORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCEOR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANYWAY OUT OF THE USE OF THISSOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OFTHE POSSIBILITY OF SUCHDAMAGE.The licence and distribution terms forany publically available version orderivative of this code cannot bechanged. i.e. this code cannot simply becopied and put under anotherdistribution licence [including the GNUPublic Licence.